10份初二英语试卷

2014-5-11 0:22:52 下载本试卷

初二英语. Unit 1- 3 试卷

姓名:_____  班级:_______   座号:________

一、听写单词:2.5分

    1._______   2._______    3._______   4.________   5._______

二、选出你所听到的句子。2.5分

1、(  )A. We  all come back to  school on Sunday.

         B. Welcome back to  school, boys and  girls!

         C. I  don' t know all  your names.

2、(  )A. She  usually come to  school by bus.

         B. Are you  going to the  factory by  bus?

         C. Do  you often come to  the factory by  bus?

3、(  )A.  Jim is  older than Lucy.

         B. Lucy is  younger than Jim.

         C. Jim is  shorter than Jom.

4、(  )A. They play volleyball on  Saturdays.

         B. They play with their parents on  Sundays.

         C. They watch football games every day.

5、(  )A.  May I  borrow a piece of  paper?

         B. I have your name' s  on this piece of  paper.

         C. I  have them on  this piece of  paper.

三、选出你所听到的单词。5分

1、(  )A. certainly   B. third   C. Thrsday   D. turn

2、(  )A. hard       B. class    C. half       D. farm

3、(  )A. police   B. week   C. leave    D. me

4、(  )A. house    B. about    C. brown   D. now

5、(  )A. what    B. watch   C. want     D. wash

四、英汉互译。12分

1. It doesn' t matter_________________

2. Write on  a piece of  paper_____________________

3. 步行上学___________________

4. Thand you  for helping me_________________

5. 在那天_______________  6. 好主意________________

7. in the  open air____________8.许多不同种类________________

五、辨音。5分

1、(  )A. thank    B. fourth   C. another    D. three

2、(  )A. long     B. short    C. tall        D. walk

3、(  )A. air       B. first     C. term       D. third

4、(  )A. second   B. lesson   C. next       D. evening

5、(  )A. paper   B. matter   C. eighth     D. page

六、选择填空。22分

1. ____ the Chinese teacher of  Class Three?

A. Whose    B. What     C. Who' s     D. Where

2. Does he ____ home at  six in the  morning?

A. leave      B. leaving    C. to leave    D. leaves

3. How does he  go to school?_____bus.

A. By        B. By a     C. by        D. on

4. He_____ goes to  work by car.

A. sometime     B. some ttimes    C. sometime    D. sometimes

5. This box  is heavy . But that one  is______.

A. the  most heavy    B. the heavyest   C. the heavier    D. heavier

6. Lucy  is reading a  letter______her friend.

A. in         B.  on      C. with        D. from

7. What' s the  English ______Zhong Qiu  Fie?

A. on        B. in       C. for          D. with

8. Please come here ______ earlien  next time.

A. a  lot of   B. a little    C.too        D. very

9. Kate is_____than any  other girl in  her class.

A. younger   B. the yourgest   C. the younger   D. youngest

10. The big  apple is____ofall .

A. the  redder    B. the reddest   C. the redest  D.reddest

11. Are you  free_____?

A. tomorrow evening  B. on  tomorrow  evening  C. tomorrow' s evening.

七、按要求变换句型。11分

1. Mr  Green is forty- two. Mrs  Green is forty. And  Kate Green is  only seven.

   Mr Green is_________  _____________in his  family.

2. These mooncakes have nuts in  them. I like them.

   I  like the  moomccakes__________muts_______  ___________.

3. What a  fine day it  is today!_____ _____ it is!

4. It' s time to  have breakfast. It' s time_____breakfast.

5. He' s eating the  biggest apple.(划线提问)

________________________________________________.

6. It  has  an egg  in  it.(否定句)_________________________________.

7. She  is only three.  She can' t carry the  heavy bag.

(用 Why组成一个问句)_______________________________________.

八、找出划线部分的替换词。10分

(   )1、 Do you  want  to drink a  bottle of orange?

       A. Are you drinking.         B. Let' s drink. 

       C. Can you drink.           D. Would you like.

(   )2、Lily  is writing . What about lucy?

       A. Where' s Lucy?           B. Is Lucy reading?

       C. What is Lucy  doing?     D. Can Lucy write?

(   )3、The  young  man is  working.

       A. at home    B. at school  C. at work   D. at his  desk

(   )4、The  work is hard. I want some help.

      A. Cam  I help you ?   B. What can  I do for  you?

       C. What' s wrong with you?  D. Could you  help me?

(   )5、Li  Lei works hard at  English and she  studies English well

       A. is good at  English.      B. studies English hard.

       C. can speak English.      D. writes very well.

九、阅读理解,选择正确的答案。10分

 Mr  Smith is a teacher of  English. He is  29. He has  a round face and  his black hair(头发) . He is  tall. There are  50 students in  his class . They all  like him.

Now it' s five in  the classroom. Look, some students are  working in the  classroom. Mr Smith is  there, too. He  is helping them to  study English. He  is a good teacher, and  he is a  good friend of  them.

1.  What does Mr  Smith do?(    )

A. He is  a student.        B. He' s a teacher. 

C. He' s Englishman.       D. He' s a friend of  us.

2. What coloun is  his hair?(    )

A. Black      B. Red    C. Yellow   D. White

3. How many students are  there in Mr Smith' s class?(   )

A. Twenty- nine   B. Fifty   C. Fifreen  D. Fifties

4. What time is  it now?(    )

A. It' s five in  the mouning.    B. It' s five in  the afternoon.

C. It' s fifty                   D. I don' t dnow.

5.What is  Mr Smith doing in  the classroom?(    )

A. He is  having his class.  B. He is  doing his homework.

C. He is  talding with his  students.

D. He is  helping the students to  study English.

十、完型填空。10分

Li Ping:  Mother ,  this is Kate. She' s①_______ English girl. Kate, this is②________ mother.

Kate:      How do you  do, Mrs Li?

Mother:   ③______? Sit  down, please.

Kate:      ④________________.

Mother:   Are you  and ⑤ ______ classmate?(同班同学)

Kate:     Yes, I am. ⑥________ are  in Class  3.

Li Ping: ⑦  ___ teacher says I' m like Kate. But  we aren' t⑧______.

Mother:   Yes, you  are ⑨ ________ .You are  good ⑩_______.

(  )1. A.  a      B. an    C. the   D.×

(  )2. A. my     B. I     C. mine  D. me

(  )3.A.How are you? B.How do you do? C.Are you fine? D.Is it all right?

(  )4. A. Thank   B. Thank'    C. Thanks   D. thanks.

(  )5. A. my daughter B. my daughter' sC. my daughters D. my daughters'

(  )6. A.  I    B. Li Ping  C. Li Ping and  I.  D. I and  Li Ping.

(  )7. A. We    B. Our     C. Us      D. Ours

(  )8. A. twin   B. twins    C. sisters   D. English

(  )9. A.  ×      B. too      C. right     D. wrong

(  )10. A. friends  B. friend  C. freind   D. freinds

十一、安排句子的顺序,用a,b,c…表示。10分

1.(  )A. How  much is it?

2.(  )B. What about that one? It' s only 30.

3.(  )C. 80  yuan.

4.(  )D. That' s too  dear.

5.(  )E. All  right. I' ll take it.

6.(  )F. Can  I help you?

7.(  )G. Yes, please. I  want a pair of  shoes, please.

8(  )H. White.

9.(  )I.  What 10  Lour do you  want?

10.(  )J. OK,  here you are.

依次写在如下:________________________________________________

初二年段英语测试(Unit 1- Unit 2.)

                              Sep.17.

       姓名:______  座号:_____   班级:______      得分:_____

一、语音。指出下列各组单词划线部分共有几种读音。10分

    (A:一种       B:二种      C:三种      D:种)

          A          B           C             D

(   )1.  soon         moon      bedroom        food

(   )2. parent        hard       pair            car

(   )3. sea          bread      mean          great

(   )4. another       from       so             do

(   )5. usually       sister      swims         school

(   )6. train         plance     away          way

(   )7. policeman    ship       ride          children

(   )8. my          lily        yellow         your

(   )9. Tuesday      usually     uncle         ruler

(   )10. walk        half        talk           all

二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式。(10分)

1. long (反义词 ):___________      2. two ( 序数词):__________

3. pair  (同音词):___________      4. foot ( 复数):__________

5. lesson (同义词):___________     6. canada (形容词):_________

7.fifth(基数词):__________         8. see (同音词):________

9. have (第三人称单数):_________  10. night (反义词):________

三、选择填空:(30分)

(   )1.There are ________on  the  table.

A.a piece of  paper       B.a piece of  papers

C. two  pieces of  paper   D. two pieces  of papers

(    )2.I have  your names ______this piece of  paper.

A. in      B. on      C. at     D. of

(    ) 3. Welcome  back  _______school.

A. at      B. in      C. to     D. on

(    ) 4. _______him  come   in .

A. Doesn' t  let          B. Don' t  lets

C. Don' t    letting       D. Don' t  let

(    ) 5.Would   you  like  to  have_________ ?

A. a  piece  bread       B. some  bread

C. a  bread             D. a piece of  bread

(    ) 6.  I ' m  sorry ________.

A. to  late               B. be  late

C. I   late               D. I ' m late

(    ) 7.Wei  Hua _______have lunch at  home.

A. doesn' t often          B. don' t  often

C. often   don' t          D. often  doesn' t

(    ) 8.One of  these  mooncakes  _______ an  egg in it.

A. have     B. is        C. are        D. has

(    ) 9.How many of  _______come to school on  foot ?

A. we       B. they      C. us         D. our

(     ) 10.It ' s seven o 'clock .  They _______ their homework.

A. do       B. does      C. is doing   D.are  doing

姓名:______  座号:______   班级:________

(   ) 11.  I  don' t like this dress .   Do yon  have ______one ?

A. an  another            B. another

C. other                 D. others

(   ) 12.  He ________his lunch  at  school.

A. don' t  have           B. hasn' t 

C. haven' t               D. doesn' t have

(   ) 13.  Sam  often _______to  the  farm.

 A.  by bike            B. on a  bike 

 C.  rides a  bike        D. ride  bikes

(   ) 14.  _________good  students.

A. They all  is           B. They are  all

C. Are  they  all           D. All  are  they

(   ) 15._____Is  the  woman _______?  Yes  she is .

A. shop      B. shops       C. shoping       D. shopping

四、介词填空 (10分)

1. It ' s a  fine day _______a  swim.

2. She  goes home every year ________his  parents.

3. How  many  ________you  come from Canada ?

4. She  helps  her  mother ________housework .

5. He  often buy food _______his way  home .

6. Who  is the  English teacher ________class Two  ?

7. Please  write  _______the piece of  paper.

8. We  don' t  go to  school _______Sunday.

9. Do  you have something _______supper.

10. Jim  often goes to  school ______ foot.

五、改病句(每句只有一处错,指出并订正在横线上)(10分)

(   ) 1.  ________ Look ! Mike  is runing  with  the  kite.

                   A          B    C     D

(   ) 2._________ The  two  men are  playing the  basketball now.

                          A         B     C    D

(   ) 3. _________ This is  our the  first  lesson  this  term.

                         A  B   C           D

(   ) 4. _________ Everyday  he leaves home  at  about  seven.

                    A           B        C    D

(   ) 5. _________ He  often helps  uncle Wang does  housework.

                      A      B                C      D

六、用所给动词的正确形式填空 (10分)

1. He  ______(not have ) his  lunch at school .He  _______( have )

   it at  home now.

2. Tom  likes  ________(swim) .   Look ,   he ________ (swim )

  in the  river.

3. Let  me  ________ (sing )  this  song.

4. May  I  ___________ ( have )  another   mooncakes ?

5. _______ (not  be )  late next  time.

6. I  like _______ (ride ) a bike .  Now  I   would  like  ______

  (swim ) in  the river.

7. What  about  ________ ( have )  a  drink  of   tea ?

        姓名:______  座号:______    班级:_______

七、句型转换。(10分)

1. She  does housework everyday  (改为一般问句)

     ___________________________________________________

2. Is   she  having  supper  now ?( 用usually…at home 改写)

     ___________________________________________________

3. The  girl  in red  is  Tom ' s sister ?(划线提问)

     ____________________________________________________

4. He  usually  swims  in  the  river .(用now改写)

     ____________________________________________________

5. Do  you  have  a sister ?(改为否定疑问句)

     _____________________________________________________

八、补全对话。(10分)

G:Morning ,  Mr Wu !  I ________you ' re  on  foot today ?

   _______you  usually come  by  bike ?

W : Yes  I  do .  ________ I  walk _________.

G :____________where ' s  you  bike .

W: It ' s broken.

G:  Broken  ?   Oh  ________?

W: It  doesn ' t___________ .

    I  like  __________ look at  the  sun!  

         It ' s  a   fine  day   for  a  _______.

G : That 's  hight .

 And  the ___________ today  is  nice.

                                 

                                   Good  Luck !

                                   Baxia  Middle  School.

初二英语测试(Unit 3—4 )

一.听写单词.5分

   1.________   2.________  3.________  4.________ 5._______

二.选择与所听到句子意思相似的句子.5分

(  )1.A.This bottle is  clean.       B.This bottle is  empty.

      C.This bottle is  small.       D.This bottle is  full.

(  )2.A.Li Lei  is older than Wei  Hua.

      B.Li Lei is  taller than Wei  Hua.

      C.Li Lei is  younger than Wei  Hua.

      D.Li Lei is  shorter than  Wei Hua.

(  )3.A.The red  ruler is the  shortest of the  three.

      B.The red ruler is  the longest of  the three.

      C.The red ruler is  heavier than the  blue one.

      D.The green ruler is  langest of the  three.

(  )4.A.I' m going to  do some washing.

      B.I' m going to  do some reading.

      C.I' m going to  do some shopping.

      D.I' m going to  do some cleaning.

(  )5.A.Why don' t you  play basketball with us ?

      B.Why don' t you  go swimming with us ?

      C.Why don' t you  go on foot with us ?

      D.Why don' t you  go by bus ?

三.选择你所听到的单词.5分

(  )1.A.book       B.look       C.food         D.foot

(  )2.A.right        B.light         C.like       D.bike

(  )3.A.sun         B.some        C.can' t      D.aren' t

(  )4.A.first         B.third         C.shirt      D.skirt

(  )5.A.meat        B.please        C.sea       D.tean

四.找出划线部分读音不同的选项.5分

(  )1.A.sun      B.put      C.must        D.nut

(  )2.A.september       B.next       C.mend      D.let

(  )3.A.dear      B.wear      C.hair      D.where

(  )4.A.think      B.month     C.another       D.fourth

(  )5.A.quite      B.night      C.pick       D.outside

五.按要求写单词.10分

1.month(复数)______      2.good(比较级)________

3.tall(反义词)_______      4.sure(同义词)_________

5.hungry(最高级)_______   6.has(现在分词)______

7.sun(同音词)________     8.three(序数词)________

9. foot(复数)__________     10.out(反义词)_______

六.单项选择.30分

(  )1.What day  is it today?_____

      A.It' s Ootober 10.          B.It' s 7 o'clock.

      C.It' s Teachers' Day.        D.It's a fine day.

(  )2.What ____ it  look like?

      A.are    B.is     C.do    D.does

(  )3.Lily  has  many different______.

      A.kinds of kites     B.kind of kites   

      C.kinds kites          D.kind kite

(  )4.There is  ___ water in the  glass.

     A.any      B.few      C.a few      D.a little

(  )5.Whose pen  is longer, ______?

      A.Tom and kate' s.        B.Tom' s  or Kate' s.

      C.Tom' s and Kate' s.      D.Tom or Kate' s.

(  )6.Everyone here _____ playing football.

     A.is liking    B.is likes     C.likes      D.like

(  )7.______ early next time.

     A.Be      B.Is        C.Am        D.Are

(  )8.Why not  ____ home and watch TV?

     A.stay at     B.stays at  

     C.staying in   D.to stay at

(  )9.It' s  time  ______ to have a  swim.

     A.to us       B.for us  

      C.for we     D.with we

(  )10.The students don' t_____ on Sundays.

       A.have some classes.         B.have any classes.

       C.to have classes.            D.have no classes.

(  )11.He' s reading English ____ the open air.

      A.on      B.at       C.in       D.to

(  )12.I like flying kites. It' s____ better than ____classes.

      A.many , have         B.many , having  

      C.much,  have          D.much , having

(  )13.This banana is ___ of all.

     A.big     B.bigger   

     C.boggest      D.the boggest

(  )14.He would  like you _____ earlier.

       A.come      B.coming  

      C.to come      D.comes

(  )15.We call ____ oranges.

       A.they        B.them  

      C.their         D.it

七.改写句子.10分

1.Tom offten helps Lucy with her  homework.(改为一般

  将来时,用this term改写)

________________________________________________________

2.Write down your names.(否定句)

______________________________________

3.The boy  is eating  the  smallest opple.(划线提问)

____________________________________________

4.This book is  good. That book is  better.(合并为一句)

______________________________________________

5.The students of  class 1 are  going to pick pears.(改为一

般问句并作答)__________________________________

      __________________________________________

八.用所给词 的正确形式填空.10分

1.Here ___(be) 3 books. One  of ____(their) is an  English book.

2.They like ____(swim). They' re going ____(swim) tomorrow.

3.Ann' s kites are _______(nice) than  mine.

4.________(not let) him  ________(come) in.

5.Thank you  for _______(ask) me.

6.Lesson 1  is ______(easy) than  Lesson 2.

7.The Yellow River is  the second _____(long) river in  China.

九.完成对话.12分

A: Hello, Meinei. Where are  you ⑴_________?

B: Hello, Lucy. I' m going to  the ⑵_____________.

A: What are  you going to  ⑶_____________?

B: I' m going to  buy some ⑷_______. Don' t  you know it' s Mid-     Autumn Day Tomorrow?

A: Oh. I see. What ⑸______of  mooncakes do you  like?

B: I like those ⑹_____ meat.  What ⑺_______ you?

A: I like the  ⑻_____ ⑼_____ nuts ⑽____them.

B: We have them. Please come over and  have mooncakes with us.

A: Sure. I' d love ⑾_______.

B: ⑿______you tomorrow.

A: see you.

十.先阅读,后判断正误.8分

     I' m an  American girl . My  name is Kate. I' m twelve. I 

have a  brother, Jim. He' s two  years old than I  am . We go  to

school from Monday to  Friday. We have no  classes on Saturdays and  Sundays.

     My father and  mother are teachers . They teach English in  Beijing . We all  like China.

(  )1.They' re from England.

(  )2.Kate and  her brother go  to school five day  a week.

(   )3.Kate' s parents are  in China.

(  )4.Kate is  twelve and Jim  is fifteen.

初二英语单元测试(Unit5—Unit6)

  姓名:________  座号_____  班级_____   得分______

一.语音:10%

(  )1. A. take      B. many     C. paper    D. baby

(  )2. A. monkey   B. dangerous  C. worng   D. uncle

(  )3. A. say       B. may       C. play    D. Sunday

(  )4. A. careful    B. hair       C. hear    D. chair

(  )5. A. half      B. wall       C. talk     D. tall

(  )6. A. whose    B. white      C. which   D. what

(  )7. A. park      B. hard       C. puarter   D. car

(  )8. A. meal      B. team      C. clean     D. great

(  )9. A. first       B. tiger       C. hers      D. Thursday

(  )10. A. likes     B. helps      C. picks      D. answers

二.按要求转变下列单词:10%

   1. monkey(复数) _______      2. here(同音)______

   3. near(反义词)_______      4. reach(第三人称单数)___

   5.busy(反义词)________     6. zoo(复数)________

   7. twenty(序数词)_______    8.careful(比较级)______

   9. good(最高级)________   10. forget(现在分词)______

三.用所给形容词适当形式填空:5%

   1.The bag  is_____(heavy) than that one.

   2. Lucy is _______ (short)  of the  three.

   3. Bill has  some apples.   I have ______(many) apples  than Bill      Mike has____(many)  of all.

   4. The ninth Lesson is _____ (long) lesson in  Unit 3.

四.翻译下列词组:12%

   1.一直___________        2.玩得很高兴_____________

    3.听到一些动物声音_____________    4. 6 : 15 ___________

    5. be hard to  reach____________      6. a  little longer_______

五. 选择题25%

(  )1. Classes _______at eight every  morning.

    A. is beginning     B. is  begining  

   C. begins          D. begin

(  )2. He is  going _____ early tomorrow morning.

    A. to go  there    B. to come  here.

    C. coming here         D. there

(   )3. Who______ here the  latest?  Wu Dong does.

    A. is coming   B. comes    C. is      D. coming

(  )4. The farmers are  lifting the basket______the truck.

   A. in  to              B. into    

   C. down to            D. on to

(  )5. Look at  those oranges! _____ are  better than yours.

   A. My       B. I      C. Mine       D. Our

(  )6. Please ______ too  high.  It' s dangerous.

   A. not  climb          B. climb   

   C. not to  climb          D. dor't climb

(  )7. I' m going ______ nent Saturday.]

   A. be free           B. to have free  

   C. to be  free         D. have free

(  )8. _______ is  it?      It' s about five kilometres from here.

   A. Where         B. Where' s    

   C. How far        D. How long

(  )9. Mike is  holiday the ladder _____ his  brother.

   A. at       B. in      C. for      D. of

(  )10. Whose paper  planes are ____, Wu  Dong' s or Wei  Fang's?

    A. best    B. the best    C. better      D. good

(  )11. Work must come ________

    A. one      B. first     C. the first      D. at first

(  )12. I _____ think  he ______ a  good boy.

    A. / … isn' t     B. don' t … is   C. do … aren' t   D. not … is

(  )13. —Shall we  go to the  park?  —________.

    A. I' ve no  idea       B. Good idea

    C. I' d love to        D. No, Let' s meet at  7: 00

(  )14. —Would you  like to go  shopping with me?

       — I ______  love to.

    A. would      B. had     C. do     D./

(  )15. My watch is  cheaper than_____.

    A. Lily       B. Lilys     C. Lily' s    D. her.

(  )16. Why _____ your father?

    A. don' t ask   B. not to  ask   C.don' t to ask   D. not ask

(  )17. The  Reads _____supper now.

    A. is having    B. have    C. has     D. are having

(  )18. It' s time _____  boating.

    A. to          B. for      C. at      D. in

(  )19. Many oranges are ______ bigger  than yours.

    A. very        B. too      C. much    D. more

(  )20. One of  the teachers in  our school ____ to Beijng.

    A. walk        B. walking    C. walks     D. is  walk

(  )21. Who climbs _____, Jim , Peter or  Sam?

    A. the  higher    B. highest   C. higher     D. high

(  )22. Can you ____ the apples?  They are  too high.

     A. reach       B. reach to     C. get to    D. reaching

(  )23. Everyone in  our class _____ busy now.

     A. has       B. have     C. are        D. is

(  )24. " Would you  like some water or  tea? "  "_______"

    A. Yes, please        B. No , I don' t  

    C. Some tea, please    D. No, thank you.

(  )25. It' s _______   we all_______

    A. hard  work,   hard  work       B. work hard,  work hard

    C. work hard,   hard work        D. hard work, work hard

六.用动词适当形式填空:10%

   1. Jim and  I _____(make) our kites tomorrow.

   2. Lucy often ______(watch) TV  in the evening.

   3. Look! The  students_______(pick) the apples.

   4. My mother has  quite a lot  of homework______(do).

   5. Does he  like ______(read)  English books?

   6. Kate would like Lucy ______(come) to  supper.

   7. Shall we  ____(go) shopping.

   8. Kate and  Jim______ (come) tomorrow evening.

   9. My friend Ann  is good at______(sing).

   10. It' s hard _____(play) football.

七.句型转换:10%

   1. Does Kate want to  go with us?(同义句)

      ______ Kate ______ to  go with us?

   2. Shall we  go at ten?(同义句)

     _______  ______ go  at  ten?

   3. Jim is  the strongest in  his class. (同义句)

     Jim is _____ than ____  ______ student in  his class.

   4. The hat  looks like a cat.  (划线部分提问)

      ________   ______ the hat  look like?

   5. Jim usually does his  homework  in the  evening.(划线部分提问)

     ______  does Jim  usually do his  homework?

八.补全对话:8%

    Jim: Hi, Lin Tao! What are  you going to  do on Sundays?

Lin Tao: I' ve no____ .   What do  you____?

    Jim: _____ we go  to the park?

Lin Tao: ______ idea!  _____ shall we  meet?

    Jim: What about a  quarter past two?

Lin Tao: Let' s ____ it  a little ______. There  is a  zoo in the  park.

    Jim: OK,  Let' s make it  half past one.

Lin Tao: ______ shall we  meet?

    Jim: Let' s meet outside the  park gate.

九.完形填空:

        ______1. student of  class Four often nork on  the farm. They usually go  to work there ______2. Saturday morning. _____3. they are  going to there _____4. Friday morning. They are  going to help the  farmers ______5. their work.  ______6. teachers are  going to the  farm with them. They are  going to pick _____7. there. They are  going to meet at  about eight at  the  school  gate.  They  are going to  ______8. the farm ______9. bus. The  bus  is  going  to leave at  8 : 15, So eveuyone must ______10. the  bus  before  that time.

(   )1. A. An       B. A       C. The       D. /

(   )2. A. on       B. at       C. in         D. by

(   )3. A. And      B. But      C. So        D. Or

(   )4. A. in this    B. at  this   C. that       D. this

(   )5. A. at        B. on       C. of       D. with

(   )6. A. Much     B. They      C. Their    D. Theirs

(   )7. A. oranges    B. orange    C. much oranges  D. any oranges

(   )8. A. get        B. get to    C. reach to   D. get  to

(   )9. A. at         B. in        C. for       D. by

(   )10. A. get up    B. get on    C. to get on  D. to get

   

   

   

   

   

       初二英语Unit 8 --- 9 试卷

一. 语音. (10分)

(   )1. A. answer    B. ask      C. aslo     D.  farther

(   )2. A. hear       B.pear     C. dear      D.  ear

(   )3. A. front      B.from    C. popular   D. long

(   )4. A. whose     B.when   C. where    D. which

(   )5. A. chicken   B.chair    C. lunch     D. machine

(   )6. A. class      B. desks   C.sure       D. same

(   )7. A. house     B.pass    C.nose       D.mustn't

(   )8. A. office      B.stop     C.police     D.hospital

(   )9. A.real        B.meat    C.idea       D.really

(   )10. A. my       B.why     C.yellow    D.fly

二. 按要求写出下列单词的相应形式 (10分)

1. ask (反义词)______       2.front (反义词) ____________ 3. similar  (反义词) ________ 4.touch (第三人称单数)______5.policeman (复数)  _______ 6.practice (动词)____________ 7. open (形容词 反义词)______   8. I (同音词) _________ 9.turn (名词) ___________   10.You'd better (完全形式)____

三. 选择填空: (20分)

(   )1. They are  putting their ______ in  front of them.

       A. close  hads             B. closed  hands

       C. close  hand              D. closed  hand

(   )2. He is  one of ____ in  our  school.

       A. good   students          B. best students

       C. the  best  students       D. the best  student

(   )3. Jim has __________.

       A. many   fruits         B. much fruit   

       C. more  fruits          D. less fruits

(   )4. I don' t  like  this  shirt.  Show me _____ one, please.        A. other       B. another     C. others    D. the others

(   )5. Why not ____ a  bike  for  your son ?

       A. to buy    B. buying     C. buys       D. buy

(   )6. My mother often keeps ______ everyday.

       A. her very busy        B. her to be  busy

       C. her' s  very busy       D. she  busy

(   )7. Please  keep  Kate  and ____ wity their housework.

       A. hers       B. me      C. us         D. her

(   )8. Let' s ______  friends.

       A. to be      B. are      C. be         D. being

(   )9. I _______ the  teacher ,  but  I can' t ___ a  word.

       A. hear . . . listen         B. listen . . . hear

       C. listen to . . . her       D. listen to . . .hear to

(   )10. One of  the  students ____ an eraser in  his hand.

        A. have       B. having    C. has      D. to  have

(   )11. Children often love ____ this game.

        A. to playing    B. to play   C. play   D. plays

(   )12. Where ___ Tom and Tim ___ in the  classroom.

        A. do . . . sit              B. does . . . sit

        C. is . . . sitting            D. are . . . sitting

(   )13. Where is  my bag?  I can' t _____it  now.

        A. look for    B. find    C. find out      D. look at

(   )14. It' s about three ____ along  on the  left.

        A. hundreds  metres            B. hundred   metre

        C. hundred  metre              D. hundred   metres

(   )15. She is  good  at Chinese .  She ____ any help.

        A. doesn' t  need                B. not need   

        C. needn' t                     D. needs

(   )16. You' d better ____ late  next  time.

        A. not to be            B. don' t  to be

        C. don' t be            D. not  be

(   )17. The school is _____the other side ___ the  river.

        A. on . . . in   B. in . . . in   C. on . . . of   D. in . . . of

(   )18. How far  is it ____ Beijing _____  Shanghai ?

        A. from . . . from         B. to . . .  to

        C. from . . . to            D. to . . . from

(   )19. He  neads __________.

        A. number   12   bus        B. the number 12  buses         C. number   12  buses       D. a  number  12  bus

(   )20. You ____ ride  a bike  on the  left  of  the  road.

        A. mustn' t     B. can    C. may not    D. needn' t

四. 在空格中填入适当的词.  (10分)

1. Do  you  know  who  sits  next ____  him ?

2. Can you tel l  me  the  way ____  the  station ?

3. I  know  the parts _____  the  body?

4. There is  a  blackboard  ______  the  back  wal l _____ the   classroom.

5. Jim sits ____  Li  Lei' s  nigbt.

6. The  factory is  about 12 kilometres away _____ the school.

7. The school is  two hundred metres ______ on  the left.

8. I like ______ the  second  floor.

9. The eraser is  _____  his night  hand.

五. 选择适当的动词,  用适当的形式填空.  (10分)

stand ,  go ,  have,  keep,   climb,   hear,   swim ,   pass, answer,    borrow,

1. The ball _____  from  one clild  to  another.

2. Please _____  that  pencil  to me.

3. Look, Meimei _____ in  the  middle of  the  river.

4. ________(not) the ladder!  It' s  broken.

5. Look  at the  picture  and ______ the  teacher' s  questions.

6. He  usually ______ a  drink  of  orange  in  the  middle of   the  day.

7. Who _______ in  front  of the  car ?  Our  teacher is.

8. I _____  there  is going  to  be  a  football  game  the day   after  tomorrow.

9. Can I _______ your  pen ? Mine  is  broken.

10. The students  must ________  their  eyes  open.

六. 改病句(每句只有一处错误, 指出并订正在横线上)(20分)

______ (   )1. It' s very  late  and  there' s  not  bus  here.

               A        B                C        D

______ (   )2. You  need  to catch  a train YOu   have  better

                    A       B                  C    D

              find  a  station.

______ (   )3. The students are  having their Chinese lessons.

                                     A     B 

              Most  of they  are  listening  to  the  teacher.

                        C           D

______ (   )4. It' s about  twenty  minutes' s  walk   from 

                    A               B      C

              here to  our  home.  

                   D

______ (   )5.You think  there be many  trees along the  river.               A            B      C         D

______ (   )6.She studies very well. She  is  also good at  sing                   .A          B          C           D

______ (   )7. There is a  post office near hear.  On  it  right                  A                           B  C

              hand  is  a  small  telephone  box.

                   D

______ (   )8. Excuse me.  Can you  tell  me  the  way  of  

                  A       B        C                  D

             the  bus --- stop ?

______ (   )9. He is  looking  for  different  place.

                 A     B     C             D

______ (   )10. Mr Wu  usually stands  in  the  front  of  the 

                               A    B  C         D

               blackboard.

七. 按要求变换句型: (10分)

1. You mustn' t open your eyes (同义替换) 

   You must _____  your  eyes ______.

2. I sit on  Tom' s  right. (同义替换)

   Tom sits ______  ______ me.

3. I need  some  paper . (否定句)

  I ________  _______  some  paper.

4. He is  going  to buy  some  fruit  tomorrow. (划线提问)

  _____ _____  fruit is  he  going  to  buy  tomorrow ?

5. You  may  look  out  of  the  window.(否定句)

   You ______  ______  out  of  the window.

八. 按课文填空 (10分)

    Children  often ________  to play  this  game.  They play it _____  this :  six  students   stand _______  a   row  in front  of   the ______ .   They   put  their   hands______ their   backs .   So  you  can' t _______  their  hands.  The teacher ________ one  of  them  an  eraser.   The   eraser goes  foom  one  student  to  ________.   They  must ___their  hands  behind  their   backs.   They  other  students in  the  class  keep  their  eyes ________. They  must   look.

    Best   Wishes

初二英语(Unit 12 —13)

姓名:________   座号:____   班级:_____成绩_______

一. 找出划线部分读音与其他三个不同的选项. 10分

(   )1. A. vegetable     B. hospital      C. ago      D. again

(   )2. A.  reach        B. machine      C. touch    D. teach

(   )3. A.  noodle      B. took         C. cook    D. bedroom

(   )4. A.  word        B. born         C. work      D. worse

(   )5. A.  move        B. hold         C. hope       D. nose

(   )6. A.  played       B. passed       C. helped    D. hoped

(   )7. A. quick        B. will          C. bring      D. night

(   )8. A.  think        B. thought      C. throw    D. clothes

(   )9. A.  because    B. August      C. autumn   D. daughter

(   )10. A. whose     B. where       C. white      D. which

二. 根据句子意思填上适当的词: 6分

 1. ______ comes  before  September ,  and  comes after____

 2. ______ did you  come ?    --- Two  days  ago.

 3. We  played  football  the day  before_________.

 4. The  girl ________ to  school  after ________ breakfast.

三. 按要求写词语   12分

 1. little (最高级)________    2. buy (过去式)__________

 3. good (副词)_______       4. best (反义词)_________

 5. aunt (同音词)______      6. five (序数词)_______

 7. forty (序数词)______      8. hour (同音词)______

 9.  catch (过去式)_______    10. 出生于 (英语)________

 11. 休息一会儿(同上)_____________  12.开会(同上)_____

四选择题:  25分

(   )1. He  had  better____ his  homework_____.

       A. finish . . . the first      B. finishing . . .  the first

       C. finish . . .  first         D. to finish . . .  first

(   )2. We  don' t _______ every  day.

        A. does  eyes  exercises   B. does eye  exereises

        C. do  eye  exercise       D. do eye  exercises

(   )3. Today is  Fuesday,  December______.

        A. nineteen               B. nineteenth   

        C. the  nineteen           D. the nineteenth

(   )4. One  of  my friends ____ here an  hour ago.

        A. is        B. are       C. was        D. were

(   )5. Li  Lei and  I  enjoy ____ this  game.

        A. playing    B. played   C. play    D. were played

(   )6. Sport  is  good _____ students.

        A. with        B. for       C. to      D. on

(   )7. I  met  my  uncle _____my way _____school .

        A. on , to      B. in , to    C. on , ×   D. in ,  at

(   )8. Our  teacher  talked  with  Mr Green  for ______.

        A. an  half  hour      B. one  half  an  hour

        C. half  an  hour       D. half  a  hour

(   )9. What  did  your  father  do_______?          

        A. last  morning        B. morning  last

        C. yesterday  morning     D. on yesterday morning

(   )10. Are  you  enjoying _____here  and______?

        A. to sit ,  talk          B. sitting ,  talking

       C. sitting ,  talk          D. sitting , to  talk

(   )11. Sport  is  good _____  students.

        A. with         B. on       C. to         D. for

(   )12. We had  a  meeting _____ May.  4,  1998.

        A. on      B. at       C. in       D. ×

(   )13. July  comes before _____ and  after.

        A. June  , August        B. August ,  June

        C. May ,  June          D. June ,  April

(   )14. Happy  New  Year  to you !

        A. Yes ,  I' m  happy    B. The  same to  you.

        C. OK ,  thank  you     D. Not  at  all

(   )15. The  vegetables   are ______  dear.

        A. much               B. not  much   

        C. too  much           D. much too.

(   )16. He  eats  a  lot  of ______.

        A. fruit  and  vegetable    B. fruits  and  vegetables

        C. fruits  and  vegetable   D. fruit  and  vegetables

(   )17. When  did  you _____ her  home  yesterday?

        A. get     B. reach      C. got  to    D. reached.

(   )18. Did  you _____ lunch  yesterday?

        A. do      B. make      C. cook     D. take

(   )19. You  may ___  this  book  for  two  days .

        A. buy    B. borrow     C. lend      D. keep

(   )20. Pass____ English  books ,  please.

        A. they  their           B. them  their

        C. their  they           D. their  them

(   )21. Would  you  like _____?

        A. to eat some  porridge   

        B. to eat  some  porrides

        C. have  any  porridge    D. to have any  porridge

(   )22. You' d  better _____ at  home  on  Sundays.

        A. not  to  stay        B. to  stay

        C. not  stay            D. stayed

(   )23. Don' t  read ____ the  sun.

        A. in          B. under       C. over       D. on

(   )24. It  was _____ hard  work.

        A. a       B. an         C.  ×         D. the

(   )25. The  peaple  give  us_____.

        A. two  box of  small  cakes

        B. two  boxes  of  small  cake

        C. two  boxes  of   small  cakes

        D. two  boxs  of  small  cake.

五. 下列各句中各有一处错误, 先出并订正. 10分

 _________ (    )1. She  is   born  in  1982, in  Shanghai.

                       A    B    c         D

 _________(    )2. I wash  my   hand and face every morning                       A         B    C   D

 _________(    )3. Did  you   helped   your   mother   clean

                   A           B                     C

                  the  house  yesterday  morning?

                                     D

 _______(    )4. My mother  was  busy to do her  housework

                               A        B

                 all  day     yesterday.

                   C          D

 _____(   )5. Now I  can speak a few English, but she  can' t

                           A     B            C        D

      

六. 选用动词的正确时态填空. (每个词填一次)20分

    work,      study,    be,     be born ,    walk,      find

    enjoy,     buy,     move ,     begin.

   

     My   friend,   John ______ in  a  small  village  and___ in  a  school   three  years  ago.  The  school ________ not  far ,   So   he  always _______ there .  His  father_____ a   bike  for  him ,  but  he  didn' t  like  to   use   it.

    Last  year  John' s  father ________ work  in  the city. So  his  family _________  there.   John ______ to  study in

a   middle   school.  Now  John ________ hard  at  his  lessons  and  he _______ living  there.

七. 句型转换  13分

 1. He  watched  TV  for  two  hours  last  night. (划线提问)

   ______ _______ _______ he ______TV last  night?

 2. The  students  do sport  for  six  hours  every  week.        (同义替换)

    The students  do _____ _____ ______ sport every day.

 3. My sister   often  goes  to  school  late. (划线提问)

   ______ ______ ______your  sister______ to school late?

 4.She is  going to  do  sport  tomorow (用two days  ago改写)

   She ________ ________ two  days  ago.

八. 情景对话.  4分

(   )1. I' m going  to Paris  with  my  parents.

       A. Have a good  time        B. Good--bye

       C. OK                     D. Please  go

(   )2. Are  you  going to  be away  for  long? 

       No, _____

       A. Three days ago          B. Only  a day  or  two

       C. In  three  days           D. After  a  week

(   )3. --- How often  do  you  go  to  the  park? 

       --- ______

       A. Ten days               B. One  time

       C. For  six  days          D. Aften  a  month

(   )4. Is  there  a station  near  here ?

       A. There  is .

       B. No,  there  isn' t . 

         The  nearest  one  is  about 5  kilometres.

       C. The  police  office  is  on  the  left  side.

       D. The  station  isn' t  here.

初二英语Unit15 — Unit16测试

一、选出划线部分读音与所给词划线读音相同的词10%

(   )1. Message  A. cinema   B. moment   C.telephone  D. enough

(   )2. phone    A. moment  B.on        C.come       D.mother

(   )3. pleasure   A. great      B.bread     C.meat       D.please

(   )4. way       A. Friday     B.Sunday   C.Monday    D. today

(   )5. then      A. think      B.than      C. thind       D. three

(   )6. summer   A.June       B. conductor C.duty      D. full

(   )7. answer    A.last        B.lake        C.station    D.watch

(   )8. food      A.foot        B.took       C.good      D. cool

(   )9. health     A. mean      B.ready      C. reach     D. clean

(   )10. warm    A.harvest     B.start       C.quarter    D.March

二、词汇在空格上填入适当的词。10%

A: 1. There are ________ months  in  a  year.

   2. Everything  begins  to  grow in ________.

   3. What' s  the  weather ________  today?

   4. The  farmers  are  getting  ready---the next  year.

   5. " I _______ the  most  apples " ,  said  Li  Lei.

B:用括号内词的适当形式填空

   1. We _____ like to go  to the People' s Park.  (real)

   2. I enjoy _______ apples  on the  farm.     (pick)

   3. Which  season  do  you like ____, spring or  autumn.(well)

    4. In a  football team,  there  are eleven_______. (play)

    5. My mother _____ born in  1958.    (be)

三、选择 Choose  40%

(   )1. —When' s winter in  China ?

       —It' s  from  about______.

     A. October  to  December.    

     B. November  to  January.

     C. December  to  February.

     D. November  to  February.

(   )2. It's  very cold outside.  You need  to ____warm  clothes

     A. put on    B. wear      C. have      D. get

(   )3. Which____of  China  did you  live in last year?

     A. City        B. Part       C. town      D. country

(   )4. It' s  late  autumn.  It____colder  and  colder.

     A. gets         B. turns     C. is  getting   D. is turning

(   )5. In summer  ,  young  people often ____.

     A. go to swim  B. go and  swim    C. go  swimming

(   )6. The football  game____ two  hous  last night.

     A.lasted        B. lasts       C. last.

(   )7. Children in  the  country(农村)often  help their parents___         the harvest.

     A. at        B. in      C. with     D. to

(   )8. Excuse me ,  ____you  show  me the  way t o the  station?

     A.Must      B. May     C. Could    D. Need

(   )9. Will  you  please help  me?

    A. Certainly           B. Very  well ,  thanks

    C. It  doesn' t  matter     D. It' s  a  pleasure

(   )10. It' s ____  hard  work , but  we enjoy it. 

      A. the        B.a        C. an       D. /

(   )11. —Hello, ____?   

        —Yes ,  This is  Li  Lei.

       A. Are you  Li  Lei?         B. who are you?

      C. Is that  Li  Lei ?          D. Is  this  Li  Lei?

(   )12. Hello!  Could  I  speak ___lily?

      A. to          B. for         C. on      D. in

(   )13. —Could  I  speak to  Jim,  please?

        —I' m  afraid he' s out now.  Can I ____  a message?

      A. give        B. bring         C. take       D. keep

(   )14. There ____ a  lot of  people in  the next room.

      A. were        B. is           C. are        D. was

(   )15. The opposite of  "Cheap"   is _____.

      A. little        B. much        C. many      D. clear

(   )16. I  want to  show  the photo ____ you .

      A. for         B. to           C. on         D. in

(   )17. Could  you  ask  him ____me , please?

      A. ring         B. rang        C. to ring      D. ringing

(   )18. Summer  comes _____spring .

      A. before       B. behind        C. after        D. back

(   )19. Now  I can ____-some  English .

      A. tell          B. talk           C.speak        D. say

(   )20. In Autumn the  days  get ___and  the nights get___.

      A. long---short        B. short---long 

      C. longer---shorter         D. shorter---longer

四、补全反 意问句  5%

 1. It; s  very cloudy  today, _____  ______ ?

 2. Your  aunt  is  from  Guang  dong, _____  ______?

 3. The  twins  can' t  speak  Chinese, _________  ________?

 4. Li  Lei  likes  English, _________  _________?

 5. There  was  no people  in the  room, _______  _______?

五、在下列空格中填入划线词的反义词。8%

 1. The days  get  longer in  summer .

    The days get  _______ in winter.

 2. There' s  an  easy  question.   That is a  _______ question.

 3. My father came back from Paris  last  week.

   He is  going to Paris ________ month.

 4. The coldest season is  winter.   

   The ______  season is  Summer.

 5. Please take off  your  warm clothes.

   You need to _____  ______  ______clothes.

 6. Please  stand _____here,  Please  sit  down  there.

六. 根据短文写出电话留言.

     Ann  rings  up on  a Saturday evening.  She wants to  speak to Lily.  lily is  out at the  moment. Lucy  takes a  message.  When Lily comes back, Lucy tells  her, "Ann  wants  you to  go to the  zoo in  the  park  on  Sunday  morning. "

①电话留言___________      ②From: _________

③To :______________        ④Time: __________

⑤Message:_________         ⑥_______________

七. 阅读理解

      Mr  Knott  worked in  a big  school  in London.  His  home  was far  from the school.  So he  was  usually very  tired(累)when he  got home.  One  evening he  went to bed  very  early. But  after a little  time  the telephone rang.  SO he  got out  of  his bed , picked up  the telephone and  said , "Hello.  Who' s speaking, please?"

     " Watt, " a  man  answered.

      "May I have your name ,  please?" said Mr  Knott.

      "Watt's   my  name ," was  the answer.   

"Yes ,  I asked you  that.  What' s your  name?" Mr  Knott  said  again. " I  told you  .  Watt' s  my name,"  said the  other man,  "Are you  Jack  Smith?"

   "No ,  I' m not , " ansererd  Mr  Knott.

    " Will you give  me  your name , please? said Mr  Watt.

    " Will Knott ,"  answered  Mr Knott.

    Both  Mr  Watt and  Mr Will Knott put  their  telephone down angrily(生气地)and thought, "That' s a  rude (无理的)foolish愚蠢 man ! "

根据短文内容,选择正确答案。

1. Mr  Knott  was a ____.

   A. wouder.    B. farmer     C. teacher    D. student.

2. He  lived ____ the  school .

   A. far  from   B. near      C. in         D. next to

3. When  the telephone rang, he  was _____.

   A. at school      B. on the way  home    C. in  bed

4. When  Mr  Knott  asked  " Who' s speaking,  please? " _____

   A. the other man  told  him his  name is  Watt.

   B. the other man  didn' t  understand理解 him.

  C. the other man  asked what' s Mr  Knott' s name.

   D. the other man  didn't  answer.

5. Both  Mr Watt  and Mr  Will  Knott put  their telephone  down     angrily  because ________ .

   A. Mr  Watt didn' t  understand  Mr Will  Knott.

   B. Mr Will  Knott  didn' t understand  Mr  Watt.

   C. Both  of  them  didn' t  understand  each other互相

   D. they  didn' t  know each other.

  八、完型填空。 10%

B: Good  afternoon ,  Mr Black  . (1)_____ Black.

L: Good  afternoon,  Mr Black . This is  Lucy ,  May I  speak to      Ann,  please?

B: Sorry ,  she (2)_____ right now.  She went out  shopping  with    her mother half  an  hour  (3)____ and  they aren' t back now.

L: Could you  take  a message  (4)____ her , please?

B: Gertainly.

L: Thank you ,  Ann  asked me  (5)____ to  the  cinema.

   With  her  this  evening .  But  (6)____ I  can' t.

B: What' s the matter?

L: My parents and  I  (7)____ going to  the  airport飞机场. to      meet  my  uncle.  He' s  returning 返回   (8)____ Japan  this     evening.

B:  (9)____ to hear that. Please  give  my  best  wishes to  your       uncle. 给你叔我最好的祝愿

L:  Thanks   a  lot  . Please tell  Ann  (10)____ it.

B: OK.

(   )1. A.That is      B. This  is    C. It is      D. I a m

(   )2. A. is  in       B.isn't out    C. is  at home  D. is out

(   )3. A. ago         B. before       C. later      D. after

(   )4. A.to          B.with         C. at        D.for

(   )5. A. to          B. went        C. to go    D. going

(   )6. A. I' m  sorry         B. I' m glad高兴

       C. I' m   afraid        D. I' m  sure

(   )7. A. are          B. is           C. was      D. were

(   )8. A. to           B. down       C. for       D. from

(   )9. A.I' m sorry           B. I' m glad.

       C. I' m well           D. I' m  afraid

(   )10. A. about       B. on       C. do        D. to  do

初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

第十七单元(65——68课)试卷

一. 找出划线部分的读音与其他三个不同的词: 10%

(   )1. A. touch      B. cloud     C. found      D. round

(   )2. A. windy      B. why      C. dry       D. July

(   )3. A. give        B. wind     C. ticket     D. bright

(   )4. A. ready    B. pleasure    C. head    D. mean

(   )5. A. may     B. day     C. Monday     D. today

(   )6. A. father      B. they      C. then      D. thin

(   )7. A. how      B. town      C. snow     D. down

(   )8. A. present      B. sunny     C. strong      D. yourself

(   )9. A. lot     B. front      C. dog     D. stop

(   )10. A. ear     B. wear      C. hear      D. near

二. 按要求变换下列各词: 18%

    A. 把下列词变为形容词:

       1. sun ________   2. rain ________    3. wind _______

       4. cloud _______  5. snow _______   6. friend _______  

    B. 把下列词变为副词:

       1. easy ________  2. heavy ________  3. strong ________

       4. bright _______  5. quick _________  6. careful ________

    C. 把下列词变为名词:

   1. teach ________  2. work ________  3. drive ________

   4. read ________   5. write ________  6. think ________

三. 选择填空: 20%

(   )1. What' s the weather ______ today?

       A. like    B. is like    C. is liking    D. likes

(   )2. Summer ______ spring.

       A. comes after         B. comes in   

       C. comes before        D. goes on to

(   )3. We can' t go  out . There is too _____ ice.

       A. little      B. a little      C. many     D. much

(   )4.“What' s the  date today?”“It' s _____.”

        A. Jume 1      B. Monday    C. January    D. summer

(   )5. Thanks ____ giving  us so much help.

       A. to    B. by    C. in    D. for

(   )6. _____ a good teacher Mr  Wang is!

       A. How      B. What     C. Who    D. Which

(   )7.“_____ late for  the meeting.”said Mr  Green.

       A. Not be   B. Be not   C. Don' t be   D. Do be  not

(   )8. We are going to _____ a football match.

       A. see     B. watch     C. look at      D. look

(   )9.“_____ do you  write to your friend?”

    A. How often   B. How many   C. How much   D. How long

(   )10. He' s ______than  his brother.

       A. much strong          B. more strong

       C. much stronger         D. more stronger

(   )11. Look! _____ white  and beautiful snow!

        A. How      B. What      C. Which     D. Why

(   )12. October is near. It _____ colder.

        A. are going to  be    B. got    C. gets   D. is going to  be

(   )13. There ____ too ____ ink  in the bottle.

        A. are , many   B. is , lot of    C. is , much  D. are , lots of

(   )14. The strdents are  picking the apples. ____ hard they' re             working!

         A. How      B. Very     C. What     D. So

(   )15. Bruce ____ up his father on  the telephone last Friday.

        A. rang    B. rings    C. is ringing   D. is  going to  ring

(   )16. The boy is  drawing a plane ___.He is  always ___like that.

        A. careful , careful          B. carefully , careful

        C. careful , carefully         D. carefully , carefully

(   )17. Last year the  farmers had a  good harvest _____ much of         China.

        A. in     B. on     C. at     D. from

(   )18. It' s a beautiful picture, ______?

        A. is it     B. isn' t it     C. does it     D. doesn' t  it

(   )19. Can you pass me  the photo , please? ________.

        A. Yes. Here it is        B. Yes. Here are you

        C. Yes. Here you are    D. Yes. You are here

(   )20. The boys are  up ______ at the party.

        A. all the food         B. all  the foods

        C. the all food         D. the all foods   

四. 补全对话: 15%

    刘梅在外地. 一天她要去邮局, 不知道怎么走, 她向警察问路. 请根据这一情景完成下列对话.

Liu Mei : _______ _______, _______ is  the post office?

Policeman : Just  go ______ this road and ______ the sixth _______            on the right. Then you  can ______ it.

Liu Mei : ______ ______ is it?

Policeman : About  four kilometres. I think you' d _______ _______            a bus.

Liu Mei : _______ ________ do I need?

Policeman : The  No·56 bus.

Liu Mei : Thank you very much.

Policeman : You _______ ________.

五. 用所给动词的正确形式填空: 17%, 每空1分

1. There ______ (be) only one  school in my  hometown ten years     ago, but now there _______ (be) five ones.

2. It ____ (be) very  hot in summer in  Nanning.

3. My mother ______ (go) to the fruit shop _____ (buy) some fruit.

4. Mum _____ (be) busy _______ (sweep) the floor. Could you ____   (get) some water for  her?

5. The  farmers _________ (have) a  good harvest this autumn. They   ______(write) to us last Monday and _____(ask) us _____ (help)   them to  pick oranges.

6. Last  month most of  us ______(go) to the farm and _____(help)   the farmers ______ (pick) oranges. We all ______ (enjoy) ______

   (work) there.

六. 阅读理解: 20%

(A)

    Tom was  a boy. One day  his mother went out  for dinner. Before she  left, she said to  Tom, “Tom, I' m going out  for dinner. Stay near the  door and watch it  all the time!”

     Tom sat down beside the  door. After an hour, one of  his uncles came and  asked, “Where' s your mother?”“At a  dinner.”Tom answered.“Well, ”said his  uncle.“We' re going to  visit your house this evening. Go and  tell your mother.”

     Then his uncle went away. Tom thought,“My mother said ' watch the  door all the  time' , and uncles said ' go and  tell your mother '.”He thought and  thought. At last he  pulled down the  door , put it in  the back and  went to look for  his mother.

根据短文内容判断正误, 对的打“√”,错的打“×”.

(   )1. One day Tom' s mother went to  have dinner.

(   )2. Tom sat down beside the  door all the  time.

(   )3. Tom' s uncle  went  to see his  family.

(   )4. Tom put the  door on the  back and sat  still.

(   )5. Tom was a  clever boy.

(B)

Mark Twain(马克·吐温) was an American writer. One day  he went to  a city by  train. He wanted to  see one of  his  friends there. He was  a very busy man. He usually fougot something.

When he was  in the train, the  conductor (列车员) asked him  for his ticket. Mark Twain looked for  the ticket here and  there, but he couldn' t find it. The conductor knew Mark Twain. She said,“Show me  your ticket on  your way back. And if  you can' t, it doesn' t matter.”

“Oh, but it does,”said Mark Twain.“I must find the  ticket. If I can' t find it, how can  I know where I' m going?”

(   )1. Mark Twain was  a ______.

       A. teacher    B. student     C. doctor    D. writer

(   )2. Mark Twain went to  a city _____.

       A. by plane   B. by car   C. by train   D. by ship

(   )3. He went to  the city to _________.

       A. see his friend       B. buy some paper

       C. sell his books       D. see his parents

(   )4. When he was  in the train, the conductor asked him              for ______.

       A. some books        B. the ticket  

       C. a pen             D. some food

(   )5. Mark Twain didn' t show his  ticket because he                   couldn' t ______ it. 

        A. buy     B. find     C. look for    D. know

初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

第十八单元(69—72课)试卷

一. 找出划线部分的读音不同于其他三个的词: 5%

(   )1. A. start      B. warm       C. party    D. park

(   )2. A. cleaner   B. head        C. ready    D. weather

(   )3. A. chair     B. sandwich    C. China    D. machine

(   )4. A.face      B. plate         C. later      D. last

(   )5. A. touch    B. about        C. round    D. cloud

二. 按括号中的要求写出相应的形式: 20%

1. wind (形容词)__________  2. tell (过去式)__________

3. shine (现在分词)________  4. country (复数)_________

5. strong (副词)___________   6. clean (名词)___________

7. hot (比较级)___________   8. write (同音词)_________

9. begin (同义词)__________  10. laugh (反义词)_________

三. 选择填空: 15%

(   )1. I' m sorry _______ that.

       A. hearing    B. to hear    C. heard    D. hear

(   )2. There' s going to _____ a party on  Sunday.

       A. be      B. to have     C. are    D. is

(   )3. Lucy likes reading English. ______.

       A. I do so   B. And I  do   C. So do I   D. Do I  so

(   )4. My uncle ______ last year.

       A. comes here          B. came to here

       C. comes to here        D. came here

(   )5. There is only ____ milk in  the glass.

       A. few      B. a few    C. little     D. a little

(   )6. Don' t forget _______ the door when you  leave.

       It' s windy this evening.

       A. close      B. to close      C. closing    D. closed

(   )7.“Would you  love to go  swimming with me?”

      “________.”

        A. Yes, I would           B. No, I wouldn' t love

        C. No, I wouldn' t go      D. Yes, I would love to

(   )8. Thanks a lot _____ me so  much help.

       A. for give    B. to give    C. for giving   D. to give

(   )9. I' ll give ______ the message.

       A. he      B. her      C. she      D. they

(   )10. ____ nice the present is !

        A. Where      B. Why     C. What      D. How

(   )11. All the  food ______ on the table.

        A. were      B. was     C. are      D. being

(   )12. You had better _____ the tickets this evening.

   A. to find   B. find   C. finding   D. is going to  find

(   )13. —Thank you  for telling me  the whole thing.

        —_______.

        A. That' s great           B. Don' t say like that

        C. It doesn' t matter      D. That' s all right

(   )14. The best time ___ to Beijing to  spend your holiday                is in autumn.

(   )15. —I may  be a little late for  the party.

        —________.

        A. That' s great      B. Thank you

        C. That' s  right       D. That' s all right

 四. 按要求变化下列各句: 10%, 每空1分.

1. We  had a good time yesterday. (改为一般疑问句)

   _____ you ______ a good time yesterday?

2. His  mother did the  housework last Sunday. (改为否定句)

   His mother ______ ______ the housework last Sunday.

3. Did  your brother go  to the shop? (肯定回答)

   ______ , ______  ______.

4. He  has a very nice watch. (改为感叹句)

   ______ ______ ______ watch  he has !

五. 用所给词的正确形式填空: 10%

1. He' s __________ (play) football with us.

2. There  are one hundred _________ (teacher) in our  school.

3. Could  you ask _________ (she) to have the  party, please.

4. Don' t  watch TV. It' s time ___________ (have) supper.

5. They __________ (go) to the  park last week.

6. It' s ____________ (cloud), isn' t it?

7. Her  brother writes ___________ (careful).

8. What  are they ____________(do) this afternoon?

9. His father ___________ (mend) the bike now.

10. I can' t __________ (carry) the box. It' s too heavy.

六. 完形填空: 20%

One day Jack went to  a big dinner party. His  1  wasn' t good. When he  went in, no one   2  him and  no one gave him  3 food. He was  very  4  , so he  went   5  , put on  his best coat, and then came back to   6  party. Everyone stood up  at once and  came to meet him. He was  taken to the  7  table, and the  other guests gave him  the best food. Then Jack put  his coat in  the food and  said, “Please eat, dear coat.”The other guests were  very  surprised and said,“Why are  you doing this?”

Jack  answered,“When I  came here   8  , nobody noticed me   9  gave me  food. After I changed my  coat, and came, you gave me  the best food. So you  gave this food to  my coat, not to    10  !”

(   )1. A. clothes     B. trousers     C. coat      D. hand

(   )2. A. saw      B. wanted     C. looked      D. looked at

(   )3. A. any        B. some        C. not      D. no

(   )4. A. happy      B. angry       C. angrily    D. afraid

(   )5. A. to home    B. home    C. at home    D. in home

(   )6. A. a          B. the      C. an             D. ×

(   )7. A. good      B. well     C. better     D. best

(   )8. A. first      B. last    C. at last     D. again

(   )9. A. nor     B. then    C. but         D. or

(   )10. A. it      B. mine      C. me       D. them

七. 阅读理解: 20%

(A)

Mr Jones was  very angry with his  wife, and she was  very angry with her  husband. For several days they did  not speak to  each other at  all. One evening Mr  Jones was very tired when he  came back from work, so he  went to bed soon after dinner. Of course, he did  not say anything to  Mrs Jones before he  went upstairs. Mrs Jones washed the  dinner things and  then did some sewing. When she  went up to  bed much later than her  husband, she found a  piece of paper on  the small table near her  bed. On it wre  the words.“Mother. —Wake me  up at 7 a. m.——Father.”

When Mr Jones woke up  the next morning, it was  nearly 8 a. m. —and on the  small table near his  bed he saw  another piece of  paper. He took it  and read these words:“Father.—Wake up. It is  7 a. m.——Mother.”

根据短文内容判断正误: 对的打“√”, 错的打“×”.

(   )1. Mr and Mrs  Jones didn' t speak to  each other for                several  days.

(   )2. Mr Jones went to  bed because he  was angry.

(   )3. Mrs Jones left home after dinner.

(   )4. She got up  very late the  next morning.

(   )5. Her child wrote a  piece of paper to  her.

(B) Writing  a Letter

Mary is a  little girl. She is  only five. She does not  go to school, and of  course, she does not  know how to read and  write. But her sister, Kate is  schoolgirl. She is ten.

One day, Kate sees her  little sister at  the table  and  there is a  pen in her  hand and a  piece of paper in  front of her.

“What are you  doing, Mary?”she asks.

“I' m writing a  letter to my  friend Kitty,”says Mary.

“But how can  you?”says her  sister.“You don' t know how  to  write.”

“Well,”says Mary.“It doesn' t matter,  because Kitty doesn' t know how  to read.”

(   )1. Does Mary know how  to read and  write?

       A. Yes.   B. No.  C. She knows a  little.  D. Not sure.

(   )2. Mary' s sister ________.

       A. is five              B. is younger than Mary

       C. is not a  student     D. is ten years old

(   )3. One day, Mary ________.

       A. is drawing a  picture      B. is doing her  homework

       C. is sitting  on the  table    D. is ten years old

(   )4. Mary' s friend, Kitty, is _______.

       A. ten years old          B. five  

       C. a student             D. not a student 

(   )5. You think Mary is ________.

       A. warm-heartec (热心的)     B. ten years old

       C. very interesting (有趣的)   D. stupid (笨的)

初中英语素质测试卷集 (第二册)

第十九单元(73—76课)试卷

一. 找出下列各组单词划线部分的读音与所给单词划线部          分的读音相同的单词: 5%

(   )1. says    A. really    B. easy      C. ready    D. great

(   )2. stopped  A. played   B. mended   C. started  D. looked

(   )3. country   A. south    B. young   C. house   D. brought

(   )4. north    A. word    B. work    C. worse    D. report

(   )5. shop    A. stop      B. most     C. son      D. go

二. 写出下列动词的过去式: 12%

1. speak ________   2. swim ________  3. wear ________

4. grow ________   5. buy ________    6. clean ________

7. ride ________    8. hold ________    9. worry ________

10. stand _________  11. bring ________  12. put ________

三选择填空: 20%

(   )1. Please write it  down ______ your paper.

       A. on    B. in     C. /    D. with

(   )2. Is there a  telephone call _____ me ?

       A. to     B. for     C. with    D. by

(   )3. Will you please_____the picture here  tomorrow?

       A. take     B. bring     C. pick     D. need

(   )4. I like _____ in summer.

       A. swam    B. swim     C. swimming    D. swims

(   )5. Picking apples is _______.

       A. a hard work            B. hard work

       C. a very hard work        D. hard works

(   )6. It never gets too _____ here.

        A. hoter     B. hotter    C. the hottest     D. hot

(   )7. You are  from China, ______?

        A. are you            B. aren' t you  

        C. are you not         D. don' t you

(   )8. We really enjoy ______ TV on  Sundays.

       A. to watch     B. watch     C. watching    D. to see

(   )9. Yesterday there was  a ___rain.That means it  rained__.

       A. heavy , heavily        B. heavy , heavy

       C. heavily , heavy         D. heavily , heavily

(   )10. It is _____ today. The ____ is blowing hard.

        A. windy , wind          B. wind , wind

        C. windy , windy         D. wind , windy

(   )11. Will the meeting _______ long?

        A. last for    B. last   C. goes to   D. finish

(   )12. _____ bad weather we  have today !

       A. What    B. What a    C. How    D. How a

(   )13. Canada is _____ the north of  the USA.

        A. in      B. to      C. on      D. at

(   )14. Nanjing is _____ the southwest of  Jiangsu.

        A. in     B. to     C. on    D. at

(   )15. Class begins. Please stop _______.

        A. talk    B. to talk    C. talking    D. talked

(   )16. What time ______ we meet ?

        A. will      B. shall     C. would      D. could

(   )17. The TV set  looks _____ better now.

        A. much     B. too    C. very     D. many

(   )18. The radio _____ that it will be  sunny tomorrow.

        A. saying    B. will say   C. says    D. say

(   )19. I want to  watch TV now. Could you _____?

        A. turn on it          B. take it  on

        C. to turn it  on       D. turn it on

(   )20. You' ll stay here long, ______?

        A. won' t you         B. doesn' t it

        C. won' t it           D. don' t you

四. 用所给动词的正确形式填空: 14%, 每空1分.

1. He usually _______ (play) football on Friday afternoon.

2. Let' s ________ (meet) outside the  park gate.

3. They _______ (go) to the  zoo last Sunday and ________         (have) a good time.

4. Mrs Green ________ (like) wearing green dresses. But now         she _______ (wear) a  red dress.

5. Where ________ your mother _________ (work)?

6. I _______ (go) to  see my friend the  day after tomorrow.

7. Jack _______ (do) his homework this evening.

8. Lucy _______(be) on duty yesterday.

9. My father _______ (leave) home early this morning.

10. —______ the snow ________ (stop) soon?

   —Yes, I think so.

五. 按要求变换下列各句: 24%, 每空1分.

1. There will be  a meeting this afternoon. (改为一般疑问句)

   ______ there _______ a  meeting this afternoon?

2. I  think she is  free now. (改为否定句)

   I ________ think she _________ free now.

3. They  went to the  farm last week. (改为反意疑问句)

   They went to  the farm last week, ________ _________?

4. Mr Green came to China three years ago.(就划线部分提问)

   ______ ______ Mr. Green _______ to China?

5. It' s  raining now. (改用tomorrow为时间状语)

   It _______ _______ tomorrow.

6. The  radio is very old. (改为感叹句)

   ______ ______ the radio is !

7. We  shall go shopping this afternoon. (就划线部分提问)

   ______ ______ we ______ this  afternoon?

8. There  was a letter for  yor. (改为复数形式)

   ______ ______ _______ letters  for you.

9. He  went to bed  at ten last night. (改为否定句)

   He _______ _______ to bed  at ten last night.

10. My  sister gave me  a book for  my birthday.(就划线部分         提问)

    ______ ______ your sister ______you for  your birthday?

六. 完形填空: 10%

Dear Mary,

How are you? It is  very kind of  you to write to  me. From your letter I  know a lot   1  you  and your school. Now let  me  2 you  something about me  and our school.

I' m in  3  , Gradi Two of  the No. 3 Middle School. Every morning I  get  4  early and  5  English aboud(高声地). I like it  very much.

Our  school is very large. It' s very beautiful, too. It 6 about 2,000 students and  170. teachers. The  teachers and students  7 hard. We know we  are working  8  the  people. It is spring now. Please come and   9  a  look  10  our  school.

                                            yours,

                                            Wei Fang

(   )1. A. from    B. about     C. of    D. to

(   )2. A. put      B. give    C. speak     D. tell

(   )3. A. Class Three         B. Three Class  

       C. class three          D. three class

(   )4. A. off     B. down    C. on         D. up

(   )5. A. say    B. talk    C. read          D. tell

(   )6. A. have    B. has    C. there are    D. is

(   )7. A. play     B. read    C. work       D. write

(   )8. A. to       B. on       C. at        D. for

(   )9. A. have    B. make     C. give      D. do

(   )10. A. after    B. for      C. at        D. to

七. 阅读理解: 15%

(A) On  the Train

One summer, Tom and John wanted to  visit another city. Both of  them bought the  tickets and got  into the train. In the  train John couldn' t find his  ticket in his  pockets. Tom found the  ticket on the  floor and picked it  up, but he didn' t tell John about it. He put  it into his  own pocket.

A short time later a  conductor(列车员) came. He wanted to  check the passengers, tickts. John was  very afraid. He had  to hide himself under his  seat. When the conductor came, Tom brought out  two tickets.

“Who is the  other?”asked the  conductor.

“My friend doesn' t like to  sit. He is just under his  seat.”Tom answered.

根据短文内容判断正误: 对的打“√”, 错的打“×”.

(   )1. Tom and John went to  another city by  bus.

(   )2. Both John and  Tom had tickets at  first.

(   )3. John put Tom' s ticket into his  pocket.

(   )4. John was very afraid because he  couldn' t bring out              his ticket.

(   )5. John didn' t like to  sit.

(B)

Miss  Jones was a  teacher. Her home was  not far from her  school, and she always walked there in  the morning. All the  students in the  school were very young.

She walked to  school on a  very cold and  windy morning in  winter, and the cold wind went into her  eyes, and big tears(眼泪)began running out  of them. She reached the  school, opened the door and  went into the  classroom. It was nice and  warm there and  Miss Jones was  happy. But then a  small boy looked at  her for a  minute, put his arm  around her and  said,“Don' t cry(哭). School isn' t very bad.”

(   )1. It was _____ from Miss Jones' s home to  her school.

       A. a long way   B. far away   C. not far   D. far

(   )2. Miss Jones usually went to  school ______.

       A. by bus   B. by bike   C. by car   D. on foot

(   )3. The story happened(发生) on a _____ morning.

       A. rainy    B. nice    C. warm   D. cold and windy

(   )4. When the small boy  saw tears in  his teacher' s eyes,             he was sure ______.

       A. she was happy      B. she didn' t like school

       C. there was something wrong with her  eyes

       D. she didn' t like the  bad weather

(   )5. From the passage we  learned that ______.

      A. Miss Jones doesn' t love her  students

       B. the students didn' t love Miss Jones at  all

      C. Miss Jones her  students and the  students loved her

      D. the students didn' t love their class

初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

第二十单元(77—80课)试卷

一. 找出其划线部分的读音与其他三个不同的词: 10%

(   )1. A. chips     B. school    C. lunch       D. catch

(   )2. A. cold      B. show     C. road         D. above

(   )3. A. beef      B. meat     C. ready        D. piece

(   )4. A. tomato    B. warm    C. laugh        D. half

(   )5. A. south      B. town    C. found        D. below

(   )6. A. leg        B. dialogue   C. cabbage    D. dog

(   )7. A. sell        B. sugar     C. salt          D. set

(   )8. A. finished   B. called    C. closed      D. answered

(   )9. A. ear        B. wear     C. hear          D. near

(   )10. A. they      B. feather    C. then          D. thin

二. 按括号中的要求写出相应的形式: 10%

1. carry (现在分词)_________  2. beautiful (最高级)________

3. radio (复数)________        4. worse (原级)_________

5. popular (比较级)_________  6. fry (形容词)_________

7. take (过去式)_________      8. potato (复数)_________

9. busy (反义词)_________    10. run (现在分词)_________

三. 选择填空: 20%

(   )1. I like Chinese ______ than English.

      A. more better           B. much better  

      C. most better            D. many better

(   )2. They asked me ____ help them____ do some cooking.

       A. with , to    B. to , /    C. /  , with      D. /  ,  /

(   )3. Put ____ in this bottle, please.

       A. a little salt            B. a few salt

       C. many salt             D. some salts

(   )4. We hope can  come _____ our house _____ supper                next Saturday.

       A. to , to     B. to , for     C. in, for     D. to , with

(   )5. Could you ______ me the  eraser, please?

       A. pass      B. take     C. turn     D. carry

(   )6. Would you _______ a cup  of tea, please?

       A. likes      B. liked      C. to like    D. like

(   )7. In _____ the most popular food is  fish and chips.

       A. England    B. America     C. China    D. Australia

(   )8. —The twins went to  the Great Wall last Sunday.

       —So ______ we.

       A. do     B. does    C. did      D. are

(   )9. I' d like English tea _____ sugar and  milk.

       A. in     B. on     C. with      D. to

(   )10. Give him _____ to eat, please.

        A. something delicious      B. delicious something

        C. anything delicious        D. delicious anything

(   )11. Do you want ____ beef ? No, thanks.

        A. some      B. a     C. another    D. others

(   )12. Could you pass _____ the box, please?

        A. I      B. my     C. mine      D. me

(   )13. I know she  often _____ bananas at home.

        A. have      B. has     C. had    D. having

(   )14. Which do you  like ____ , beef or pork?

         A. good      B. better    C. best     D. well

(   )15. Would you like ______ cake?

        A. other    B. the other    C. another    D. others

(   )16. —May I  ask you a  question? 

        —_______.

        A. I have no  time      B. No, don' t ask me

        C. I' m afraid not       D. No, you may not

(   )17. It took _____ only ten  minutes to walk  there.

        A. he      B. his    C. we    D. us

(   )18. Which is ______, this building or  that one?

        A. tall      B. taller    C. tallest    D. high

(   )19.“______ we finish our  homework today?”

       “Certainly.”

        A. Is     B. Shall     C. Are    D. Do

(   )20. Mary helps me ______ my lessons.

        A. do     B. does     C. doing    D. to doing  

四. 用所给动词的正确形式填空: 10%, 每空1分.

1. She __________ (come) this evening.

2. Sometimes  people _________ (cook) this  food at home.

3. My parents _________ (be) very busy last night.

4. What  lessons _______ you ________ (have) yesterday?

5. Mr  Black usually ________ (reach) his office early.

6. He ________ (buy) a new  book tomorrow.

7. ______ you _______ (do) your homework now?

8. They ________ (clean) their room this Sunday.

五. 完成对话, 每空一词: 10%, 每空1分.

Mum : Lingling!

Lingling : Yes, Mum?

Mum : Supper  is __________ now.

Lingling : I' m ______. Hello, Dad. Hello, Mum.

Mum : Sit  down, Lingling. _______ is  your rice.

Lingling : Thanks. Oh, there' s fish and  chicken! Meat, too!               Why so _________, Mum?

Mum : It' s  your daddy' s birthday!

Lingling : Oh! ________ birthday, Dad.

Dad : Thank  you, Lingling. _____ do  you like better, fish or              chicken?

Lingling : I  like fish better _______ chicken.

Dad : Help  yourself to ______ fish, please.

Lingling : Thank  you. It' s my _________.

Mum : Lingling, could you ______ me the  salt, pleast?

六. 就划线部分提问: 10%, 每空1分.

1. Everything  will be ready before lunch.

   ______ ______ everything  be ready?

2. She  felt happy because her  mother gave her  a very good         present.

   _______ _______ she feel happy?

3. I  like the bananas on the  table.

   _______ bananas _______ you  like?

4. Kate  often eats chicken at  home.

   _______ _______ Kate  often eat at  home?

5. Kate  often eats chickten at home.

   _______ _______ Kate  often eat chicken?

七. 用介词、副词填空: 10%

I turn  1  the  radio. It says the  sun will some 2  later. I like the  sun. I will wait for  Li Lei tomorrow morning. He will go  3   the cinema   4  me  5  nine  o' clock. The cinema is  not far  6  my  home, so we will go  there  7  foot. It woll be   8  at  ten thirty.   9 the film, we will go  to the park and  have a good rest there . We will not  go back home  10   four  o' clock. In the evening, we will watch TV  for two hours.

Tomorrow  we will be  happy because it  is Sunday. Would you  like to come and  play with us?

1. ______ 2. ______ 3. _______ 4. _______ 5. _______

6. ______ 7. ______ 8. _______ 9. _______ 10. ________

 八.阅读理解: 20%

(A) At  the Bus Stop

Tom' s  father was ill. It was  Saturday. Tom was on  the way to  the hospital to  see his father. The hospital was  very far away, so he  had to take a  bus.

When he got  to the bus  stop, he saw many people ther3e. They were standing in  line and waiting for  a bus. The bus  was late. Tom didn' t want to  wait in this queue. He went to  the front and  stood there.

One of the  people said to  him, “You mustn' t jump the  queue, boy.”

With a red  face Tom said sorry and  went to the  end of the  line. Soon the bus  came. All the people got  on the bus.

根据短文内容选择正误: 对的打“√”, 错的打“×”.

(   )1. Tom  was at  the bus stop to  see his father.

(   )2. A lot of  people were going to  take a bus  to the                 hospital.

(   )3. When he got  to the bus  stop, Tom wanted to  be the             first one to  get on the  bus.

(   )4. When Tom jumped the  queue, one of the  people                 pushed him back.

(   )5. Tom waited until another bus  came to the  stop.

(B)

Mr White had  a farm in  England. He and his  wife grew a  lot of things on  the farm. They worked very hard. One day, Mr White said to  his wife,“Dear, Let' s go to  London next Sunday. We can  have a good lunch there, and then we  can go to  the cinema.”His wife was  very happy when she  heard this, because she and her  husband always ate  a lot, and she  didn' t like cooking three times every day.

They  went to London by train and  walked for an hour. When it was  twelve o' clock, they wanted to  have a meal. They looked at  a few restaurants. In one  of them there was  a blackboard outside. On the  blackboard was“Lunch 12: 30 to  2 : 30, $ 1.50.”

“Well, that' s good,”Mrs White said.“We eat  for two hours for  $ 1.5 here! This is  the place for  us.”

(   )1. Mr White took his  wife to a  very ______ restaurant.

       A. dear      B. cheap     C. new    D. old

(   )2. Mrs White was  very happy because ______.

       A. she didn' t have to  cook  

       B. Mr. White ate  too much

       C. she couldn' t eat  much   

       D. they worked hard

(   )3. Mr and Mrs  White wanted to  see a film ______.

       A. before lunch          

       B. in the morning

       C. in the afternoon       

       D. in the restaurant

(   )4. The words on  the blackboard told people that _____.

       A. they must eat  a very slow lunch

       B. they must eat  for two hours

       C. they could have lunch anytime between 12 : 30                  and 2 : 30

        D. they must be  in the restaurant at 12 : 30 and                    leave at 2 : 30

(   )5. Mr White wanted to  go into the  restaurant because

       _______.

       A. they could eat  for a long time

       B. they could eat  quickly

       C. she was  in London    

       D. she was not  hungry

初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

期中检测试卷

一. 语音知识:

   A) 把划线部分读音不同开其他三个的一个指出来: 5%

(   )1. A. party    B. ask    C. warm    D. March

(   )2. A. play    B. may     C. says      D. stay

(   )3. A. matter    B. happy    C. candle    D. plate

(   )4. A. short    B. worse     C. form    D. sport

(   )5. A. street    B. mean    C. heavy    D. reach

(   )6. A. month    B. mother    C. weather    D. with

(   )7. A. bought    B. born    C. doctor    D. quarter

(   )8. A. waited    B. hoped    C. looked    D. stopped

(   )9. A. stops    B. plates    C. presents   D. radios

(   )10. A. below    B. snow    C. won' t    D. now

   B) 选择下列各组句子的正确语调: 5%

(   )1. —Did you  telephone Tom?

       —No, I didn' t.

       —Why not?

       —Because I  wasn' t free.

      A. 升降降降 B. 升升降降  C. 降升升降  D. 降降降升

(   )2. —Which do  you like better, fish or  meat?

      —I like fish better

      —But I  don' t like fish.

      —Really?

      A. 降降降升  B. 升降升降  C. 降升升降  D. 降降升降

(   )3.—I turned on  the TV and we sat down and watched it.

      —Did you  forget Grandma' s birthday?

      —What do  you think she  would like?

       —I am  not sure.

       A. 降升降降  B. 升升降降  C. 降升降升 D. 降降升升

(   )4. —How long have you  been in China?

       —I have been here for  three years.

       —Have you  learned any Chinese?

       —Yes, I have learned it  for three years.

       A. 降升降升  B. 降降升降  C. 升降降降 D. 降降降降

(   )5. —Jim, could you  help me, please?

       —Certainly, Lucy. What' s wrong?

       —It' s this kite. It' s broken.

       —Oh, nice kite. What a  pity!

       A. 升降降陈  B. 升升降降  C. 升降降升 D. 降降降降

二. 词汇知识:

    A) 选择正确的选项, 使单词完整、正确: 5%

(   )1. north ___ st    A. au     B. ae    C. ea    D. ee

(   )2. sun ___ ine    A. ch     B. ge    C. sh    D. th

(   )3. sou ___    A. ch     B. ge    C. ng    D. th

(   )4. w ___ k    A. ol    B. oa     C. ou    D. al

(   )5. enou ___    A. th    B. gh    C. ch    D. sh

    B) 按括号中的要求写出相应的形式: 5%

1. get (现在分词)__________    2. easy (副词)__________

3. sit (现在分词)___________    4. stop (过去式)________

5. sandwich (复数)__________   6. long (比较级)_________

7. worry (形容词)___________   8. play (名词)___________

9. radio (复数)_________  10. fry (第三人称单数形式)_____

    C) 从A、B、C、D中找出与句中划线部分意思相近的             选项: 5%

(   )1. They liked the  Chinese food.

       A. were like   B. enjoyed   C. looked like   D. looked

(   )2. The fish is  delicious.

       A. beautiful           B. take away food

       C. very good to  eat    D. very good to  look  at

(   )3. I have a lot  of work to  do.

       A. many    B. much     C. little    D. a few

(   )4. It will be  cloudy at times.

    A. all the time   B. every time   C. sometimes   D. time

(   )5. She isn' t here now.

      A. at the moment   B. then   C. at that time   D. today

三. 选择填空: 10%

(   )1. May I _____ Mr  Jim?

       A. say to   B. tell to    C. speak to    D. talk

(   )2. Thank you ______ me to  the party.

       A. for asking  B. to ask  C. with asking  D. of asking

(   )3. The radio looks ______ better now.

       A. very      B. qute     C. much     D. more

(   )4. Which do you  like better, fish _____ meat?

       A. and     B. or     C. but    D. than

(   )5. The cats climbed the  tree _______.

       A. very quick    B. carefully    C. careful    D. quick

(   )6. Can you lift the _____ box?

       A. heavily    B. strongly    C. heavy    D. brightly

(   )7. Could you ask  him _____ me, please?

        A. call      B. calling    C. to call    D. called

(   )8. Not everyone ______ sandwiches.

       A. like      B. likes    C. liked     D. liking

(   )9. Which do you  like _____, pork or beef?

        A. most      B. best     C. well     D. better

(   )10. ________ good  idea !

        A. How      B. How a    C. What   D. What

(   )11. There are many apples _____ the tree.

        A. on    B. to     C. for     D. in

(   )12. There are a  lot of birds ______ the tree.

         A. on    B. to    C. for     D. in

(   )13. _____ the weather like in  the USA now?

        A. What' s    B. What    C. How    D. Which

(   )14. Please ______ the TV.

        A. open   B. turn on   C. put on   D. turn down it

(   )15. You come from England, ______ you?

        A. isn' t    B. aren' t    C. don' t     D. doesn' t

(   )16. A friend _____ me a  beautiful picture yesterday.

        A. give     B. gives     C. giving    D. gave

(   )17. Jim will be  back in _______ hour.

        A. a     B. an    C. the     D. /

(   )18. Would you like ___ swimming with me  tomorrow ?

        A. go    B. to go    C. going    D. went

(   )19. When the bus  stopped, the woman ____ the bus.

         A. got on   B. got in   C. got up    D. get into

(   )20. Give me _____ bread, please.

         A. little     B. a little    C. few     D. a few

四. 用括号中词语的正确形式填空: 5%

1. The  young people talked and  laughed _______. They  were        very _______. ( happy , happily)

2. What a _________ monkey! It runs and  climbs trees very         __________. ( quick , quickly)

3. The work is  very _______.  We can  do it _______. (easy,         easily)

4. Look  at the ________! It' s________ today. ( sun , sunny)

5. The  old man is  quite _________. He  often crosses the            road_________. (careful , carefully)

五. 按要求完成下列句子:

   A)完成对话, 每空一词: 10%

Ann : Hello !  May I  1   to  Jim, please?

Jim : Hello !   2   is  Jim. Is  3  Ann,  please?

Ann: Yes. Hi ,  Jim!

Jim : Hi , Ann!

Ann : Jim, thanks  a lot for   4  me  to your party. I' d  5  to             come.

Jim : Great!

Ann : It  starts at four thirty ,  6  it?

Jim : Yes, that' s   7  .

Ann : OK. But  I' m  8  I  may be a   9  later.

Jim : That' s  OK. It   10  matter.

Ann : All  right. See you.

Jim : See  you. Bye!

1. ______ 2. _______ 3. _______ 4. _______ 5. _______

6. ______ 7. _______ 8. _______ 9. _______ 10. ______

B) 对句子划线部分进行提问: 5%

1. Ann  went  to  see  Jim  because  he  was  ill.

   ___________   _________  Ann  go  to  see  Jim ?

2. The  TV  set  looks  like  the  box .

   ___________   _________ the  TV  set  look  like ?

3. Everything  was  ready  at  ten.

   __________   _________ was  everything  ready?

4. They  saw  Tom  in  the  park  three  times  last  week .

   ______   _________ times  did  they  see  Tom  in  the          park  last  week ?

5. I  met  her  in  the  Zoo  a  moment  ago .

   _______   __________ you  meet  her  a  moment  ago ?

C) 情景反应 :5%

(   )1. "_________?"  "It's  June 3."

    A. What's  the  day  today    B. What's  the  date  today          C. What  day  is  today        D. What  time  is  now

(   ) 2. "______?"  "It's  ten  yuan  a  kilo."

    A. How  much  is  it        B. How  many  is  it

    C. What  is  it              D. How  is  it

(   )3. "What's  the  weather  like  today ?"  "_______."

     A. Very   well            B. Yes , it's  good

     C. It's  well              D. It's  fine

(   )4. "Thank  you ."  "_________."

     A. Not  thanks            B. No at  all 

     C. That's  right             D. I'm  glad  to  hear  it

(   )5. "Is  that  Jim ?"  "____________."

      A. Yes , I  am              B. No , I'm  not

      C. Yes , it  is               D. Hello

六. 用所给动词的正确形式填空: 6%

   1. Why ______(not  go ) to  the  park  with  your  sister ?

   2. Listen , someone ________(sing ) in  the  next  room .

   3. Where _______ they _______ (go) next  Sunday ?

   4. We ________(not  come) to  school  yesterday .

   5. Don't _______ (open) the  window ,  the  wind _______            (be) strong . 

   6. She  usually ______(go) to  school  at  seven , but                this morning she ____ (go) to school  at  half  past  six

   7. When  the  teacher  came  into  the  classroom , we  all            stopped __________(talk).

   8. What ________she ________(do)? She's  a  teacher . 

七. 用适当的介词填空: 4%

   1. Which  part  of  the  country  do  you  come ______?

   2. You'd  better  not  take ______your  coat.

   3. Tom  was  born _____ England _______ May 6, 1980.

   4. Li  Lei  was  never  late ________school .

   5. It  will  be  cloudy ______ times .

   6. Yesterday we needed to climb ___ the trees with ladders.

   7. Summer  lasts  from May ______ July  in  China .

八. 完形填空: 10%

 Fred  liked  eating  fish  very 1_____. He  often  bought  some  fish  home . But  when  his  wife  saw  the  fish , she  always  said  to 2 _____, " Good ! Now  I  will 3___ my  friends  to  lunch  and  we  will  eat  this  fish . They  like  fish, too."

So  when  Fred  came  home  in  the 4______ , the  fish  was  never  there , and  his  wife  always  said , " Oh, your cat  ate  it !  She  is  a  very 5______ animal !" And  she  gave  Fred  some  bread 6________ his  supper .

But  one  evening  when  this  happened , Fred  became  very  angry . He 7_____ the  cat  and  his  wife  to  the  shop  near  his  house  and  weighed(称)  the  cat, 8______he  said  to  his  wife, "My  fish  weighed  three  pounds(磅).  This  cat  weights  three  pounds , 9____. 10 ____ this  three pounds  is  my  fish  in  the  cat , you  see , where  is  my  cat ?"

(   )1. A. well       B. good        C. more      D. much

(   )2. A. the  cat    B. her  friends  C. herself    D. Fred

(   )3. A. remember  B.ask          C. have       D. meet

(   )4. A. morning   B.middle of the  day  C. night  D. evening      (   )5. A. bad       B. good        C. nice        D. quick

(   )6. A. on        B. to          C. for         D. at

(   )7. A. sold      B. took         C. asked      D. told

(   )8. A. when     B. until         C. after       D. then

(   )9. A. too       B. two         C. and        D. to

(   )10. A. So       B.When        C. If          D. But

九. 看图填空: 10%

  

 

Wang  Lin  is  one  of  my  best  friends . He  likes  sports  very  much . 1_____ is  his  favourite  sport . He  often  goes  to 2______ football  after  school.

Wang  Lin  often goes to  school 3____ bike . After  school , he  often 4____his 5____. Wang  Lin  likes  summer . He  thinks  summer  is  his 6_____season . In  summer  he  may  go 7____ .He  often  says  swimming  is  good  for  our 8_____.

Wang  Lin  also  likes 9_____, and  he  draws  very  well. He often  draws 10______for  the  wall-newspaper  of  our  class.

1.________  2________ 3.________ 4.________ 5. ______

6.________  7________ 8. ________ 9. _______10 ________十. 阅读理解: 10%

       (A)

Black  was  eleven  years old . The  school  was near  his  house . He  usually  went  there  and  came home  on  time .  But he  came  home  from  school  late  last  Monday . His  father asked him, "why are  you  late  today ?"

" My  teacher  sent  me  to  her  office  after  class."

"To  her  office ?"his  father  said . " Why  did  she  send  you  to  her  office?"

"Because  she  asked  me  a  question  in  the  class," Black  said . "And  none  of  the children  gave  the  answer except  me ."

"But  why  didn't  your teacher send all  the other  children?"

"Because  her  question  was who  put  glue (浆糊) on  her  chair." Black  answered.

根据短文内容选择正误: 对的找“√”, 错的打“×”.

(   )1. Black  often  came  home  on  time .

(   )2. Black 's  teacher  was  a  woman.

(   )3. Blac  didn't do  wrong and the  teacher didn't do  right.

(   )4. The  teacher  asked  the  question  and  was  angry .

(   )5. Black  didn't  put  glue  on  teacher's  chair.

(B) This  Isn't  My  House

Tom  bought  shoes  from  the  shoes  factory  and  tried  to  sell  them  to  people.

There  were  not  many  shops  in  the  small  village.  People  there  didn't  want  to  go  to  town  to  buy  their  shoes. So  Tom  sold  a  lot  of  shoes  there .

One  day  Tom  drorve along  the  street . He  stopped  in  front  of  a  house , there  was  a  small  boy beside  the door. Tom opened  the  window  of  his  truck  and  called  to  the  boy.  "Hello, is  your  mother  at  home?"  The  boy  looked  at  him  .Then  he  answered , "Yes , she  is."

"That's  good," Tom  said. He  got  off  his  truck , took  some  shoes  amd  went  to  the  door  of  a house . He  knocked at(敲) the  door  and  waited  for  a  few  minutes,  but  nobody  came to  answer  the  door. Tom  knocked  again  and  waited  a  few  more  minutes, but  still (仍然) no  one  answered.  Then  Tom  looked  at  the  boy  and  said  amgrily, "Your  mother  is  NOT  at  home !" " She  IS !"  the  boy  said.

"Why  didn't  she  open  the door?"

"This  isn't  my  house ." the  boy  shouted . (喊)

(  )1. There  are  not  many ______in  the  small  village.

      A. shops         B. towns    

     C. stations       D. buildings

(   ) 2. People  in  the village______to go to  town to buy                their shoes.

       A. wanted             B. didn' t want  

       C. thought             D. liked

(   )3. They boy said _____ was  at  home.

       A. his father           B. his sister 

      C. his mother          D. his brother

 (   )4.Tom knocked at the door and  waited _____twice.(两次)

       A. for an  hour          B. for a long  time

       C. for a  few  minutes      D. for  half   an   hour

 (   )5. The  boy' s mother didn' t open the  door , because___

       A. she was not  at home    

       B. she was at  home

       C. she was at  work       

       D. that wasn' t her  house

初二英语听力部分(Unit 15—Unit 16)

1. 听句子, 选择你所听到的单词: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. thick        B. sits      C. its         D. six

(   )2. A. street       B. free      C. tree       D. three

(   )3. A. monkeys   B. Monday  C. month    D. mouth

(   )4. A. way        B. why      C. write      D. right

(   )5. A. sing        B. think     C. thing      D. ring

2. 听对话, 选择正确的答案回答问题: (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. A. It' s Monday.                 B. It' s Sunday.

       C. It' s February.                D. It' s six fifteen

(   )2. A. I went to  have breakfast.      B. I went to  school.

       C. I went to  the park.            D. I went boating.

(   )3. A. Lily feels full.                B. Lily feels hungry.

       C. Lily feels fine.                D. Lily feels well.

(   )4. A.They are talking about the  time.

       B. They are talking about their classroom.

       C. They are talking about the  weather.

       D. They are talking about their shoes.

(   )5. A. He is picking apples.      B. He is playing a  game.

       C. He is holding a  ladder.  

       D. He is looking for  his friend.

 3. 听录音, 选择下原句意思相似的句子: (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. A. They bought many books yesterday.

      B. They bought a  lot of oranges yesterday.

      C. Jim bought many apples yesterday.

      D. Jim' s sister bought a  lot of oranges yesterday.

(   )2. A.We helped the  farmers to pick oranges last Sunday.

       B. We helped the  farmers pick apples last Sunday.

       C. They helped the  farmers to pick oranges last                    Tuesday.

       D. They helped the  farmers pick apples last Tuesday.

(   )3. A. Li Ping likes spring.      B. Li Ping likes autumn.

       C. Lucy likes spring.        D. Lucy likes autumn.

(   )4. A. It' s so warm in  the room.

          Why don' t you  take off your coat?

       B. It' s so warm in  the room.

         Why don' t you  take off your sweater?

       C. It' s so old  in the room.

          Why n ot put  on your coat?

        D. It' s so cold in  the room.

          Why not put  on your sweater?

(   )5. A. Bruce is at  home.       B. Bruce is away.

       C. Bruce is at  the shop.   D. Bruce is  at the cinema.

      4. 听录音, 选出你所听到的电话号码: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. 322148    B. 311482     C. 311248    D. 311284

(   )2. A. 996656    B. 669965     C. 696965    D. 969656

(   )3. A. 886152    B. 886652     C. 881652    D. 888152

 五. 听录音, 选出该词的反义词: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. heavy    B. early     C. day    D. full

(   )2. A. small     B. open    C. long    D. outside

(   )3. A. young    B. night     C. down    D. closed

六. 听对话, 填表格: (对话念两遍)

初二英语听力部分(Unit 17—Unit 18)

1. 听句子, 选择你所听到的单词: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. sunny    B. sun     C. song         D. Sunday

(   )2. A. laugh    B. love     C. life(生活)    D. like

(   )3. A. snow    B. grow    C. show        D. blow

(   )4. A. hold     B. told      C. hope        D. cold

(   )5. A. feel      B. ill       C. till           D. meal

2. 听问句, 选择最恰当的答案: (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. A. Winter is the  warmest season in  China.

       B. Summer is the  warmest season in  China.

       C. Spring is the  best season in  China.

       D. Artumn is the  best season in  China.

(   )2. A. It' s winter.       B. It' s summer.

       C. It' s spring.        D. It' s autumn.

(   )3. A. Shopping.   B. Swimming.  C. Fishing.  D. Skating.

(   )4. A. The same to  you.      B. It doesn' t matter.

       C. I am happy.           D. Thanks a lot.

(   )5. A. It' s cool.             B. It' s Sunday.

       C. It' s October lst.        D. It' s my birthday.

3. 听录音, 选择与原句意思相似的句子: (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. A. What about the  picture ? 

       B. What a nice picture it  is !

       C. The picture is  very beautiful.

      D. What does the  picture look like ?

(   )2. A. The rain was  very heavy last night.

       B. It rained heavily last week.

       C. It rained all  night.

       D. The rain wasn' t  heavy last night.

(   )3. A. His birthday party is  going to start at  5 : 30.

       B. His birthday party is  going to start at  6 : 30.

       C. His birthday party is  going to start at  5 : 45.

       D. His birthday party is  going to start at  6 : 15.

(   )4. A. Give Lily the  message.    B. Get ready for  Lucy.

       C. Ring up Lucy.    D. Remember to tell Lucy.

(   )5. A. The days get  shorter and shorter.

       B. In winter, the days are  shorter than the  nights.

       C. Winter is from December to  February.

       D. The weather gets warmer and  warmer.

4. 看图, 听录音, 选择正确答案: (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. A. It' s my birthday.        B. It' s Jack' s birthday.

       C. It' s John' s birthday.     D. It' s Jim' s birthday.

(   )2. A. There is a  mooncake on the  table.

       B. There is a  chicken on the  plate.

       C. There is some fish and  meat on the  plate.

       D. There is a  big birthday cake on  the table.

(   )3. A. They are going to  have a class meeting.

       B. They are going to  have a rest.

    C. They are going to  have a birthday party.

    D. They are going to  have a talk about the  class.

(   )4. A. John is eleven years old.

       B. Jack is seven years old.

       C. John is thirteen years old.

       D. Jim is six  years old.

(   )5. A. I think he  is very happy today.

       B. He isn' t happy today, I think.

       C. He is busy today, I think.

       D. He is strong today.

五. 听短文, 选择正确的答案: (短文念两遍)

(   )1. A. Sam' s friend.          B. Bill.

       C. Sam' s father.          D. Sam' s mother.

(   )2. A. In the office.       B. In the classroom.

       C. At home.          D. He was out.

(   )3. A. Sam' s teacher.       B. Bill.

       C. Sam' s father.        D. Sam' s friends.

(   )4. A. His telephone number was  451382.

       B. His telephone number was  541328.

       C. His telephone number was  453218.

       D. His telephone number was  543128.

(   )5. A. Because Sam' s mother was  at the cinema.

       B. Because Sam' s mother was  busy at home.

       C. Because Sam' s mother was  ill at home.

       D. Because Sam' s mother wanted to  tell him

         something  interesting.

初二英语听力部分(Unit 19—Unit 20)

1. 听句子, 选择你所听到的单词: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. below    B. before    C. because    D. brown

(   )2. A. fall       B. feel      C. felt         D. fell

(   )3. A. about     B. above    C. along       D. again

(   )4. A. whole    B. hold      C. ago        D. cold

(   )5. A. boy       B. easy     C. enjoy       D. story

2. 听录音, 判断该单词与你所听到的单词的元音音素是否         相同, 相同的写“S”, 不同的写“D”: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. friend   (   )2. south   (   )3. pork   (  )4. beef

3. 听句子, 把所缺的部分补充完整: (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. The radil ______ it will  be _______ tomorrow.

(   )2. The temperature will ______ ______ zero at  night.

(   )3. There will be  a______ ______the day after tomorrow.

(   )4. I shall _____ _____ you outside the  school gate.

(   )5. It is _______ _______ food.

4. 听录音, 选择与原句意思相似的句子: (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. A. Lucy likes eating fried eggs better than fried beef.

       B. Lucy likes eating apples better than oranges.

       C. Lucy doesn' t like fried eggs.

       D. Lucy doesn' t like fried chicken.

(   )2. A. Who is back this evening?

       B. Who is ill  this evening?

      C. Who will come this evening?

      D. Who will stay at  home this evening?

(   )3. A. What do you  think of the  potatoes?

       B. How are the  delicious potatoes?

       C. How delicious the  potatoes are !

       D. What about the  potatoes?

(   )4. A. It' s cloudy today.     B. It' s rainy today.

       C. It' s sunny today.      D. It' s windy today.

(   )5. A. Bruce often comes at  noon.

       B. Bruce often comes at  night.

       C. Bruce often comes in  the day- time.

       D. Bruce often comes at  that time.

5. 听短文, 选择正确答案: (短文念两遍)

(   )1. A. Fish and chips.    B. Chinese take-away food.

       C. Oranges and apples.   D. Both A  and B.

(   )2. A. England.   B. The U.S.A.   C. Australia.   D. Japan.

(   )3. A. Pork and beef.        B. Fried chicken.

       C. Fish and chips.        D. Meat and fish.

(   )4. A. Fried chicken.            B. Fidh  snf chips.

       C. Hamburgers(汉堡包)      D. Fried beef.

(   )5. A. The USA, England and  China.

       B. England, China and Australia.

       C. Australia, England  and the USA.

       D. England, Australia  and France.

初二英语听力部分(Unit 15—Unit 21)

1. 听句子, 选择你所听到的单词: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. pleasure     B. present    C. parents    D. parent

(   )2. A. late         B. letter      C. later       D. matter

(   )3. A. their        B. where     C. wear      D. pear

(   )4. A. would      B. could     C. cool      D. food

(   )5. A. warm       B. form     C. phone     D. born

2. 听录音, 选择与原句意思相似的句子: (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. A. Could you ask  him to call her  name , please ?

       B. Could you please answer the  phone ?

       C. Could you make her  a telephone call, please ?

       D. Could you ask  him to ring me , please ?

(   )2. A. I' m sorry I  forget to say“Good-bye”.

       B. I' m sorry I  forget the room number.

       C. I' m sorry I  mulst go now.

       D. I' m sorry I  can' t remember the  phone number.

(   )3. A. How hot it  is today!      B. How cold is  it today?

       C. What a cold day!         D. What a hot  day!

(   )4. A. The weather in  the same country is  not the same.

       B. The weather in different countries are not  the same.

       C. Different countries don' t have different  weather.

       D. The weather in  different countries are  the same

(   )5. A. Englishmen like the  most popular food in  Australia.

   B. Englishmen like eating fish and  chips very much.

   C. Fish and chips are  the most popular food in  the USA.

   D. The most popular food in  England is Chinese take-               away food.

3. 听对话, 选择正确答案: (对话念两遍)

(   )1. A. Yes. Mary will see  her grandma.

       B. No, Mary won' t see  her grandma.

       C. Yes, Mary will see  her grandpa.

       D. No, Mary won' t see  her grandpa.

(   )2. A. Tom gets up  at 7 : 00 and  leaves home at  8 : 00.

       B. Tom gets up  at 7 : 30 and  leaves home at  8 : 30.

       C. Tom gets up  at 7 : 00 and  leaves home at  7 : 30.

       D. Tom gets up  at 7 : 50 and  leaves home at  8 : 15.

(   )3. A. The book and  the pen are  in the black bag.

       B. The book isn' t in  the red bag.

       C. The pen and  the book are  in the red  bag.

       D. The pen and  the book are  in the blue bag.

(   )4. A. In 1989.   B. In 1992.   C. In 1990.   D. In 1987.

(   )5. A. They are talking about sports.

       B. They are talking about shopping.

       C. They are talking about the  seasons.

       D. They are talking about the  weather. 

4. 看图, 听录音, 选择正确答案: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. It' s sunny.         B. It' s cloudy.

      C. It' s windy.         D. It' s rainy.

(   )2. A. He is Bruce.       B. He is Mike.

       C. He is Jim.         D. He is Bob.

(   )3. A. They are talking.

       B. They are making telephone call.

       C. They are speaking English.

       D. They are counting the  number.

(   )4. A. He is saying,“How old  are you?”

       B. He is asking,“What' s your house' s number?”

       C. He is asking,“What' s your telephone number?”

       D. He is asking,“What' s the car  number?”

(   )5. A. It' s 554392.        B. It' s .

      C. It' s .        D. It' s .

5. 听短文, 选择正确答案: (短文念两遍)

(   )1. A. The People' s Park.     B. Beijing Zoo.

       C. The Great Wall.        D. The hospital.

(   )2. A. His aunt.              B. His friend.

       C. His teacher.            D. His mother.

(   )3. A. They played games.    B. They took some photos.

       C. They drew pictures.     D. They had lunch.

(   )4. A. They had noodles.      B. They had Beijing duck.

       C. They had potatoes.     D. They had chicken.

(   )5. A. Yes, they did.          B. No, they didn' t.

       C. Yes, they are.          D. No, they aren' t.

初二英语听力部分(Unit 22—Unit 23)

1. 听句子, 选择你所听到的单词: (每小题念一遍)

(   )2. A. why       B. wife     C. wait      D. way

(   )2. A. visit       B. busy     C. easy      D. city

(   )3. A. green      B. begin    C. bring     D. ring

(   )4. A. snow      B. show     C. blow     D. so

(   )5. A. meet      B. meal      C. mean     D. leave

2. 听对话, 选择正确答案: (对话念两遍)

(   )1. A. He wants to  go to a  park in Beijing.

       B. He wants to  go to the  Beijing Zoo.

       C. He wants to  go to the  factory in Beijing.

       D. He wants to  go to a  school in Beijing.

(   )2. A. Yes, he does.        B. No, he doesn' t.

       C. No, he does.         D. Yes, he doesn' t.

(   )3. A. He asks a  woman and she  tells him the  way.

       B. He asks a man, but the  man doesn' t know the way.

       C. He asks a  policeman and he  tells him how  to get               there.

       D. He asks a  boy, but he doesn' s answer.

(   )4. A. He gets there by  train.    B. He gets there by  bus.

       C. He gets there on  foot.    D. He gets there by  car.

(   )5. A. Yes, it is.        B. No, it isn' t.

       C. No, it' s quite near, only about two  minutes' walk                from here.

       D. No, it' s very far  from here. 

3. 听问句, 选择恰当的答语: (问句念两遍)

(   )1. A. It' s not very nice.    B. It' s very small.

       C. Walk along the  street and turn right. It' s not  far.

       D. It' s busy street.

(   )2. A. I' m sorry.                 B. That' s all right.

       C. Thank you very much.      D. Excuse me.

(   )3. A. Go to school.         B. Go to see  a doctor.

       C. Go for a  walk.        D. Take exercise.

(   )4. A. I shall ask  a teacher.    B. I shall ask  a cleaner.

       C. I shall ask  an officer.   D. I shall ask  a policeman.

(   )5. A. I shall do  my best.      B. No, not at all.

       C. You are right.           D. Thank you.

4. 听录音, 填写所缺的词语: (短文念两遍)

It was a  1 ______ spring morning 2 ______ London. An old  woman went to  see the doctor. because her  3 ______ hurt. The  woman 4 ______ to the hospital very early. There were many people in  the 5 _______ room. Soon after, an 6 _____ came into the  room. He walked quickly to  the 7 ______ room. The old  woman stood up  and 8 ______ him. She said,“You must wait for  your 9 ______.”She did  not 10 ______ the Indian was  the doctor.

5. 听短文, 选择正确答案: (短文念两遍)

(   )1. Jim didn' t go  to school this week because ______.

       A. his hand was  hurt           B. his arm hurt

       C. he didn' t do  his homework  D. his mother was  ill

(   )2. Jim fell down from the  tree when he ______.

       A. played with his  friends

       B. helped the farmers pick apples

       C. helped the farmers clean the  house

       D. flew the kite

(   )3. Jim' s ____ brought  him to see  the doctor.

       A. father    B. mother     C. friends    D. teacher

(   )4. There were _____ children in the  hospital.

       A. a lot of     B. some    C. few     D. a few

(   )5. Jim waited for ____ before he  saw the doctor.

       A. less than two  hours    B. more than two  hours

       C. two hours              D. three hours

初二英语听力部分(Unit 24—Unit 25)

1. 听句子, 选择你所听到的单词: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. instead     B. bread    C. best      D. rest

(   )2. A. ready      B. rainy    C. many     D. tidy

(   )3. A. wrong     B. long      C. song     D. along

(   )4. A. away      B. ago       C. afraid    D. again

(   )5. A. sad       B. bad       C. bed       D. head

2. 听单词, 选出你所听到的单词的重读音节所共有的元音         音素: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. [C:]      B. [Q]     C. [B:]      D. [ei]

(   )1. A. [U]       B. [U:]    C. [Q]      D. [C]

(   )3. A. [e]      B. [A]     C. [ei]      D. [I:]

(   )4. A. [I]       B. [ai]     C. ['ai[]    D. [i[]

(   )5. A. [[:]     B. [[]      C. [C]       D. [au]

3. 听问句, 选出最恰当的答案: (问句念两遍)

(   )1. A. I am  late.        B. I am ill.

       C. I am busy.       D. I am in  hospital.

(   )2. A. I have to  wait outside.  

       B. I have to  go back home.

       C. I have to  say, “May I  come in?”

       D. I have to  say, “I' m sorry. I' m late.”

(   )3. A. Because he  is free.

       B. Because the doctor asks him  to help.

      C. Because he is  alone.

      D. Because he likes watching TV.

(   )4. A. No, you mustn' t.     B. No, you needn' t.

       C. No, you won' t.       D. No, you can' t.

(   )5. A. I must take exercise.    B. I must get  up at six.

       C. I mustn' t read in  bed.   D. I must eat  much.

4. 听录音, 把对话中所缺的部份补充完整: (对话念两遍)

T : Good morning, doctor.

D : Good morning. What' s 1 ______ , young man?

T : I don' t feel very well today. My head 2 ______.

D : Oh, let 3 ______ look over you. Mm, something 4 ______         wrong with your head.

T : What do I  5 ______ to do?

D : Have a good 6______ and drink a  7 ______ of water,            you will 8 ______ all right tomorrow.

5. 听对话, 选择正确答案: (对话念两遍)

(   )1. A. Yes, he can.          B. No, he can' t.

       C. He can stay here.

       D. He can play basketball with Tom.

(   )2. A. Because it' s raining heavily.

       B. Because he has  to do his  homework first.

       C. Because he doesn' t like to  play football with Tom.

       D. Because he is  going to the  cinema.

(   )3. A.Because he  won' t finish it  if he doesn' t do  it first.

      B. Because he  has to cook meal for  his parents.

      C. Because he has  to hand in  his homework first.

      D. Because his mother is  ill.

(   )4. A. Tom.    B. Jim.    C. Mike.    D. John.

(   )5. A. It' s cloudy today.    B. It' s sunny today.

       C. It' 's windy today.    D. It' s rainy. 

初二英语听力部分(Unit 26—Unit 27)

1. 听句子, 选择你所听到的单词: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. shout      B. round      C. about     D. down

(   )2. A. himself    B. herself     C. myself    D. yourself

(   )3. A. money    B. monkey    C. month    D. mouth

(   )4. A. play       B. great       C. grade     D. bread

(   )5. A. fly        B. fry         C. dry       D. cry 

2. 听录音, 选择与原句意思相似的句子: (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. A. They took care of  themselves.

       B. They had a  good time.

       C. They have a  happy party.

       D. They like it  very much.

(   )2. A. The girl stopped to  cry. 

       B. They girl began to  cry.

       C. The girl stopped crying.

       D. The girl didn' t like crying.

(   )3. A. You must look at  these babies.

       B. You must liik after these babies.

       C. You must look after these babies.

       D. You must put  on these babies.

(   )4. A. Maybe Lucy is  Mr Green' s doctor.

       B. Maybe Lucy is  Mr Green' s daughter.

       C. Maybe Lucy is  Mr Geen' s sister.

      D. Maybe Lucy is  Mr Green' s student.

(   )5. A. I have to  go home because mother is  ill.

       B. I have to  go home because mother told me  to                  come back early.

       C. I have to  go home because it  isn' t early.

       D. I have to  stay here because it  is late.

3. 听对话, 选择正确答案: (对话念两遍)

(   )1. A. Li Lei.    B. Tom.   C. John and Tom.   D. Lucy.

(   )2. A. No, he isn' t.        B. Yis, he is.

       C. Li Lei can' t.        D. Li Lei can.

(   )3. A. Because he can' t swim in  the river.

       B. Because he old  enough to do it.

       C. Because his parents are  not at home these days.

       D. Because his friends are  going to see  him.

(   )4. A. John will help him  with the work.

       B. NoBody.  He wants to  do it all  by himself.

       C. His friends  will  help him.

       D. His parents will do  the work.

(   )5. A. No, he can' t.        B. Sure , he can' t.

       C. He won' t do  it with others.

       D. He thinks he  can. He wants to  learn to do  it by                himself.

 4. 听对话, 填写家谱表: (对话念两遍)

五. 听对话, 选择正确答案: (对话念两遍)

(   )1. A. Winter holidays.        B. Summer holidays.

       C. Mid-Autumn Day.      D. The twins' birthday.

(   )2. A. Himself.              B. With his friends.

       C. With his parents.      D. With his teachers.

(   )3. A. Xi' an.    B. Wuhan.    C. Tianjing.   D. Beijing.

(   )4. A. they will take her.     B. No, they won' t.

       C. Yes, they will.         D. They won' t take her.

(   )5. A. Playing games.           B. Playing in the  sun.

       C. Swimming in the  sea.     D. Taking a walk.

初二英语听力部分(Unit 22—Unit 28)

1. 听句子, 选择你所听到的单词: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. sugar      B. sure       C. short     D. shoe

(   )2. A. alone      B. along      C. about    D. above

(   )3. A. brighty    B. night      C. right      D. light

(   )4. A. quick     B. quickly    C. quite     D. queue

(   )5. A. coat       B. road       C. boat      D. cold

2. 听录音, 选择能正确回答或紧接你所听到的句子的选项:        (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. A. You' d better go  to see a  doctor.

       B. You' d better  jump  the queue.

       C. You must have a  rest.

       D. You must get  up earlier tomorrow.

(   )2. A. Come in , please.            B. Sorry , I can' t.

       C. All right. Let' s have a  talkl.   D. Not at all.

(   )3. A. When they make some mistakes.

       B. When they are  ill.

       C. When they do  their homework.

       D. When the lift goes up  and down.

(   )4. A. He is mending a  bike.    B. He is flying a  kite.

       C. The kite is  broken.        D. He hurt himself.

(   )5. A. Yes, I can see  five.        B. I can see  the tenth.

       C. No, I can see  only one.   D. I can  see five.

3. 听录音, 选择与原句意思相似的句子: (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. A. Could you borrow five books from her?

       B. May I borrow five books from you?

       C. Will you please borrow five books from Bill?

       D. Will you please lend five books to Bill?

(   )2. A. The students began to  make faces when the                     teacher came in.

       B. The students stopped making faces before the                    teacher came in.

       C. The students didn' t make faces before the  teacher                came in.

       D. The students didn' t make faces after the  teacher                  came in. 

(   )3. A. It is difficult.          B. It is a  pleasure.

       C. It is dangerous.        D. It is safe.

(   )4. A. There was nobody on the island except themselves.

       B. There was no  one on the  island.

      C. There was someone else on  the island.

       D. There were a  few people with them.

(   )5. A. Why don' t you  watch TV tomorrow night?

       B. Why not come and  mend TV tonight?

       C. Please come and  watch TV  tonight.

       D. Don' t watch TV  tonight.

4. 听问句, 找出相应答语并写上问句的序号: (每句念两遍)

(   )1. It' s half past nine.

(   )2. Yes, please. I want some eggs and  a cup of  tea.

(   )3. It' s about two  kilometres away.

(   )4. I' m from Shanghai , too.

(   )5. That' s a good idea.

(   )6. Certainly, here you are.

5. 听短文, 选择正确答案: (短文念两遍)

(   )1. A. Mr Turner.         B. Mr Green.

       C. Mrs Turner.        D. Mrs Green.

(   )2. A. To come and  have lunch with her  and her                      husband.

       B. To come and  have supper with her  and her                     husband.

        C. To come and  have lunch with her  friends.

        D. To come and  have a birthday party.

(   )3. A. There was much food in  the house.

       B. There was a  little food in  the house.

       C. There was a  little rice and  bread in the  house.

       D. There was little food in  the house.

(   )4. A. He remembered.        B. Yes, he did.

       C. No, he didn' t.           D. He forgot.

(   )5. A. Because Mr Green forgot to  take the meat out  of                the car at  first.

       B. Because Mr Green ran  out and drove to  buy.

    C. Because Mrs Green bought the  meat yesterday.

    D. Because a friend brought it  over.

初 二 英 语 竞 赛

I . 语音和词汇: (共10小题, 计10分)

   A)观察下列各组单词划线部分的读音, 交按A、B、C、            D四种情况选择答案.

   A. 一种读音  B. 两种读音  C. 三种读音  D. 四种读音

1. A. pencil      B. kilometre     C. tiger     D. policeman

2. A. full         B. June         C. use      D. uncle

3. A. easily       B. reach         C. sea      D. health

4. A. hungry      B. England      C. strong   D. orange

5. A. fourth       B. colour        C. ours    D. yours

   B)下列每组单词中只有一个是拼写正确的. 请找出来.

6. A. chicken      B. chickin       C. checken      D. chiken

7. A. Februry      B. February     C. Ferbruary    D. Febrary

8. A. minute      B. minete        C. minite       D. minate

9. A. different    B. differant      C. defferent    D. different

10. A. remember  B. remenber   C. remember  D. remmember Ⅱ. 单项选择: (共30小题, 计15分)

A)综合选择填空.

11. Where  are the _______?

    A. policeman  B. policemans  C. policemen  D. police men

12. —Do you  like _______?    —Yes , I do.

    A. the colour of  these clothes  B. these clothes' colour

    C. these clothes colour   D. the colour on  these clothes

13. —What' s the  time?

    —It' s _______.

    A. one thirty

    B. one thirty-one

    C. six o five          

    D. six five o' clock

14. These  footballs are for _______and ________.

    A. his, me    B. you, her   C. I , you   D. them , we

15. —Is everyone here today?

    —Yes , we ________.

    A. all are here         B. are here all

    C. all here are         D. are all here

16. Mr  Black has no  sons _______ daughters.

    A. or      B. and     C. but      D. too

17. There' s ______ group of  ducks in front of ______ old             house. ______ house is near ______ Changjiang River.

    A. the ; an ; A ; (不填)     B. a ; (不填) ; The ; (不填)

    C. a ; the ; The ; the        D. the ; (不填) ; A ; the

18. There  are five flowers here. One is  for my sister, ______          are for my  mother.

    A. the other    B. other   C. the others    D. others

19. Who is _______. Mrs Read or  Mrs King?

    A. more careful         B. careful more  

    C. carefuler             D. most careful

20. ______ weekdays  we often have lunch _______ the middle        _______ the day.

    A. In ; in ; at  B. On ; in ; of  C. At ; at ; of   D. Of ; on ; at

21. —How much ________ the meat?

    —Ten yuan a  kilo.

    —I want ______.

    —Here you  are.

    A. does ; half kilo          B. does ; a half kilo

    C. is ; half a  kilo          D. is; half kilo

22. You  have more apples than _______do. But _______ are           better than yours.

    A. us ; we    B. we ; ours    C. ours ; us    D. ours ; ours

23. My  father often gets  up  early. He doesn' t like _______.

   A. to be  late    B. to late   C. be late    D. late

24. —_______ does Tom  put the boxes?

    —He ______ them there.

    A. When ; puts              B. Who ; is putting

    C. What ; is going to put     D. Where ; puts

25. Look! Sam' s  uncle ____ under a big  tree and ____ a book.

   A. sits ; reading               B. is sitting ; reads

   C. is sitting ; reading          D. sits ; reads

26. Please ______ this coat. It' s cold outside.

   A. take off    B. put on    C. put away    D. take away

27. —______ do you like our  school?

   —Oh , very much.

    A. What      B. How      C. Why      D. When

28. —Lily, please answer this question.

   —Excuse me , must I  speak in English?

   —No, you ________.

   A. won' t      B. mustn' t     C. needn' t      D. may not

29. Today is ______, little Tom' s birthday.

    A. July the  twenty-first, nineteen  ninety-severn

    B. July the twenty-one, nineteen ninty-seven

    C. nineteen ninety-seven, July twenty-first

    D. the nineteen ninty-seven, July the  twenty-one

30. —Would you  like to go  with  us?

    —______.

    A. OK, I' d love          B. I would like  

    C. Yes, I like            D. I' d love to

    B)从A、B、C、D四个选项中选出与句子划线部分意           思相同或最为接近的一项.

31. —Sorry, I don' t know a  place called Red  House.

    —Oh, thanks any way.

    A. very much   B. a lot   C. all the  same   D. all the time

32. —What are  they doing now?

    —I' ve no idea.

    A. I don' t think so.           B. I' m sorry.

    C. Doing nothing.             D. I don' t know.

33. There  are many  oranges in  the basket.

    A. more     B. a lot of    C. a little    D. a lot

34. Go down this road, and then you  can see the  hospital.

    A. up to   B. with   C. along with    D. along

35. My  father got  the  model ship for  my brother yesterday.

   A. repaired    B. bought     C. gave      D. made

   C)下列各题的划线部分均有一处错误, 请指出.

36. Please not  come here! Go  to the  blackboard!

           A         B       C         D

37. He  wants to buy some breads because he  is hungry.

         A      B            C                   D

38. These  are English teachers. One of the  teacher is American.

                    A           B         C        D

39. Can  you tell me  the different between the  twin sisters?

           A    B      C    D

40. You usually haven' t breakfast at eight , right?

           A      B                C      D

Ⅲ. 情景交际: (共15小题, 计15分)

   A)根据下列对话情景, 选择最佳答案.

41.

    A. I want a  blue coat.        B. I' d like to  talk to you.

    C. Thanks for your help.      D. I' d like two  cakes.

42. —Hi, Mary.

    —Hi, Kate. Who' s that?

    —________

    —The one  behind the door.

    —Oh, it' s Jim.

    A. Whose Jim.  B. Where is  it?  C. What?  D. Which one?

43. —Can you  find China on  this map?

    —Yes. _____ It' s here.

     A. China is a  good country.       B. Let me see.

     C. It' s on the  wall.      D. I have a  new map of  China.

44.

      A. Dick! Nice to  meey you.  B. Dick! How are  you?

      C. Hello! Is that Dick?    D. Hi! What are you  doing?

45. —Are you  Mrs Green?

    —No, I' m Miss Green.

    —_______ I thought you  were Mrs Green.

    A. OK.   B. Er, sorry    C. Excuse me.   D. Oh, yes.

46.

    A. Why do you  study English? 

    B. What' s wrong with you?

    C. What did you  catch?    D. Where are you  going?

    B) 根据下列每题所设情景, 选出最佳答案.

47. 当你想问“手表”用英语怎么说时, 下面四句话中哪一         句是错的?

    A. What' s“手表”for English?

    B. What' s the English for“手表”?

    C. What' s“手表”in English?

    D. How do you  say “手表”in English?

48. 初次见面, 经人介绍后, 你想问对方的名字, 该怎样问?

    A. What are you?              B. How are you?

    C. May I know your name?    D. How do you  do?

49. If (如果) you want to  borrow your brother' s bike , you            should (应该) say:

    A. Do you use  your bike?   B. Is this your bike?

    C. May I catch your bike?   D. Could I  use your bike?

50. When your  friend says“Your dress is  very nice.”, you          should say:

    A. Thank you.           B. Don' t say so.  

    C. That' s right.          D. It' s not good.

   C)根据对话内容, 从A、B、C、D中选择适当的句子补全          对话.

Peter : Good  morning.

Mike : Good  morning.

Peter : (51)_______, is this Class Two?

Mike : (52)_______, but it  isn' t.

       It' s (53)_______.

Kate : Class  Two is over there.

Peter : Oh, (54)________. I' m new  here.

Mike : (55) ________.

Kate : You' re  welcome.

51. A. Sorry      B. Excuse me     C. Hello     D. Hi

52. A. Excuse  me    B. I' m sorry    C. Yes   D. Oh

53. A. Class  One  B. Class Three  C. Class Four  D. Class Five

54. A. thanks      B. no    C. good      D. bye

55. A. It  doesn' t matter        B. All right

   C. That' s right             D. That' s OK

Ⅳ. 10%

56. Which  letter goes all  around an island(鸟)?

    A. B.   B. C   C. W   D. E

57. Which  letter is most useful to  a deaf(聋的) woman?

    A. H      B. R       C. A      D. E

58. Which  letter is the  difference betueen here and  there?

    A. e       B. r        C. h      D. t

59. This  is the name of  a day. Thereare six  letters in it.  The         third letter is  "n", but there is  no "s" in  it what day  is it?

    A. Sunday     B. Friday      C. Thursday   D. Monday

60. What' s  the best and  cheapest light?

    A. Moonlight    B. Daylight    C. lamp      D. The Sun.

61. What  Country is useful at  mealtines?

    A. China        B. America     C. England    D. Japan

62. In  which month do  people speak least?

    A. December     B. May        C. February    D. January

63. There' re ______  hours in a  week.

    A. one hundred and  sixty  

    B. one hundred  and  tighty

    C. one hundred and  sixty-eight

    D. one hundred and  eighty-six

64. Judy  is 10 and  her brother is  12, In how  many years           will their age  total (总共)38?

    A. 4       B. 6        C. 8        D. 10

65. It' s  half past one. What time will it  be twenty hours             later? ________.

Ⅴ.完形填空: (共20小题, 计20分)

选择正确答案填空.

                             (A)

Two  friends 66_____ a  bear(熊)  when they went through a  forest (穿越森林) 67._____. One  of them ran  to 68.____tree. and  climbed up very quickly. He  forgot his friend. He  thought only of  69.____ His  friend 70.____ bears 71.____ dead(死的) men. 72._____ he 73._____ when the  bear came to  him. Then the  bear went away. The  man called his  friend in the  tree. "You can  74.______ now. " The  man smiled(微笑) and asked ,  "What  did the bear say  to you?" His  friend answered, "He said I  needed a new  75.______."

66. A.looked  for      B. met    C. looked at      D. watched

67. A.by  bus        B. by bike   C. on foot    D. by car

68. A. the  nearest    B. the good   C. a taller    D. a biggest

69. A. himself       B. his mother   

   C. the bear      D. his girl friend

70. A. knew         B. thought       C. saw       D. watched

71. A. wasn' t  like        B. needn' t find

    B. didn' t  eat        D. couldn' t touch

72. A. And           B. so            C. But      D.Because

73. A. moved    B. ran  C. opened his  eyes    D. didn' t move

74. A. climb  up   B. get up     C. stay there    D. come down

75. A. teacher     B. dress      C. house       D. friend

                           (B)

Sam:  Tomorrow is Saturday.  What  76._____?

John: Let' s have a  picnic(野餐)

Mike:  77._______.

Sam:  78.______ can we  go ?

John: To the  big park.

Mike: To the  beach(海滩).

Sam:  There 79._____going to  be a lot  of people at  the                beach. Le' s go  to 80._______.

Mike:  You always like 81.___. OK!  How do we  82.___there?

Sam: By bus.  83.____ is one  at nine o' clock.

John:  84._____ do we meet?

Sam:  Eight thirty at  the bus stop. And  I want to  bring some           85.______.

John:

Mike:   

76. A. day is it             B. do you think  of it

    C. are you doing        D. are we going to  do

77. A. Great      B. Thank  goodness  C. Well   D. Oh dear

78. A. Where      B. How      C. When       D. Why

79. A. (不填)      B. are          C. was       D. were

80. A. the  beach      B. the zoo  C. the park    D. the picnic

81. A. my  picnie    B. his ideas   C. his park   D. many  people

82. A. reach      B. walk      C. come      D. get

83. A. Teh  bus     B. He      C. It         D. There

84. A. How       B. When    C. Where   D. When are where

85. A. Chicken  and dumplings        B. desks and chairs

    C. books and pens               D. water and porridge

Ⅵ.阅读理解: (共20小题, 计30分)

                      (A)

Mary:  Mum, what' s in  the box?

Mum: Two shirts.

Mary:  What colour are  they?

Mum: One is  blue, the other is  green.

Mary:  Whose are they?

Mum:  They're for your brothers. Today is  their birthday.

Mary:  oh, yes, Happy birthday to  you !

Jim:  

Tim:   

Mary:  How old are  you ,  Jim?

Jim:   I' m eight. Oh,  no, I' m  nime. Today is  my birthday.

Tim:   I' m nine, too.

Mum:  Here are two  shirts.

Jim:   Which is  mine?

Mum: The blue one.

Tim:   And the  green one is  mine.

Jim: 

Tim:

根据对话内容, 选择正确答案

86. How many people are  there in the  dialogue?

    A. Tow       B. Three      C. Four       D. Five

87. Jim and  Tim are _____.

    A. friends    B. sisters   C. brother and sister   D. twins

88. Where  are the two  shirts?

    A. In a  box       B. In a desk    

    C. On a  table.        D. On a chair.

89. Which  shirt is for  Tim?

    A. The blue one.    B. The green  one

    C. The red one       D. The black one

90. Whose  birthday is it?

   A. Mum and  Mary' s     B. Jim' s

   C. Tim' s                D. jim and Tim' s

                        (B)

I will tell you  the story of  the ant and  the grasshopper. It  is a cold winter' s (冬天的)day and an  ant is bringing out  some grains of  corn(谷粒). He gathered(收集)them in the summer(夏天). He wants to  dry(晒干)  them.  The grasshopper is  very hungry.He sees the  ant and says, "Give me  a few grains of  corn; I am  dying of hunger(饿死)."

"But, "  says the ant, "what did  you do during the  summer? Didn't  you store up (贮藏)some corn?"

"No,"  says the grasshopper,  "I was  too busy."

"What  did you do ?" asks the  ant.

" I  sang all day," answers the  grasshopper.

" If  you sang all  summer," says the  ant,

"you  can clance(跳舞)all winter."

根据短文内容, 选择正确答案.

91. Teh  ant dries the  grains of corn______.

    A. in the  summer          B. in the winter

    C. on weekdays           D. when he is  hungry

92. The  grasshopper is very hungry because he  only______          during the summer.

    A. danced                 B. dried the grains  

    C. storedd up corn          D. sang

93. The  ant gave the  grasshopper_____.

    A. some grains of  corn       B. something to eat

    C. nothing                    D. some rice

94. The  title(题目)  of the story may  be_____

   A. The Ant  and the Grasshopper

   B. The Ant  Sings and Dances

   C. The Busy Ant  and the Happy  Grasshopper

   D. Store up  Some Corn and  You' ll Be Hungry

95. From  the story we  can dnow_______.

   A. teh ant  is our  good  friend

   B. we must think before we  do anything

   C. people must help others.

   D. we must work hard for  a good life

                       (C)

It was Sunday. I never get  up early on  Sundays. I sometimes stay in  bed till(直到) lunch time. Last Sunday I  got up very late. I looked out of  the window. It was dark(暗)outside. "What a  day!" I thougt, " It' s raining(下雨)again." Just then (正在那时), the  telephone rang (电话响了). It was  my aunt Lucy. "I' m in  your city now, " she  said, " I'm coming to  see you. "

"But I' m still(仍然) having breakfast, "  I  said.

"I' m  having breakfast, "  I repeated.

" Oh,  dear, " she  said.  "Do you  always get up  so late? It's one  o' clock!"

根据短文内容, 选择正确答案.

96. When  Aunt Lucy telephoned, the  writer_____.

    A. was coming to  see his  aunt  Lucy

    B.  was in bed    

    C. was having lunch

    D. got up a  short time ago

97. Aunt  Lucy was surprised(惊讶) because______.

    A. it was one  o' clock   

    B. it was too  late

    C. the writer had  his  breakfast

    D. the  writer had  breakfast so late

98. The  writer______ gets up  early on Saturdays.

    A. never             B. usually

    C. often             D. we don' t  know.

99. "What  a  day!" here meas " What a ______ day!".

    A. good         B. bad     C. fine      D. hard

100. Im  the eighth line of  the passage, the  word "repeated"           means_______. 

     A. 不好意思地说        B. 大声说  

      C. 重复               D. 笑着说

                             (D)

Mr Green asked a  lot of questions about the  buses. But Sam  couldn' t answer them.  Here' s a  timetable(时间表). Friends, after you  having a look  at it , can  you answer Mr  Green' s questions?

根据图表内容, 选择正确答案.

101. How  many stops are  there(在……之间) the  Ferry and           the Market?

     A. Five.      B. Six       C. Seven   D. Eight.

102. How often does the  bus get to  the Old Street?

     A. Every(每)  half an hour      B. Every twenty minutes.

     C. Evey ten minutes.           D. No answer.

103. At  what time does Bus  Four leave the  Hotel?

     A. Seven fifty-five.            B. Eight o' clock.

     C. Five minutes past eight.    D. No  answer.

104. I  work in the  hospital. It is  quite near the  bus  stop.             Only three minutes'  walk. I  must reach the  hospital  at           eight o' clock. Which  bus should I  take?

     A. The first bus.              B. The second bus

     C. The third  bus             D. The fourth  bus

105. Every  Sunday I take the  first  bus to  the Park. There I          can play some there.  The market opens from seven thirty        to eight thirty. At  the most how  long can  I stay in  the          park?

     A. Half an hour .              B. An hour.

     C. An  hour  and  a half       D. No answer.

初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

第十五单元(57---60课)试卷

Ⅰ找出划线部分的读音不同于其他三个的词:8%

 (  ) 1.A. hour       B. hat      C. hand      D. hair

 (  ) 2.A. warm      B. park     C.garden     D. harvest

 (  ) 3.A. dear       B. near      C. wear      D. here

 (  ) 4.A. phone     B. of       C. afraid      D. enough

 (  ) 5.A. moment   B. cinema   C. ago       D. April

(  ) 6.A. above      B. over      C. wrote     D. hope

 (  ) 7.A. throw      B. those    C. this       D. that

 (  ) 8.A. nut        B. sun      C. busy      D. bus

Ⅱ.按括号中的要求写出相应的形式:10%

   1. bring (过去式) _______    2. hot(最高级) ________

   3. near (反义词) _______      4. happy(副词)________

   5. get (现在分词)________   6. windy(比较级)_______

   7. sun(形容词)________      8. forget(过去式) _______

   9. photo(复数)_________     10.stop (过去式) ________

Ⅲ.选择填空:20%

 (  ) 1. We  enjoy _______ English  songs .

       A. to  sing   B. sang    C. singing    D. sing

 (  ) 2. My  pen  is  broken . I  need  to  buy ______ .

       A. another  one         B. it

       C. the  other  one       D. a  new  one

 (  ) 3. Please write ______ your  name  on  the  book .

        A. out      B. down    C. off      D. on

 (  ) 4. ---______ did  your  father  watch  TV  last  night?

       --- About  two  hours.

       A. How  long           B. How   often 

       C. How  much          D. How  many

 (  ) 5. The  Changjiang  River  is ______river  in  China.

        A. longer   B. longest   C. most  longest   D. the  longest

 (  ) 6. I  saw  Lucy ______ .

       A. on  my  way  school       B. on  my school way

       C. on  my  way to  school    D. on  a  school  way

 (  ) 7. What  lessons _____ yesterday?

       A. did  you  have       B. do you  had  

       C. did  you  had        D. do  you  have

 (  ) 8. This  book  is  quite  different _______ that  one .

       A. from    B. with     C. about     D. of

 (  ) 9. Mary  usually_____ TV on  Saturday evening but  she ___

        the cinema last night.

        A. watches , goes         B. watched , went

        C. watched , goes         D. watches , went to

(   )10. Listen! She _____ English by the  lake.

        A. reads     B. read      C. will read    D. is reading

(   )11. There' s a  pen on the  floor. Please _____ for me.

        A. take it up           B. put it up  

        C. bring it up           D. pick it up

(   )12. We ______ an English lesson tomorrow morning.

         A. will be              B. are going to  be

         C. are going to  have     D. is going to  have

(  ) 13. My father wanted ____ a letter to  my grandpa.

        A. me to write           B. my writing

        C. I write               D. my to write

 (  ) 14. The farmers gave us  a basket of  apples _____.

         A. tomorrow             B. the next day 

         C. next week            D. for two days

 (  ) 15. Could you  give me ______ please?

         A. two papers             B. two piece of  papers

         C. two pieces of  paper     D. two piece of  paper

 (  ) 16. Do you  remember _______?

         A. where he live          B. where does he  live

         C. where he lives          D. where lives he

 (  ) 17. We picked _____ apples yesterday.

         A. much    B. a lots of     C. lots of    D. a lot

 (  ) 18. Did you _____ a good time at  the cinema?

        A. had     B. having     C. has     D. have

 (  ) 19. He _____ up before seven this morning.

         A. got      B. gets     C. get      D. getting

 (  ) 20. Yesterday his  brother helped me _____ my English.

         A. for      B. to      C. with     D. at

Ⅳ.用学过的词组或短语代替划线部分, 使新句意思与原句相符:15%, 每空1分.

1. He' splaying basketball now.

  He' s playing basketball ______ ______ ______

2. She is seeing a  film. She is _______ _______ _______

3. Who called me  a moment ago?

  Who _____ me a  moment ago?

4. I had a  busy day yesterday. I _____ _____ yesterday.

5. I showed him  the  photo. I showed the ______ ______ him.

6. Peter  isn' t in. Peter is ______.

7. They picked many apples.

   They picked _______ _______ _______ apples.

Ⅴ.就划线部分提问: 7%

1. John carried the  apples on to  the trucks.

  _______ carried the  apples on to  the trucks?

2. They worked  very  hard.   _______ _______ they work?

3. The children wrote the  answers to the  questions.

   _______ _______ the children do?

4. Jim needed help because he  was ill.

  _______ _______ Jim need help?

Ⅵ.用适当的介词填空: 10%, 每空1分.

1. The man climbed up  the tall tree _______ a tall ladder.

2. Han Meimei is  good ______ skating. She  likes winter very           much because it  is good _______ skating.

3. Liu Hong , here is  a letter ______ you from your brother.

4. Her mother is  out. She is ______the cinema ____ the moment.

5. They went to  work _______ a farm last month.

6. Tom' s mother usually gets up _____ six o' clock in  the              morning.

7. Her father  is a  doctor. He often helps her ______ her maths.

8. Look! Polly is _______ the tree.

Ⅶ.完形填空: 10%

Mr Smith is  a little   1  than  he wants to  be. He  2  to lose some weight (减肥). So he is  on diet (节食). He tries not  to eat too  3  and  he eats very little sugar  4  it will make him  fatter. He also does exercises very  5  . He  swims very  often,  6  he  runs about two  kilometres a day. Now he  is  7  than before. His  wife , Jane is  healthier than him. She does  8  every day , too. She doesn' t  9   much meat. But she  eats a lot  of fruit and  vegetbles because she  thinks 10are better for  her health.

(   )1. A. fat      B. fatter      C. thin      D. thinner

(   )2. A. wants     B. thinks     C. asks     D. likes

(   )3. A. many     B. few      C. little      D. much

(   )4. A. and then      B. so    C. because      D. when

(   )5. A. year      B. week     C. minute      D. day

(   )6. A. and       B. because     C. when      D. bus

(   )7. A. later      B. shorter      C. stronger      D. longer

(   )8. A. shopping   B. exercises    C. housework   D. homework

(   )9. A. buy      B. drink      C. cook      D. eat

(   )10. A. these      B. it      C. that      D. what

 Ⅷ.阅读理解: 20%

(A)

Most of  people make their living with their hands. But Tom  makes his living with his  feet. A very good living it  is , too.

Tom' s story began in  a very small city in  England. His parents were very poor (贫穷). There were seven people in  their small house. Tom had  no place to play but  in the street.

Tom' s father often played football. Little Tom  wanted to play football , too. So his  father made a  nice ball for  him to play. The little boy  played it every day.

At last Tom  learned to play a  real football , and after a  few years he  could play football very well.

Now Tom  is one of  the best football players.

 根据文内容判断正误: 对的打"√", 错的打"×".

(   )1.Tom makes his living in a  different way from other people.

(   )2. Only a  few people make their living with their hands.

(   )3. Little Tom  could play only in  the street.

(   )4. Tom and  his father enjoyed playing football very much.

(   )5. Tom' s father bought him  a new football to  play at first.

(B) Mrs  Simpson' s Soup(汤)

Mrs Simpson wanted to invite (邀请) many people to  her house. She wanted  to  cook them a  good dinner of  meat and soup. She had  five daughters. They were all  busy. Mrs Simpson was  busy , too. She forgot to  put any salt (盐) into the soup. So she  asked Mary, one of  her daughters, to help her.“I can' t , Mum. I' m busy now.”said Mary. She asked the  other girls , but got  the same answer. So she  did it herself.

Now , Mary thought she  should help mother. She put  some salt into the  soup. One by one , the other girls did  the  same thing.

Mrs Simpson put  the soup on  the table. The friends took a little soup and  their eyes opened wide (张大的). She took the  soup, then she knew.“Which of  you put salt into the  soup?”she  asked.“I  did it , Mum.”all the other five said together.

(   )1. Mrs Simpson wanted to  cook _____ for her friends.

       A. rice    B. bread   C. meat and rice   D. meat and  soup

(   )2. Mrs simpson had ________.

       A. two sons and  two daughters    B. five sons

       C. five sons and  five daughters    D. five daughters

(   )3. Mrs Simpson asked ________ to help her.

       A. herself           B. her friends 

       C. Mary            D. Mary and her  sisters

(   )4. ______ put salt into the  soup.

       A. One of the  daughters       B. The five girls

       C. Mrs Simpson and  her five daughters 

       D. Only Mrs Simpson

(   )5. The friends ______ the soup.

       A. like     B. liked    C. don' t like   D. didn' t like

初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

第十六单元(61--64课)试卷

一、找出划线部分的读音不同于其他三个的词:8%

(  )1. A. season    B. dog     C. stop    D. not

(  )2. A. part       B. last     C. past     D. animal

(  )3. A. really      B. weather C. head    D. bread

(  )4. A. enough    B. less     C. ill       D. ticket

(  )5. A. snow      B. cold     C. how     D. boat

(  )6. A. touch      B. cloudy   C. count    D. out

(  ) 7. A. started     B. looked   C. cooked   D. worked

(  )8. A. more       B. morning C. worker  D. story

二、按括号中的要求写出相应的形式:10%

1. well (比较级) _________     2. wear (现在分词) __________      3. snow (过去式) ________      4. warm (最高级) __________

5. season (复数) _________     6. reach (第三人称单数) _____      7. last (反义词) __________     8. hottest (原形) __________

9. bring (过去式) _________     10. bad(比较级) ___________

三、选择填空:20%

(  )1. We  often go ______ in  summer.

       A. swim     B. swimming    C. to swim    D. swims

(  )2. Spring  is  the best  season ______ the  year .

       A. on       B. of           C. at         D. with

(  )3. It's  very  warm  here, _______?

       A. it  is      B. it  isn't       C. isn't  it    D. is  it

(  )4. Sometimes  it  rains _______ here.

       A. heavy     B. big           C. heavily    D. full

(  )5. It's  your  turn  now . Please  get _____for  the  game.

       A. popular      B. nice     C. ready     D. well

(  )6.Which  do  you like ______, oranges  or  pears ?

       A. better        B. best      C. it        D. well

(  )7. "_________ is  the  weather  like is  your  home  town              in wimter?" "It's  very  cold ."

      A. What  time     B. When    C. Where    D. What

(  )8. " _____ is  the  meeting  going  to  last ?"

         " Half  an  hour."

       A. What    B. How  long    C. When      D. How  far

(  )9.Winter  is  over . It's  getting ________.

       A. hot      B. warm         C. cool       D. cold

(  )10. The  farmers  are  busy________ the  next  year .

       A. getting  ready  for         B. putting  on

       C. getting  on               D. having  a  good  time

(  )11. The  work _______the farm  is  very hard.

       A. in       B. on      C. at       D. for

(  )12. There  are four  classes  every  morning, _______?

       A. is  there   B. aren't  there    C. is  it    D. aren't  they

(  )13. Who  is ______, Jim  , Kate  or  li lei ?

       A. taller        B. the  taller    C. tallest    D. the  tallest

(  )14. Could  I  have ______ , please ?

       A. two glasses  of  milks       B. two  glass  of milks

       C. two  glasses  of milk        D. two  glass  milk

(  )15. Tom's  bike  is ______ than ______.

      A. cheaper , her         B. cheaper , hers

      C. the cheaper , hers      D. the cheapest , hers

(  )16. _____you  _____ to  help  the  farmers  to pick the                apples  last Sunday ?

      A. Can, go    B. Did , went    C. Do , go   D. Did , go

(  )17. Autumn  is _____ busy  season .

       A. an        B. a        C. the      D./

(  )18. We  often  play games ______ Friday  afternoon.

       A. in        B. at        C. on      D. of

(  )19. My  father often  works ______ night.

       A. at        B. in         C. on      D. for

(  )20. Could  you _______ the  telephone ?

      A. ask       B. say        C. speak     D. answer

四、用适当的介词填空:12%,每空1分

    1. Thank you ______ your help .

    2. My home  isn't  far ______ our  school.

    3. Which part ______England   do you  come  from?

    4. She  usually gets up ______ six  thirty in  the  morning

    5. What  do  you often  do ______ Sundays?

    6. Spring is  the  best season _______ a  year .

    7. Winter  comes ________ autumn.

    8. He  asked me  _______the weather  here  in China.

    9. Can you help me _____ my English?

    10. What' s the weather ______ in Beijing?

    11. The weather here is  very hot _______ summer.

    12. He came to  Nanning _______ March  last year.

 五、根据下列电话提供的情景, 填上适当的词:20%每空1分.

Mrs Black : Hello!

Mary : ______ I ______ to John?

Mrs Black : Sorry , John isn' t in.

Mary : Is ______ Mrs. Black _______?

Mrs Black : Yes , ______ is it?

Mary : ______ ______ Mary , Mrs Black. I _____ at four this                afternoon , but nobody was  in.

Mrs Black : Oh , we _____ all ______. John wasn' t back home                   then. Can I ______ a ______ for him?

Mary : Yes , please. I can' t help him _____ his lessons this                  evening. I' m afraid , Mother is ill.

Mrs Black : I' m sorry ______ ______ that. Just stay at  home and                look after your mother.

Mary : All right. ______ ______ _______. Bye-bye.

Mrs Black : It' s ______ ______. Good-bye.

六、用所给 单词的正确形式填空:10%,每空1分。

     1. My sister sings well.

       She ______ (sing) an  English song now.

      2. Tom is _______ (young) than Peter.

        He is _______ (young) in his  class.

      3. July is the ______ (hot) month of  the year in  the South.

      4. She ______ (get) up  very late yesterday and  she was                late for school.

      5. _____ he ______ (come) to  visit our school next week?

      6. What ______ (do) your  mother do on  Sundays ?

        She often _______ (go) shopping.

      7. Can I _______ (take) the bus to  the station ?

七、阅读理解:20%

(A) A  Long Word

In an  English class, the students work hard at  their lesson. Their teacher is  very happy. She sings some nice songs with them, and she  goes to the  blackboard and write “S-M-I-L-E-S”on it.

“This is  the longest word in  English,”she said to  the class.

A girl stands up  and says,“It has  only six letters! Why is  it the longest word in  English?”

The teacher smiles and  says,“Because there is a mile between the first letter and  the  last.”

根据短文内容判断正误:对的打“√”,错的打“×”。

(   )1. The students are  having Chinese lessons.

(   )2. The teacher writes some words on  the blackboard.

(   )3. The girl thinks the  word is not  long.

(   )4. The teacher thinks“smiles”is a  long word.

(   )5. The students do  not work hard at  their lessons at  all.

(B)

Mr and  Mrs Jones never go out in the evening, but last Saturday Mrs Jones said to  her husband,“There is  a good film at the  cinema tonight. Shall we  go and see  it?”

Mr Jones was  quite happy about it. So they went, and both of  them enjoyed the  film very much.

When they came out  of the cinema, it was  already 11 o' clock. They got  into their car  and began driving home. It was  very dark. Mrs Jones said,“Look, a woman is  running along the  road very fast and  a man is running after her. Can you  see them?”Mr Jones said.“Yes, I can.”He drove the  car slowly near the  woman and said to  her,“Can I  help you?”

“No, thanks,”said  the woman, but she  didn' t stop running.“My husband and  I always run  home after the  film. Because whoever (不管是谁) gets home last will wash the  dishes.”

(   )1. Mr and  Mrs Jones ________.

       A. often stay at  home in the  evening.

       B. often go out  in the evening.

      C. often go out  to have supprer

      D. often go to  the cinema in  the evening

(   )2. Last Saturday, they ______.

       A. went out for  a walk        

       B. went to see  a film

       C. went to see  a woman       

       D. went to buy  a car

(   )3. ______ enjoyed the film very much.

       A. Mr Jones         B. Mrs Jones

       C. The woman       D. Both Mr and  Mrs Jones

(   )4. On their way  home, they saw ______.

       A. a man running after a  woman

       B. two man running together

       C. a woman running after a  man

       D. two women running together

(   )5. Why  were the man  and the woman running ?

       Because ________.

        A. the woman' s husband was  angry with her

        B. they liked to  run     

       C. they didn' t catch the  bus

        D. they didn' t want to  do housework

初二英语Unit17—19单元测试试卷

Grade:______  Class_____  Name:_________   mark______

一. 单词辨音: 10%

(   )1. A. bright      B. light      C. laugh        D. high

(   )2. A. sugar       B. sure       C. sunshine    D. pleasure

(   )3. A. tiger        B. beautiful   C. nice         D. like

(   )4. A. ready       B. really      C. please       D. season

(   )5. A. January     B. February   C. usually      D. student

(   )6. A. March      B. reach      C. Sandwich   D. Catch

(   )7. A. stopped     B. walked    C. washed     D. worried

(   )8. A. monkeys    B. dumplings  C. finishes     D. countries

(   )9. A. says        B. play        C. may        D. weekday

(   )10. A. laugh       B. autumn    C. taught       D. caught

二. 根据所给单词适当形式填空: 5%

1. Is your father a _______ .   (report)

2. Aunt Li takes exercise everyday. so  she is_____. (health)

3. There are one  hundred____________ (radio) in  our school.

4. It' s __________ (sun) ,  isn' t it?

5. Her brother writes __________. ( careful )

三. 词组: 5%

 1. 天气预报____________         2. 感到高兴__________

 3. 打开电灯____________ 4. 在华南________ 5.最像_______

四. 选择填空: 30%

(   )1. _____ work  it is !

    A. what  a hard           B. what hard

    C. How a hard            D. How  hard

(   )2. What a _____ day. There is  no____in the sky.

       A. sunny. . . cloud         B. sun. . . cloudy

       C. sun. . . cloud           D. Sunny. . . cloudy

(   )3. He spends(花费)_____his time on  English.

       A. many of               B. much  of

       C. much the              D. many the

(   )4. Don' t go  outside! The wind is  blowing_______.

       A. hard       B. hardly      C. strong     D. big

(   )5. Sorry, I ______you about it.

       A. forget to tell           B. forget telling

       C. forgot go tell           D. forgot telling

(   )6. Lucy often goes swimming in  Summer, ______.

       A. so does Mike           B. so is Mike

       C. so  Mike  does           D. Mike does so

(   )7. All of  her_____friends are now  outside  the door.

       A. others       B. another       C. other      D. the other

(   )8. The best time_____to their country is  in autumn.

       A. goes         B. go         C. going        D. to go

(   )9. I' ll  stay at  home. It' s  raining _____ outside.

       A. heavily      B. heavy       C. big          D. large

(   )10. Be quick, They____us outside the  school gate.

       A. are  waiting for          B. are waiting

       C. waited for                D. will  wait

(   )11. Mr John came here_____.

        A. got it back                 B. got back it

        C. to get it  back              D. to get back it

(   )12. She never wants to  get the book back, ____she?

       A. isn' t         B. does      C. doesn' t    D. won' t

(   )13. I listen to  the weather report _____the radio every day.

       A. at          B. in         C. on        D. by

(   )14. Fuzhou is  ____-the southest of  China.

        A. to         B. on         C. in          D. at

(   )15. _____the flowers are  beautiful .

        A. The most   of        B. Most of

        C. Most a               D. Of most

(   )16. He looks ill.  He _____and see  his doctor.

        A. needs go             B. need to go

        C. needs to go           D. needs  going

(   )17. He  has never learned Fereuch _______English.

         A. or         B. and        C. with       D. in

(   )18. Do you  know  when the  meeting is going to______.

         A. have       B. has         C. be         D. is

(   )19. When I  open the door, I  found my mother_____.

         A. in home    B. in        C. out home     D. is in

(   )20. I know______.

        A. when does she  leave.       B. when did she  leave.

        C. when she  left.             D. when is she  leaving

五.句型转换: (每格一空)10%

1. It' ll be sunny tomorrow.(划线提问)

   What' s the  _______  ______ tomorrow?

2. There will be  a meeting this afternoon. (改为一般疑问句)

   _____ there ______ a meeting this  afternoon?

3. I' m afraid he  knows your name.(改为否定句)

   I ______ afraid he ______ know your name.

4. They went to  the farm last week.(改为反意疑问句)

   They went to  the farm last week, _____  ______?

5. Mr Green came to China three years ago. (划线提问)

   _______  _______  Mr  Green come to  China.

六. 根据所给动词的适当形式填空: 10%

1. Winter______(last) from  Novemker to January.

2. Two hours ago, Bruce______(come) here_____(ask) you  to his party. He ______(want) you ______(ring) him.

3. thanks  a  lot  for ______ (ask) us  to  your  birthday  party.

4. It ___(be) hot  today . But  I  think  It ____(be) cool  later  on.

5. The  little ____(run) to  the  door  and  opened  it.

6. The  teacher  says  there ______(be)  a  class  meeting  this  afternoon .  Please  get  ready.

七. 改错: 10%

1.(   )_____How  delicious  sankwiches  we  had  this  morning!

              A                 B          C       D

2. (   )_____I  don't  like  winter  because  it's  too  much  cold.

                 A                B       C    D

3. (   )______I  think  the  weather  will  be  very  better  soon.

                 A                 B       C           D

4. (   )____ _There  is  nothing  in  the  room ,  isn't  there ?

                   A    B     C                 D

5. (   )______ I  usually  read  a  book  for   some  time  after  

                                A       B               C

              I go  to bed .  

                    D

八. 完形填空: 12%

A train stopped at  a small station. A  man on the  train looked 1._____ the  window and saw  a woman. The  woman was selliny cakes, and  people from 2.____ train were buying them. The  man 3.____ to  buy a cake, but  the woman was  4.____ far  from him. It  was raining and  he didn' t want to  go out 5.____ the  rain.

Sudolenly(突然) he saw  a boy.  The boy  was walking on  the platform (站台) 6.____ from him.  "Come here, boy! " the  man said. "Do you  know 7.___ each of  the cakes is? " "Five Cents (美分) ", The boy  8.____. The mem  gave the boy  ten cents and  asked him 9.____ two cakes. "One is  for me ,  and 10_____for you, " he  told the boy.

Some minutes later, the  boy came back.

He was  eating a cake. He  11.____ the mem five Cents and  said, "There was  only 12._____. "

(   )1. A. at          B. for        C. up        D. out of

(   )2. A. a           B. an        C. the        D. /

(   )3. A. wanted      B. asked      C. thought    D. like

(   )4. A. stand        B. standing    C. stay       D. stood

(   )5. A. to          B. on         C. with      D. in

(   )6. A. not near     B. not far     C. far        D. near

(   )7. A. how much   B. what is    C. how many   D. how

(   )8. A. answers                   B. answered

       C. is  answering              D. will answer

(   )9. A. bought                    B. to  buy

       C. buying                     D. buy

(   )10. A. other        B. another     C. the other     D. others

(   )11. A. said  to      B. took        C. gave         D. told

(   )12. A. one  cake           B. two cakes  

       C. some  cakes         D. a lot of  cakes

九. 阅读理解: 8%

Kate  and Peter like sports. In  summer they swim and  in winter they skate.  They are  planning(计划)  a skate trip for  this weekend, but  they don' t know about the  waeather. It' s 7 : 30 now, and  they are listering to  the weather report on  the radio. The  weather---man is giving the  weather report for  the weekend.

" Friday is going to  be cold and  cloudy, but it' s not  going to rain. The  temperafure is going to  be below 2ero. It' s going to  snow on Friday evening. Saturday and  Sunday are going to  be cold and  Sunny. "

Now Kate and  Peter are happy. The  weather is going to  be very nice for  a skate trip. They are  going to have a  good time on  the  hills.

(   )1. Kate and  Peter like_____.

    A. listening to the  radio          B. watching TV

    C. sports                        D. music

(   )2. They are  planning______for this weekend.

    A. a class meeting               B. a party

    C. a game                       D. a skate trip

(   )3. They wanted to  know about______.

     A. the rain                      B. the food

     C. the  weather                   D. the radio

(   )4. It______on Saturday and  Sunday.

      A. will rain              B. will  be windy

      C. will be cloudy         D. will be cold and  sun.

坝下中学初二英语选拔试卷

一. 辨音: 10%

A. 从每组单词中, 选出划线部分发音不同的一个. 5%

(   )1. A. B. C. D.

(   )2. A. B. C. D.

(   )3. A. B. C. D.

(   )4. A. B. C. D.

(   )5. A. B. C. D.

B. 判断每组单词, 划线部分发音的种类. 5%

   A. 一种       B. 二种       C. 三种      D. 四种

(   )1. A. B. C. D.

(   )2. A. B. C. D.

(   )3. A. B. C. D.

(   )4. A. B. C. D.

(   )5. A. B. C. D.

二. 根据句意填上适当的单词10%

三. 选择题 : 20%

(   )1. A. B. C. D.

(   )2. A. B. C. D.

(   )3. A. B. C. D.

(   )4. A. B. C. D.

(   )5. A. B. C. D.

(   )6. A. B. C. D.

(   )7. A. B. C. D.

(   )8. A. B. C. D.

(   )9. A. B. C. D.

(   )10. A. B. C. D.

(   )11. A. B. C. D.

(   )12. A. B. C. D.

(   )13. A. B. C. D.

(   )14. A. B. C. D.

(   )15. A. B. C. D.

(   )16. A. B. C. D.

(   )17. A. B. C. D.

(   )18. A. B. C. D.

(   )19. A. B. C. D.

(   )20. A. B. C. D.

四. 口语运用 10%

(   )1. ①②③④⑤

    A. ①②③④⑤B. ④②③①⑤C. ④②⑤①③D. ③②①⑤④

(   )2. ①②③④⑤

    A. ②①③⑤④B. ⑤③②①④C. ①②⑤④③D. ④⑤①③②

(   )3. ①②③④⑤

    A. ①②③④⑤B. ③①②④⑤C. ①③②④⑤D. ⑤②③④①

(   )4. ①②③④⑤

    A. ②④③⑤①B. ②④③①⑤C. ②⑤③④①D. ③⑤②①④

(   )5. ①②③④⑤

    A. ③①④②⑤B. ③②①⑤④C. ①②③④⑤D. ⑤③④①②

五. 句型转换. 10% (每个空格只准填写一个单词)

(改为一般疑问句)(改为否定句)(改成复数)(改为比较级)(划线提问)

六. 时态填空. 10%

   A. 用所给词的适当形式填空: 5%

   B. 根据短文意思, 用适当的形式填空: 5%

A fox(狐狸)is_______ for food. He  is very hungry. Now  he is  standing near a  wall. the wall is  very high. The  fox is looking up.  He_______a lot of  fine grapes (葡萄)on the  wall. He says, "How nice they are! I  want______ them. "  The fox is  jumping. He jumps and  jumps and jumps. But  the wall is  too high. He  can' t___ thegrapes. The  fox says, " I  must go now. I______these grapes. They are  green. They are  not good to eat."

七. 完型填空: 选择可填入空白处的最佳答案. 10%

八. 阅读理解: 根据短文内容, 选择一个最佳答案. 10%

坝下中学初二英语选拔试卷

一、辨音10%

 A. 从每组单词中, 选出划线部分发音不同的一个5%

(   )1.A. China      B. Lunch    C. chair      D. machine

(   )2.A. pens       B. clocks     C. books    D. maps

(   )3.A. uncle       B. supper    C. study    D. student

(   )4.A. glasses     B. houses    C. buses    D. classes

(   )5.A. moved     B. stayed     C. walked    D. cleaned

B.判断每组单词, 划线部分发音的种类. 5%

1. Septemter is the ______month of  a year.

2. Lucy and Lily look the _______.

3. Please give me  something to eat. I' m a  little____.

4. How ______ is  the meat?  Eighteen yuan a  kilo.

5. What_____ going to  the Park? Good idea.

B. 根据汉语提示, 用词组适当形式填空.

      A. 一种    B. 二种   C. 三种      D. 四种

(   )1.  too      room    classroom    foot

(   )2.  sugar   usually   beds        cakes

(   )3.  write    give      police       April

(   )4.  enough   out       round       touch

(   )5.   Sandwich    machine     school    China

二. 根据句意填上适当的单词10%

1. The most popular food is  fish and_____in England.

2. _____Chicken is the  most popular food in  the USA.

3. Canadians speak English and______.

4. Tom would like Chinese tea______nothing in  it.

5. Which do you  like______, pears or  apples?

6. What is the  weather like _______Beijing?

7. Lucy and Lily are  in _______classes.

8. The fourth day  of a week is_______.

9. There are four_______in a  year.

10. Thanks for your ______me to  your birthday party.

三.选择填空. (15分)

(   )1. She often gets ____school____7:30,

       A. at, in    B. to, on    C. /, at    D. to, at

(   )2. _____some orange in  the bottle.

       A. It has   B. It is    C. There is   D. There are

(   )3. There are  some new shoes, please put____.

       A. on them  B. on it   C. it on   D. them on

(   )4. Is there____milk in  the bottle? Yes, there's_____.

       A. much, a lot  of        B. many, a lot

       C. any, much            D. some, a lot  of

(   )5. Ann_____lunch at 11:30. She ____it at  12:00.

       A. doesn' t have, has       B. don' t have; has

       C. isn' t have;   have       D. doesn' t has ; has

(   )6. _____does Meimei come to  school? On a  bike.

       A. What     B. Where      C. Whenn    D. How

(   )7. It' s time _____have  supper.

       A. for        B. to         C. of         D. in

(   )8. Can't you  see a plane in  the sky? _____.

       A. Yes, I can't      B. Yes, I can  

       C. No, I can       D. Not,  I can' t 

(   )9. This pencil-box is _____than that one.错误的种为:

       A. more nicer          B. much nicer

       C. nicer               D.a little nicer

(   )10. _____apples are hard to reach. Please____careful.

       A. A few ; to be         B. A  little ;  be

       C. A few; be           D. A few; /

(   )11. _____the teacher , then you  can _____ her.

       A. Listen; hear           B. Listen to; hear

       C. Hear; listen           D. Hear;  listen to

(   )12. Ann' s room is  small. But mine is  smaller____.

       A. than she  B. of her   C. than her  D. than hers

(   )13. New term begins_____September 1.

        A. in        B. on       C. at        D. with

(   )14. A: What are you  going to do  this Sunday?

        B: ______. Why?

        A. Not a thing          B. Nothing much

        C. Much a thing        D. Much  nothing

(   )15.There's going to___ an English lesson this afternoon.    A. have        B. has      C. is      D. be

(   )16. ____is the  farm ?   It' s about 2  kilometres.

       A. How long        B. How many   

       C. How far          D.How much

(   )17. There is nobody in  the room, ______?

        A. isn' t there    B. isn' t it   C. is there  D. is it

(   )18. She likes singing, _______.

        A. I do so   B. I so do   C. so I  do   D. so do I

(  )19. China is ____the west of  Japan.

       A. in    B. on     C. at      D. to

(  )20. ---Jack, happy birthday to  you! ______.

       A. The same to  you      B. Not at all.

       C. Thank you          D. It is a  pleasure

 四. 口语应用10%

(   )1. ①Which boy?

       ②Who' s that boy  under the big  tree?

       ③Excuse me.  Li Hong.

       ④Oh, that' s Lucy' s brother. He  studies well.

       ⑤The one  in the white shirt.

       A. ①②③④⑤       B. ④②③①⑤

       C. ④②⑤①③       D. ③②①⑤④

(   )2. ①Who has a  bike?

       ②I  have one  here, Li  Lei.

       ③Thanks a  lot.

       ④Certainly! Here you  are.

        ⑤May I borrow it,  please?

        A. ②①③⑤④        B.⑤③②①④

        C. ①②⑤④③        D. ④⑤①③②

(   )3.①They're round, like the moon.they're very delicious.    ②Yes, a little.

       ③Would you  like one of  these mooncakes?

      ④I' d love to. But why do you call them mooncaks.

       ⑤Mary, are  you hungry.

       A. ①②③④⑤      B. ③①②④⑤

       C.①③②④⑤      D. ⑤②③④①

(   )4. ①Good  idea! Let' s meet about half past two.

       ②Shall we go  to the zoo?

       ③Hi, Xiao Wang. What are  you going to do this        Sunday?

       ④OK.      ⑤I' ve  no idea.

A. ②④③⑤①      B. ②④③①⑤

C. ②⑤③④①      D. ③⑤②①④

(   )5. ①We' re going to  pick apples on  a farm. Don't          you know?

        ②And we' re going there by  bus.

        ③What are  you going to  do this Sunday?

        ④Sorry, I  don' t know.

        ⑤Good idea! It' s much better than having classes.      A. ③①④②⑤         B. ③②①⑤④

        C. ①②③④⑤         D. ⑤③④②①

五. 句型转换.10%(每个空格只准填写一个单词)

1. Tom  usually has Lunch at  school.(改为一般疑问句)

   ______ Tom usually_______Lunch at  school?

2. He  read a lot  of books in  the library.(改为否定句)

   He______ read ______ books  in the library.

3. The  child often goes to  school by bus. (改为复数)

   The______ often ______to  school by bus.

4. This  cake is very delicious. That one  is more delicious. (改为比较级)

   That cake is  more delicious______ ______one.

5. They' re going to  play football  this  afternoon.(就划线部   分提问) _____are they going to _____ this arternoon.

六. 时态填空.10%

 A. 用所给词的适当形式填空: 5%

1. You' d  better _________  (not talk) in class.

2. Listen!  Someone ________  (sing) in the  next room.

3. ________  (not be) late again.

4. The farmers  need _______(help) with the picking-apples.

5.Lucy  always______ (do) her homework in  the evening.

B. 根据短文意思, 用适当的形式填空.5%

A fox(狐狸)is 1.____(look) for  food. He is  very hungry. Now  he is standing near a  wall. the wall is  very high. The  fox is looking up.  He 2._____(see) a  lot of fine grapes (葡萄)on the  wall. He says, "How nice they are! I  want 3.____ (eat) them. " The fox  is jumping. He  jumps and jumps and  jumps. But the  wall is too  high. He can' t 4._____(get) the  grapes. The fox  says, " I must go  now. I 5._________(not like)these grapes. They are  green. They are  not good to eat."

七.完形填空: 选择可填入空白处的最佳答案. (10分)

Class Two  are not going to  have 1____ lessons next week. They' re going to  help the farmers 2____their work on  the  farm. They' re going to  3.____apples. Many students 4____ it  is much better than 5____ classes. They are  going to 6.____earlier next Monday morning. They' re going to  7.____ at the school gate at  about 7:30. They 8.___there by  bus. They are  going to 9____their old  clothes. They are  going to 10.____ hard.

(   )1. A. some       B. any      C. a       D. a lot of

(   )2. A. on          B. to       C. doing    D.do

(   )3. A. pick      B. picking   C. picks    D. are picking (   )4. A. look       B. think      C. know    D. want

(   )5. A. have      B. having    C. has     D.are having

(   )6. A. get up  B. put on  C. to to  bed D.have classes (   )7. A. leave       B. reach    C. meet      D. pick

(   )8. A. are going   B. go   C. going   D. are going to (   )9. A. put on      B. put    C. take off     D. buy

(    )10. A. study       B. walk    C. work     D. working

八.阅读理解:根据短文内容,选择一个最佳答案. (10分)  

                         (A)

The Spring Festival(春节) is  the Chinese New Year' s Day.  It usually comes in  February. Everyone in  China likes Spring Festival very much. When Spring Festival comes,  Li  Lei usually helps his  parents clean their house and  do come shopping and  other housework. On  that day, everyone in  China eats "jiaozi", New  Year' s cakes. But  Han Meimei says jiaozi is  nicer than New  Year' s cake. The  Chinese people eat  New Year' s cakes and  jiaozi in their houses.  How happy they are!

(   )1. The Spring Festival usually comes____February.

       A. on           B. in       C. at      D. to

(   )2. When Spring Festival comes, Li  Lei_____.

       A. does his homework and  plays football with his       friends

        B. helps his parents with the  housework

        C. helps his parents do  some shopping and  clean         the house

        D. both B  and  C

(   )3. On that day, eveyone in  China often eats____.

       A. jiaozi and New  Year' s cakes

       B. mooncakes and apples

       C. jiaozi and mooncakes

       D. New Year's cakes and  apples

(   )4. ____thinks jiaozi is  nicer than New  Year's cake.

       A. Li Lei  B. Everyone C. Han Meimei D. Li Ming (  )5. The Chinese people eat jiaozi and  New Year' s             cakes_____.

       A. in the open air         B. at home

       C. outside the houses       D. on their way  home

(B)

Children in the USA  like K Day  much. K is  for kites. March 7  is the day. On  that day a  lot of children go  out in the  open air.  They take their kites with them. Some kites are  very big. Others are  small. They are  different colours.  Every kite has  a long string(绳).

To get  the kites up  the children run.  They let  out the string from the  ball in their hands. Now  the kites are  flying in the  air. How nice they look!

Now all  of the kites are  high up in  the air. Some are  higher than others. The  one like a bird is the highest. But what' s wrong ? It' s flying away! The string is  broken.

Another kite gets away. And  more kites fly. The  children are running after them. They wat  to get them back. People are  watching them and  laughing. 

(   )1. March 7  is _____in the USA.

       A. Kites' s Day              B. Children' s Day

       C. New Year' s Day          D. Running Day

(   )2. Kites are  in ____ colours.

       A. the same   B. different    C. white    D.black

(   )3. ______ kites get away.

       A. One       B. Two      C. Three    D. Some

(   )4. The one  like a bird is_____.

       A. the smallest of  all       B. the biggest of  all

       C. higher  than others       D. nicer than others

(   )5. Which sentence is  not right?

    A. The children are  having a good time on  that          day.

     B. All the kites have long strings.

     C. The children are  running after the  kites.

     D. The children want to  let the kites fly  away.

九. 综合填空(根据短文意思, 用适当的词填空, 每格      只准填一个词)10%

Yesterday Tom  didn' t feel  1._____. He went to  2.____the doctor. The  doctor Looked over(仔细检查)Tom 3.____ a  4.____ minutes. Then the  doctor said, "I am  afraid you 5.____ a  bad cold .  6.____ this medicine(药) and  7.____in bed for  two days, and  you will soon be  8._____. When Tom  asked the doctor how  much the medicine was, the  doctor said 9.____ a smile, "Don' t you  10.____ me. I  am your uncle."

坝下中学初二英语选拔试卷答案卡

 成绩_______

一. 辨音10%

A. 5%   1._____ 2._____ 3. _____  4._____ 5._____

B. 5%   1._____ 2._____ 3. _____  4._____ 5._____

二. 填词10%1.____ 2._____ 3. _____  4._____ 5._____

           6._____ 7._____ 8. _____  9._____ 10._____

三. 选择题21%:

1.____   2.____   3. ____    4.____   5.____

6.____   7.____   8. ____    9.____   10.____

11.____ 12.____   13. ____   14.____  15.____  

16.____ 17.____   18. ____   19.____  20.____

四. 口语运用.10%

1._____ 2._____ 3. _____  4._____ 5._____

五. 句型转换. 10%1. ____   ____    2.____  ____

        3.___ ____  4._____  ____  5.____ _____

六. 时态填空. 10%

A. 1._____ 2._____ 3. _____  4._____ 5._____

B. 1._____ 2._____ 3. _____  4._____ 5._____

七. 完形填空.10%

1._____ 2._____ 3. _____  4._____ 5._____ 

6._____ 7. _____ 8. _____ 9._____10.______

八.阅读理解10%:

A: 1._____ 2._____ 3. _____  4._____ 5._____

B: 1._____ 2._____ 3. _____  4._____ 5._____

九. 综合填空: 10%

1._____ 2._____ 3. _____  4._____ 5._____

6._____ 7._____ 8. _____  9._____ 10._____

 初二英语练习卷 (20—21)

 

 一、语音

     找出一个与所给单词划线部分读音相同的单词.10分

(   )1. half    A. walk    B. autumn    C. laugh   D. matter

(   )2. shine   A. winter    B. spring    C. give    D. unlike

(   )3. cool    A. food     B. cook    C. bedroom   D. look

(   )4. quarter  A. March   B. warm   C. harvest   D. farm

(   )5. birthday  A. Friday   B. says   C. stay   D. Sunday

(   )6. laugh    A. of     B. photo    C. bright    D. night

(   )7. great   A. vegetable  B. cabbage  C. English  D. oranges

(   )8. sure   A. sugar    B. supper    C. usually    D. school

(   )9. talk    A. also    B. salt     C. always     D. walk

(   )10. panda   A. what   B. worse    C. last    D. banana 

二. 根据句意补全句子, 每格一词. 7分

1. Today is  Monday. The day _____ _____will be Wednesday.

2. Let' s stop ______ have a  rest.

3. I thank Uncle Wang ______ his help.

4. Which do  you like _____, fish and  chips of chicken?

5. She wanted to _____ ready for  the party.

6. In _____ the most popular food is  fried chicken.

三. 按要求写单词. 10分

   1. cool (反义词) _______    2. tomato (复数) _______

   3. wear (过去式) _______   4. below (反义词) ______

   5. easy (副词) ________      6. also (同义词) _______

   7. radio (复数) ________     8. worry (形容词) _______

   9. beautiful (最高级) ______  10. worse (原级) ________

四. 单项选择. 40分

(   )1. I know he  often _______eggs at home.

       A. have      B. has     C. had     D. having

(   )2. Could you ____ me the  cup, please?

       A. take     B. past     C. carry     D. pass

(   )3. You work in  a factory, _____ you?

       A. isn' t     B. aren' t      C. don' t     D. doesn' t

(   )4. Not everyone _____ sandwiches.

       A. like    B. likes     C. liked     D. liking

(   )5. Tom studies English very hard . ______.

       A. So do  Kate         B. So does Kate

       C. So Kate do         D. So Kate does

(   )6. It takes half an  hour ___ my homework every day.

       A. do     B. does     C. did      D. to do

(   )7. I' m afraid it  will rain _____ the day.

       A. later on    B. later to    C. later in    D. late on

(   )8. Beijing is  the secand _____ city in  China.

       A. big     B. bigger     C. bigest     D. biggest

(   )9. There is  no time ______ us _______.

       A. to , think         B. to , to think

       C. for , think        D. for , to think

(   )10. You' ll near forget that day, _____?

        A. shall you   B. won' t you   C. will you  D. shan' t

(   )11. Ann is  very happy to  wear the feather _____ his hat.

        A. in       B. on      C. for      D. with

(   )12. Please _____ the TV set. It' s time for  weather report.

        A. open      B. close      C. turn on      D. turn off

(   )13. Would you  like _____ to drink?

         A. cool anything         B. anything cool

         C. something cool         D. cool something

(   )14. I had  a cup of  tea ____ sugar and milk.

        A. to      B. with      C. in      D. at

(   )15. New York is ____ the ____ of America.

        A. in , east   B. to , north   C. on , south   D. at , west

(   )16. Is that Mr  Chen speaking? Yes, ______?

        A. Who are you         B. Who' s it

        C. Who' s that           D. I' m Mr Chen

(   )17. My uncle lives in ______ South China.

        A. /      B. a     C. the    D. this

(   )18. There are _______ chip shops in  China.

        A. not so many         B. no so many

        C. not  so lot            D. not so much

(   )19. There ____ a meeting the  day after tomorrow.

        A. will have              B. is going to  be 

        C. is going to  have        D. was going to  be

(   )20. Mr Zhang is _____ us at  the school gate?

        A. waiting   B. waited   C. waiting for  D. waiting to

五. 用所给词的适当形式填空. 10分

    1. What a ______ (sun) day!

    2. His mother is  ill. He is ______(worried) about  her.

    3. The wind is  blowing _______ (strong).

    4. My parents _______(fly) to Shanghai tomorrow.

    5. It' s time for  class. Let' s stop _______ (play).

    6. She asked me ______ (go) shopping with her.

    7. He _____ any lessons on  Saturday (not have)

   8. This book is  very _____ (big) I  think it is _____ (big)          one of the  four.

    9. Please bring me  the ______ (knife). I' ll  use them.

六. 完成对话. 10分

A: Hello! .

B: Oh, hello! Could I  1   to Li  Ming, please?

A: Sure, One  2   , please.

C: Hello! Li  Ming is here.

B: Oh, hello. Li  Ming!  3    4   Tom.

C: Hi, Tom!

B: Li Ming are  you  5  this  affernoon?

C: Yes, I am.  What are you  going to do?

B: I' m going to  6  a  swim.  7  you like to  go with me?

C: Yes, I' d love to.  What time shall we  go?

B: What about half past one?

C: All right, Why   8  ask  Li Lei to  to with us?

B: Good  9   . I' ll  10  him up  later. Goodbye!

C: Bye!

1 ______  2 ______  3 _______  4 _______  5 _______

6 ______  7 ______  8 _______  9 _______  10 ______

七. 句型转换. 5分

  1. I had  no time to  open it.

    I didn' t ______ ______ time to  open it.

  2. Let the  twins go with him. (反意疑问句)

    Let the  twins go with him, ______ ______?

  3. They often put  the food in paper bags.

     ______ ______ they  often put the  food?

  4. I' d like tea  with milk in  it.

    _____ _____ _____ tea would you  like.

  5. The boy  sits in Row  2. The girl sits in  Row 2, too.

    The boy  sits in Row  2. So _______ the girl.

八. 阅读. 8分

One morning Mr  Black is driving in  the country (乡村) and looking for  a small hote (旅馆). When he  sees an old  woman on the  side of the  road, he stops his  car and says to  the old woman,“I want to  go to the  Sun Hotel. Do you  know it?”

“Yes,”the old woman says,“I will show you  the way.”She gets in  Mr Black' s car, and they drive about 12  miles (英里). When they come to  a small house, the  old woman says,“stop here.”Mr Black stops and  looks at the  house.“But  it isn' t the  hotel,”he  says to the  old woman.

“No,”She  answers,“This is  my house. And I' ll show you  the way to  the hotel. Turn back, And go  back nine miles. Then you' ll see  the hotel.”

(   )1. What is  Mr Black doing that morning?

       A. He' s walking in  the country.

       B. He is working in  the hotel.

       C. He is looking for  a hotel  to live in

       D. He is driving a  small  bus.

(   )2. Mr Black asks the  old woman ______.

       A. to take his  car.      

       B. the way to  the hotel.

       C. to help him  mend his car.

       D. the way back home.

(   )3. After she  gets in the  car, they drive ____ and stop.

       A. nine miles              B. twenty miles

       C. twelve kilometres         D. twelve miles

(   )4. Why does the  old woman stop him  in front of  the house? Because ________.

A. the small house is  hers.

B. She is  too hungry.

C. there' s something wrong with the  car.

D. they get  to the hotel.

 初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

 第二十二单元(85—88课)试卷

Ⅰ. 找出划线部分读音不同于其他三个的词: 10%

(   )1. A. lived    B. laughed    C. played    D. answered

(   )2. A. can' t     B. past       C. cinema   D. ask

(   )3. A. reach    B. please      C. east       D. ready

(   )4. A. find      B. until       C. right      D. write

(   )5. A. road      B. grow       C. cow      D. know

(   )6. A. matter    B. danger     C. traffic    D. January

(   )7. A. around    B. young      C. country   D. enough

(   )8. A. easily      B. happily    C. fly       D. quickly

(   )9. A. dear       B. hear       C. near      D. heard

(   )10. A. brother   B. mother    C. than      D. third

Ⅱ. 按括号中的要求写出相应的形式: 15%

1. tomato (复数) _________  2. watch (复数) __________

3. easily (形容词) ________  4. right (同音词) ________

5. left (反义词) __________  6. many (比较级) ________

7. stop (过去式) __________  8. they (反身代词) ______

9. radio (复数) ___________  10. wife (复数) __________

11. north (形容词) ________ 12. two (序数词) _________

13. thank (过去式) ________ 14. me (复数) ___________

15. get (现在分词) ________

Ⅲ. 选择填空: 20%

(   )1. The house ____ the right is  a school.

       A. on      B. in      C. with      D. at

(   )2. They' ll see  the zoo _____ of them.

       A. in the front        B. in front

       C. at front           D. on front

(   )3. The school is  very far. It will __ you about 2 hours.           A. bring    B. take    C. show    D. give

(   )4. _____ kind the  girl is !

       A. What     B. What a    C. How     D. How a

(   )5. The granny ___ the letter and  showed it to Liu Mei.

       A. looked for    B. found    C. saw   D. looked

(   )6. I asked the  old man ______.

       A. what was wrong       B. how was wrong

        C. what wrong was      D. how  wrong

(   )7. Please _____ the traffic lights.

       A. turn right at          B. turn on  right

       C. turn at right          D. turn off right

(   )8. They went _____ walk in  the park.

       A. to for a     B. for     C. for a    D. a

(   )9. Go to  asd him. ____ he knows the  way.

       A. May     B. Maybe     C. May be    D. Must

(   )10. — The  pen may be  in the desk.

        — Ah , _____.

        A. so is to          B. so it does    

        C. so does it        D. so it is

(   )11. You' d better ____ again.

        A. not to be  late          B. not be late

        C. to not be  late           D. be not late

(  )12. ____ is the  way to the  North Street Hospital ,               please ?

         A. What    B. Where    C. How    D. Which  

(   )13. The story happened in  the city ____ shanghai.

        A. in     B. at     C. on     D. of

(   )14. It will take you  half an hour ___ your homework.

       A. to finish    B. finishing   C. finish   D. finished

(   )15. Will this bus _____ you to  the hospital?

        A. go      B. take     C. takes     D. brings

(   )16. ____ , they returned to  China again.

        A. After three weeks      B. Three weeks later

        C. Three weeks after      D. Later three weeks

(   )17. Xiao Li  is ____. We' ll go to  see him tomorrow.

        A. in hosptial            B. in hospitals

        C. in a hospital          D. in the hospital

(   )18. Of all  the apples on  the table , this one  is ____.

        A. very red            B. much redder   

        C. reddest             D. the reddest

(   )19. Kate does ____ in English.

        A. good      B. nice    C. well     D. fine

(   )20. He left for Guangzhou ___ a cold spring morning.

        A. of      B. in     C. at     D. on

Ⅳ. 按要求变换句子: 15% , 每空1分.

1. The little girl does her  homework after supper every         day. (否定句)

  The little girl ____ ____ her homework after supper           every day.

2. The new  student is very tall. (感叹句)

   How _____ the new  student _____!

3. My sister works in Wuhan. (就划线部分提问)

  ______ _____ your sister ______?

4. It will take you  an hour to  get to the  station. (就划线      部分提问)

  _____ _____ will it _____ you to  get to the  station?

5. We' d better catch a  bus. (否定句)

   We _____ _____ _____ catch b bus.

 6. He goes to school on  foot every day. (改写为同义句)

   He _____ _____ school every day.

Ⅴ. 选用所给的单词填空: 10% , 每空1分.

friend , friendly , beautiful , beautifully , strong , strongly ,        bright , brightly , easy , easily

1. How ______ your room is!  2. This is  a ______ flower.

3. Tom is ______.  4. Basketball is ______ to play. We         can play it _____.  5. The wind blows _____ by the  sea.

6. Listen! How ______ Mary is singing!

7. The sun  is shining ______.  

8. He is  my good _____. He is  always _____ to all of  us.

Ⅵ. 完成下列对话: 10%

Going Shopping

( Mother is  going out with a  basket , her daughter , Ann ,       sees her )

Ann : Mum , where are you  going?

Mum :  1  .

Ann : OK. By the  way , what are you  going to buy?

Mum :   2   .

Ann : Could you  buy some eggs and  meat , please?

Mum :  3   . Which do  you like better , beef or  pork?

Ann : Pork. It' s my  favourite.  4   .

Mum : OK. I think we  also want to  buy some marrows             (葫芦).

Ann :  5  . I  think the meal will be  delicious.

Mum : Oh , I nearly forget. We  have no much sugar , and           I must buy  two kilos of  it.

Ann : Godbye , Mum.

Mum : Goodbye.

从下列答案中选择正确选项:

A. Good evening.           B. Certainly. 

C. I' m going to  buy something.

D. Nice to  meet you.        E. Good idea.

F. I' m going to  buy some vegetables —tomatoes ,              cabbages , cattots and some salt.

G. But please buy  some beef , too.

1. _____  2. _____  3. _____  4. _____  5. _____

Ⅶ. 阅读理解: 20%

(A)

Jack worked in  an office in  a small town. One  day his boss said to  him ,“Jack , I want you  to go to  Manchester , to an office there to  see Mr. Brown. Here' s the  address (地址).”

Jack went to  Manchester by train. He  left the station and  thought,“The office isn' t far  from the station. I' ll find it  easily.”

But after an  hour he was  still looking for  it , so he stopped and  asked an old  lady. She said,“Go  straight along this street , turn to  the left at  the end. And  it' s the second building on  the right.”Jack went and  found it.

A few  days later he  went to the  same city , but again he  did not find the  office , so he asked someone the  way. It was  the same old  Lady! She was  very surprised (惊奇的) and said,“Are you  still looking for  that place?”

根据短文内容选择正误:对的打“√”,错的打“×”.

(  )1. Jack worked in  an office in  a large town.

(  )2. Jack' s boss wanted hom  to go to  Manchester.

(  )3. Jack didn' t find the  office easily.

(  )4. Jack went to  Manchester again a  few months later.

(  )5. He asked the  same old lady the  way again.

(B)  A Greedy (贪婪的) Man

One of  Mike' s friends love money very much , and never gave anything to  anybody. Soon he  was rich.

One day , he was  walking near the  river with his  friends.Suddenly he fell into the  river. His friends ran  to help him. One  of them held out  his hand and  said ,“Give me  your hand , and I' ll pull you  out!”The rich man  went under the  water and then came up  again , but he didn' t give his  friend his hand. Again another of  his friends try  to help , again the  rich man did  the same thing.

Then Mike said ,“Take  my hand and  I' ll pull you  out.”The rich man  took his hand and  Mike pulled him  out of the  water.

“You don' t know our  friend very well,”he  said to the  others.“When you  say‘Give’to  him , he does nothing , but when you  say‘Take’, he  takes. ”

(  )1. One of  Mike' s friends liked ____ very much.

        A. his family            B. money

        C. to take everything     D. to give anything

(  )2. the rich man ____ anything to  anybody.

       A. never borrowed       B. didn' t give

       C. never took            D. didn' t lend

(  )3. When the  rich man was  walking near the  river               with his friends , ______.

       A. he fell into it      B. Mike fell into it

        C. he jumped into it  D. his friend jumped into it

(  )4. His friend ran  to _____.

       A. tell his family         B. see him

       C. help him             D. call for him

(  )5. When people say“____”, the  rich man does ___.

       A. Money , everything     B. Take , nothing

       C. Give , nothing          D. Take , not take

 初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

 第二十三单元(89—92课)试卷

Ⅰ. 找出划线部分的读音不同于其他三个的词 : 10%

(  )1. A. worker   B. teacher   C. sister    D. term

(  )2. A. clean     B. easy      C. heavy    D. meat

(  )3. A. lesson    B. behind    C. text      D. rest

(  )4. A. talk       B. walk      C. always   D. small

(  )5. A. station    B. page       C. late      D. Japanese

(  )6. A. ticket     B. chicken    C. give      D. Chinese

(  )7. A. day       B. play       C. always   D. says

(  )8. A. grow      B. know      C. now     D. yellow

(  )9. A. cross      B. post       C. note      D. photo

(  )10. A. autumn   B. laugh      C. daughter   D. August

Ⅱ. 按照括号里的要求写出相应的形式: 10%

1. country (复数) __________  2. visit (名词) __________

3. thin (比较级) ___________ 4. please (形容词) _______

5. fat (最高级) ____________  6. ring (过去式) ________

7. hit (现在分词) __________  8. problem (同义词) _____

9. rest (反义词) ____________ 10. feel (过去式) ______

Ⅲ. 选择填空: 20%

(  )1. I ____ breakfast this morning.

      A. hadn' t             B. doesn' t have

      C. didn' t had          D. didn' t have

(  )2. She ____ the boy  was a queue jumper.

      A. hoped     B. talked     C. thought    D. spoke

(  )3. She is _____ to go  shopping with us.

      A. to busy          B. so busy

      C. very busy         D. too busy

(   )4. If he ____ get up  early tomorrow , he' ll be  late.

       A. don' t    B. won' t     C. isn' t    D. doesn' t

(  )5. If you  look ____ before you cross the  road , you              will be safe.

       A. care  B. carefully   C. careful   D. more careful

(  )6. — What  are the students doing?

      — They _____ the examination.

       A. got ready for          B. get ready for

       C. are getting ready for   D. are getting ready to

(  )7. It is  wrong of you  to laugh _____ people.

       A. at other          B. in other

       C. at others         D. in another

(  )8. The students are  waiting for the  teacher ______.

       A. comes    B. came     C. coming    D. to come

(  )9. I don' t feel very well today. My  head ____ badly.

       A. hurts    B. is     C. was      D. hurt

(  )10. China is  one of _____ in the  world.

        A. the biggest country    B. the biggest countries

        C. bigger country        D. biggest countries

(  )11. He is  more friendly _____ you think.

        A. like    B. as     C. before     D. than

(  )12. France is  quite different _____ China.

        A. from     B. with    C. to     D. as

(  )13. When the  lights are ____ , the traffic must stop.

        A. green    B. red     C. yellow    D. on

(  )14. — ____ I come here at  5 in the  afternoon?

       — Certainly.

       A. May    B. Must     C. Can    D. Shall

(  )15. —Must  I write down the  words in this lesson?

       — No , you ____.

       A. needn' t    B. mustn' t     C. won' t    D. don' t

(  )16. Go along the street ___ you come to  a tall building.

        A. until     B. before    C. when    D. after

(  )17. ____ your friend speak English , too?

       A. May     B. Can     C. Have to     D. Would

(  )18. I am  very _____ to see your friend.

       A. happily    B. please   C. pleased   D. be pleased

(  )19. You ____ be more careful next time.

        A. have to    B. may    C. can     D. must

(  )20. The old  woman went to  London ___ her daughter.

        A. visit     B. to visit    C. visited    D. visiting

Ⅳ. 介词填空: 10% , 每空1分.

 1. This is  a small room _____ a hospital.

 2. It was  a cold spring morning _____ the city _____            London _____ England.

 3. _____ the head of  the queue was  an old woman.

 4. She was _____ a visit _____ England.

 5. A woman came _____ the waiting-room.

 6. She was  the first _____ the queue.

 7. Everyone laughed _____ her.

Ⅴ. 句型转换: 20% , 每空1分.

A : 就句子划线部分进行提问:

 1. The book on the  desk is his.

   _____ book is  his?

 2. He is  from Japan.

   _____ is he  from?

 3. Mary is  riding Peter' s bike.

    _____ bike is Mary riding?

 4. They waited for  the bus for ten  minutes.

    _____ _____ _____ they wait for  the bus?

 5. Lily and  Lucy go to  school at seven.

   _____ _____ _____ Lily and Lucy go  to school?

B : 用 if 把下列各句变成复合句:

 1. It stops snowing. We  go to the  cinema.

   ____ it ____ snowing , we _____ _____ to  the cinema.

 2. You are  ill. You don' t wear enough clothes.

   ____ you ____ wear enough clothes , you ____ ____ ill.

 3. He comes. I  tell him something about my  school

   ___ he ___ , I ___ tell him something about my  school.

Ⅵ. 完成下列对话: 10%

A : Excuse me.  We are looking for  the People' s Hospital.       Can you tell us  1   2   , please?

B : Yes , go along  3    4   . Then take the  first  5   on the        left. Walk straight until you   6  the  People' s Hospital.

A :  7   8  .  Is it  9   away?

B : No, it' s only two kilometres. You can  10  the no. 5 bus.

1. ______ 2. ______ 3. _______ 4. ______ 5. ______

6. ______ 7. ______ 8. _______ 9. ______ 10. ______

Ⅶ. 阅读理解: 20%

(A) A  Cotton Dress

One day  Mrs. White shopping. When her  husband came home in  the evening , she began to  tell him about a  cotton(棉花) dress.“I saw it  in a shop this morning,”She  said.“And I…”“And  you want to  buy it,”said  her husband.“How  much does it  cost?”“Fifteen pounds.”

“Fifteen pounds for  a cotton dress? That' s too  much!”

But every evening , when Mr. White came back from work , his wife continued to  speak only about the  dress , and at last , after a  week , he said,“Oh , dear , buy the  dress! Here is  the money!”

She was  very happy.

But the  next evening , when Mr. White came home and  asked,“Have you  got the dress?”She  said“No.”

“Why not?”he  asked.“Well , it  was  still in the  window of the  shop after a  week , so I thought ,‘Nobody else wants this dress , so I  don' t want it  either.’”

根据短文内容判断正误:对的打“√”,错的打“×”.

(  )1. Mrs. White wanted to  buy a cotton dress.

(  )2. Her husband came home in  the morning.

(  )3. Her husband didn' t give her  the money at  first.

(  )4. The cotton dress was  still in the  window of the             shop after a  week.

(  )5. At last Mrs. White got  the dress.

(B) In  A Restaurant (饭馆)

My mother speaks very good English , but she  knows little Japanese. She  went to Tokyo on  November 11 for  a meeting. the  meeting was over on  November 15.

The next morning she  went to a  park and then did  some shopping. At  noon she was  hungry. She went to  the nearest restaurant and  sat down at  a table. A  man came up  to her and  asked what she  needed. She said she  wanted noodles , chicken and some vegetables. She  spoke to  him in English , but the  man didn' t know English. My  mother looked around. No  one was eating noodles.

When she  saw a piece of  paper on her  table , she had an  idea. She took a  pen out of  her handbag and  wrote the Chinese words for  the food on  the paper.

She showed the  paper to the  man. The man  smiled and said ,“OK!”Very  soon he brought her  a bowl of  noodles with chicken and  some vegetables.

(  )1. My mother wanted to  eat ____.

      A. cakes    B. noodles    C. apples    D. mooncakes

(  )2. After she  went to a  park , she bought _____.

      A. vegetable  B. chicken   C. something  D. nothing

(  )3. The man  knew ____ , but he didn' t know _____.

       A. Japanese , English     B. Japanese , Chinese

       C. English , Japanese      D. English , Chinese

(  )4. My mother wrote the  Chinese words for ____ on             the paper.

       A. chicken , noodles  and eggs      B. nothing

       C. noodles oranges and  some vegetables

       D. some vegetables , noodles and chicken

(  )5. The man  gave my mother a  bowl of ____ noodles.

      A. cold     B. long    C. hot     D. fat

 初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

 第二十四单元(93—96课)试卷

Ⅰ. 找出与所给单词发音相同的单词: 5%

(  )1. look   A. tooth    B. school   C. moon   D. cook

(  )2. tired  A. turned   B. stopped  C. wanted  D. washed

(  )3. with   A. think   B. healthy   C. their    D. nothing

(  )4. baby   A. fat      B. anything  C. matter  D. mistake

(  )5. tiger   A. afraid   B. tidy      C. animal   D. April

Ⅱ. 选择适当的一项填空 , 使单词完整: 5%

(  )1. b __ by       A. a     B. e     C. i      D. o

(  )2. g __ den      A. er    B. ar     C. ir     D. ur

(  )3. sho __ ing    A. p     B. rt     C.pp    D. t

(  )4. h __ sework   A. om   B. or    C. ou    D. au

(  )5. p __ ce        A. ee     B. ei     C. ia    D. ie

Ⅲ. 按括号中的要求写出相应的形式: 10%

1. tidy (动词) _________  2. dangerous (比较级) _______

3. fat (反义词) ________  4. friend (形容词) ___________

5. healthy (最高级) ______ 6. understand (过去式) ______

7. problem (复数) _______ 8. care (形容词) __________

9. baby (复数) __________ 10. must (同义词组) ________

Ⅳ. 选择填空: 15%

(  )1. Kate goes to  see her grandpa ____.

       A. every four days        B. four every day

       C. every four day         D. each four day

(  )2. He doesn' t feel well. He ____ go to  see the doctor.

      A. must    B. have to    C. has to   D. had to

(  )3. There was  something _____ his bike.

       A. broke about           B. bad with  

       C. wrong with            D. wrong to

(  )4. Every evening she ____ to bed  until she finishes             her housework.

       A. isn' t go           B. goes

        C. didn' t go         D. won' t go

(  )5. There are _____ days in  a month than there are  in           a year.

       A. more    B. many      C. fewer      D. less

(  )6. Thank you  for helping me _____ my  maths.

       A. to      B. with     C. learn      D. in

(  )7. What does your mother do ____ the house when             she is at  home?

        A. round      B. in      C. at      D. behind

(  )8. It' ll take me  two hours ____ this homework.

      A. finishing  B. finished  C. to finish  D. to finishing

(  )9. After I  did some cooking , I felt ____.

       A. tired    B. tire     C. be tired     D. tiring

(  )10. Mrs. Brown should ____ more exercise.

       A. carry    B. take     C. get    D. much

(  )11. The doctor said ,“You  should never eat  too __             food.”

        A. big     B. many     C. lots     D. much

(  )12. Read the  story and _____ the answer _____ the               question.

        A. find out , to        B. find , on

         C. look for , in        D. look at , about

(  )13. — Can  you come to play basketball?

       — Sorry , I' m afraid ____.

       A. no    B. I can' t    C. I can    D. don' t

(  )14. They' ll go  to the park ____ the shop.

        A. after    B. instead    C. before    D. instead of

(  )15. — Did  you have to  go now?   — _____.

        A. No , I hadn' t        B. No , I didn' t have

        C. Yes , I did           D. Yes , I had 

Ⅴ. 就句子划线部分进行提问: 10% , 每空1分.

 1. They read English for an  hour yesterday.

    _____ _____ _____ they read English yesterday?

 2. Mike is  going to the  park tomorrow.

    _____ _____ Mike going to  the park?

 3. Peter comes from America.

    _____ _____ Peter come from?

 4. Tom goes to  school at 7 : 30.

    _____ _____ does Tom go  to school?

 5. The red pen  is his.

    _____ pen is his?

Ⅵ. 用适当的介词、副词填空: 20% , 每空1分.

 1. I met  our teacher _____ my way  to the zoo.

 2. John will go  to Beijing _____ plane tomorrow.

 3. Don' t be  late _____ school.

 4. There is  a piece _____ bread _____ the table.

 5. There is  a school ____ the other side ____ the road.

 6. I wash all  the plates ____ meals and  do lots ____            work _____ the garden.

 7. Is Mary ill _____ bed?

 8. ____ the head ____ the queue was  an old worker.

 9. They looked _____ but couldn' t see  Lucy.

 10. Walk _____ this road and  turn right. Then you  will          find the park _____ front _____ you.

 11. He asked me  to help him _____ his English.

 12. Thank you _____ coming _____ our party.

Ⅶ. 完形填空: 10%

John usually  1  up  at six in  the morning. It  is Saturday today. He  and his classmates have  2  on  Saturdays and Sundays. So  he  3   up very early this morning. After breakfast he  4  for  five minutes. Then he  did his homework and   5  a  diary in the  afternoon , he played  6   football with his  classmates. They  7   very happy.

It' s eight o' clock now. There  8   a football match on  TV. He is  going to  9   it because he   10  football very much.

(  )1. A. get       B. gets     C. got        D. am getting

(  )2. A. not class            B. no class 

      C. not classes          D. no classes

(  )3. A. not getting           B. didn' t get

      C. don' t get            D. isn' t going to  get

(  )4. A. is running   B. runs   C. is going to  run  D. ran

(  )5. A. write    B. wrote   C. writes  D. is writing

(  )6. A. the      B. a       C. /       D. an

(  )7. A. were    B. are     C. is       D. was

(  )8. A. was     B. is       C. are     D. is going to  be

(  )9. A. see      B. watch   C. look    D. look at

(  )10. A. doesn' t love       B. lovees

       C. loved        D. is going to  love

 Ⅷ. 阅读理解: 25%

(A)

An old  man thought his  wife was a  little deaf (聋), and he decided to  try her out. He  walked back ten  metres and asked his  wife from behind,“Can you  hear me?”He heard no  answer from his  wife , so he walked forward and  stood six metres away from her,“Can you  hear me?”he asked again. But he  still heard no  answer. Then he  walked up two  metres and asked loudly,“Now , my dear , can you  hear me?”

“Yes , of course,”she answered.“And  this is the  third       time I have told you —YES , OF COURSE!”

根据短文内容判断正误:对的打“√”,错的打“×”.

(  )1. “Try out”in the  passage means in  Chinese“拿            出来”.

(  )2. the man  asked his wife the  same question for  only          three times.

(  )3. The wife could not  answer her husband from 10             metres away.

(  )4. The man  was really much deafer than his  wife.

(  )5. From the  passage we can  see the man  and the              woman' s ages.

(B)

One morning , John went to  the market (集市) with six donkeys (驴子). After walking for  a while he  got very tired(累了). He got on  one of them. Then he  counted the donkeys , and there were only five. So  he got off  the donkey and went to  look for the  sixth. He looked and  looked but did  not find it.  He went back to  the donkeys and  counted them again. This time there were six , so he  got on one  of them again , and they all  started.

After a  few minutes , he counted the  donkeys again , and again there were only five! When he  was counting again , his friend Bill passed , and John said to  him ,“I left my  house with six  donkeys ; then I had  five ; then , I had six  again ; and now I  have only five! Look! One , two , three , four , five.”

“But John ,”said  Bill.“You are  sitting on a  donkey , too! That' s the  sixth. And you  are the seventh!”

(  )1. John went to  the market with six ____.

      A. monkeys  B. chickens  C. donkeys   D. horses

(  )2. He wanted to  take his donkeys to  the ____.

      A. shop    B. cinema   C. market    D. fields

(  )3. When he  was _____ he sat on  one of his  donkeys.

       A. angry    B. hungry     C. happy   D. tired

(  )4. There were five donkeys when John counted them           because ______.

      A. he was on  one of them      B. one ran away

      C. he couldn' t count            D. he sold one 

(  )5. Did he  look for the  sixth donkey?  ______.

      A. Yes , he does           B. No , he doesn' t

      C. Yes , he did            D. No , he didn' t

(  )6. At last he  found it , didn' t he?  ______.

      A. Yes , he did          B. No , he didn' t

      C. Yes , he didn' t           D. No , he did

(  )7. After _____, John counted the  donkeys again.

       A. two seconds         B. a few minutes

       C. an hour             D. three days

(  )8. When he  was counting , ______ came.

       A. one of his  friends      B. his son

       C. the sixth donkey        D. his wife

(  )9. John asked Bill _____ him to  find the donkey.

      A. to help    B. help    C. helped    D. helping

(  )10. Bill said , “You  are _____ a donkey. that' s the              sixth.”

       A. in front           B. sitting on

       C. standing by        D. behind

 初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

 第二十五单元(97—100课)试卷

 Ⅰ. 找出划线部分的读音不同于其他三个的词:5%

   (   ) 1. A. i s land      B. thi s     C. ye s      D. bu s

   (   ) 2. A. ar ou nd     B. c ou ld   C. ab ou t   D. s ou th

   (   ) 3. A. g ar den     B. p ar k    C. sug ar    D. l ar ge

   (   ) 4. A.  a lone      B. l a ter    C. pl a te    D. r a dio

   (   ) 5. A. nob o dy    B. h o pe    C. ag o    D. N o vember

 Ⅱ. 按括号中的要求写出相应的形式:10%

   1. we(反身代词)______    2. warm (反义词)_______        3. smell(过去式)______    4. cry (反义词)_______

   5. farther(同音词)_______   6. baby (复数)________

   7. understood (原形)_______ 8. near (反义词)_______

   9. safe (反义词)_______    10. begin(同义词)______

 Ⅲ. 选择填空:20%

 (  ) 1. Remember______ some meat for  supper this                  evening , will you?

         A. to buy   B. buy      C. bought     D. buys

 (  ) 2. _____we go  to the nearest park or  the farthest              one?

        A. Would     B. Will    C. Can     D. Shall

 (   ) 3. ---- Is ______ in the classroom?

        ---- No , it 's empty

        A. one   B. anybody   C. nobody   D. somebody

 (   ) 4. The children pulled the  boat up ___ the water.

         A. from     B. on    C. out    D. off

 (   ) 5. I' m very hungry. ____ me some food.

         A. Bring to   B. Take for   C. Take at  D. Bring

 (   ) 6. The students in  my class made the  machine ____.

        A. themselves            B. by them

        C. by themselves         D. by himself

 (   ) 7. My mother wants _____ some food for  supper.

        A. buys     B. buying    C. to buy     D. buy

 (   ) 8. There is ____ wrong with his  watch. 

        He has to  ask ____ to mend it.

         A. something , somebody  B. something , anybody

         C. anything , somebody   D. anything , anybody

 (   ) 9. ____ the twins feel afraid of  dangerous animals?             A. Did      B. Was      C. Were     D. Does

 (   ) 10. We must ____ the food cool.

          A. have     B. work     C. get     D. keep

 (   ) 11. Do you  have _____ to say?

         A. something more        B. anything more

         C. more something        D. more anything

 (   ) 12. It' s time _____ our English lesson.

         A. in      B. to    C. for      D. of

 (   ) 13. There is  going to ___ English party this evening.

          A. be an   B. be on    C. have    D. have an

 (   ) 14. You look ____ today. What' s wrong ____ you?

          A. tire , with           B. tires , on

          C. tired , with          D. tiring , to

 (   ) 15. She does her  homework _____ than her sister.

         A. much careful         B. more carefully

         C. more careful         D. much carefully

 (   ) 16. Let' s go _____ a walk.

         A. from     B. for    C. to    D. about

 (   ) 17. They don' t want _____ there.

          A. go     B. goes     C. to go    D. going

 (   ) 18. Can' t you  see ____ interesting in the  picture?

         A. something   B. anything   C. any   D. nothing

 (   ) 19. The boys and  girls push the  boat ___ the water.

          A. of      B. from    C. into     D. to

 (   ) 20. Are there any  animals ____ the island?

         A. at      B. in    C. on     D. with

 Ⅳ.句型转换:20%, 每空1分

   1. We can  hear nithing. (改为一般疑问句)

      _____ you hear _____?

   2. The boy  is young. He can' t go  to school. (用too…           to改句)

       The boy is _____ _____ _____ go to  school.

   3. There is  something in the  next room. (改为否定句)

      There _____ _____ in  the next room.

   4. Show him  the picture. (改为否句)

      _____ _____ him the picture.

   5. They will go   to the  nearest island  tomorrow. (就划          线部分提问)

       _____ _____ they _____ tomorrow?

   6. There' s something wrong with your watch. (改为一         般问句)

       _____ there _____ wrong  with your watch?

   7. Tom did  his homework at  home yesterday. (改为否          定句)

      Tom ____ ____ his  homework at home yesterday.

   8. The students do  eye exercises every day. (改为一般         问句)

       _____ the students _____ eye exercises every day?

   9. She was  born  in  Guilin  in 1986.(就划线部分提问)

       _____ was she _____ in 1986?

 Ⅴ. 用情态动词can , may, must和can' t , mustn' t 填空: 10% , 每空1分.

 1. _____ I have a  look at your photo?

 2. The baby is  sleeping. We _____ talk so  loud.

 3. You _____ study harder than before.

 4. He' ll come to  help you if  he _____.

 5. Little Tom _____ move this big  box.

 6. — _____ your sister play the  piano(钢琴)?

   — Yes , she _____. She is  a good player.

 7. Please write it  clearly. I _____ see it.

 8. My son _____ write English now. But  he _____ speak        a little English.

 Ⅵ. 请用介词填空: 15% , 每空1分, 可以用多次.

 in , of , on , before , at , after , above , for , under , with , to

 1. There is  a ball ______ the bed.

 2. We must wait ______ a queue.

 3. They are  waiting ______ a bus.

 4. John lives ______ the city ______ New York.

 5. ____ the head _____ the queue was  an old man.

 6. I' ll stay here _____ my parents _____ two months

 7. The English teachers are ___ the way ____ our country.

 8. Please don' t look _____ him like that.

 9. It' s autumn now. There are  many apples ____ the trees.

 10. The old  woman is playing ______ her grandson.

 11. He' s looking after his  father ________  home.

 Ⅶ. 阅读理解: 20%

 (A)  Going to the  Farm

 Today is  Friday. Lin Tao  and Jim are  not going to  have any classes on  Sunday. They' re going to  work on a  farm. They are  going to help the  farmers to pick apples. Jim  likes picking apples , he doesn' t like haveing any  classes on sunday. They' re going to  meet on the  road outside the  school gate at  two o' clock , and they are  going to put  on their old  clothes. They don' t like to  be late for  picking apples.

 根据短文内容判断正误:对的打“√”,错的打“×”.

 (  )1. Lin Tao  and Jim are  going to stay at  home on              Sunday.

 (  )2. They' re going to  pick pears on  the farm.

 (  )3. Jim thinks having some classes is  much better               than picking apples.

 (  )4. They' re going to  meet outside the  school gate.

 (  )5. They' re going to  put on their new  clothes.

 (B)

 One  morning Mrs. Brown said to  her husband,“Jack , there is  a meeting of  our women' s in  Mrs. Young' s house today , and I  must go to  it. I' ll leave you  some food for  your lunch. Is  that all right?”

 “Oh , yes,”her  husband answered.“That' s quite right. What are  you going to  leave for my  lunch?”

 “This tin (罐) of fish,”Mrs. Brown said.“And there are  some cold cooked potatoes and  some  peas here , too.”“Good.”said Jack.

 Mrs. Brown then went to  her meeting. All  the women had  lunch there , and at  three o' clock Mrs. Brown came back home.

 “Was the  fish nice , Jack?”Mrs. Brown asked.“Yes , but my feet hurting (疼痛).”her husband answered.“Why are  they hurting?”Mrs. Brown asked.“Well , on the tin  it was written —OPEN IT  AND STAND IN  HOT WATER FOR  FIVE MINUTES.”

 (  )1. Mrs. Brown wanted to ______.

       A. meet her husband       B. buy some food

       C. go to a  meeting 

       D. cook lunch in  Young' s house

 (  )2. Mr. Brown had  to ______.

       A. have lunch outside

       B. have lunch by  himself at home

       C. cook his lunch by  himself

        D. have lunch with the  women

 (  )3. Mrs. Brown asked her  husband to eat _____ for his          lunch.

       A. fish , potatoes  and peas       B. fish and chips

       C. fish with potatoes and  peas in  it

       D. fried chicken

 (  )4. At three o' clock in  the afternoon , _____.

       A. Mr. Brown finished his  lunch

       B. Mrs. Brown went to  the meeting

       C. Mr. Brown began cooking supper

       D. Mrs. Brown got back home

 (  )5. Mr. Brown' s feet were hurting because ______.

       A. that tin of  fish hurt his  feet

       B. he fell down and  hurt them

       C. he stood in  hot water for  5 minutes

       D. his wife hurt them

 初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

 第二十六单元(101—104课)试卷

 Ⅰ.找出划线部分的读音不同于其他三个的词: 10%

 (  )1. A. work ed    B. ask ed      C. learn ed     D. wash ed

 (  )2. A. paren ts     B. studen ts    C. star ts       D. han ds

 (  )3. A. st u dy      B. s u mmer    C. s u n       D. st u dent

 (  )4. A. fl y         B. b y         C. wh y       D. cit y

 (  )5. A. r e st        B. n e ver      C. th e n       D. h e

 (  )6. A. c o ld        B. m o ve       C. h o pe      D. g o

 (  )7. A.  i sland       B. r i ch        C. c i nema    D. f i fth

 (  )8. A. tr u ck       B. p u sh        C. h u ngry    D. n u t

 (  )9. A. h ear         B. n ear        C. l ear n      D. d ear

 (  )10. A. p oo r       B. st oo d       C. c oo k      D. t oo k

 Ⅱ. 按括号中的要求写出相应的形式: 15%

 1. they (反身代词) ________ 2. rich (反义词) ________

 3. sad (反义词) ___________ 4.  teach (过去式) _______

 5. hurt (过去式) __________  6. her (反身代词) _______

 7. clever (比较级) _________ 8. here (同音词) ________

 9. late (反义词) __________ 10. hit (现在分词) ________

 11. southern (名词) _______ 12. are (现在分词) ________

 13. party (复数) __________ 14. push (反义词) ________

 15. little (比较级) ________

 Ⅲ. 选择填空: 20%

 (  )1. Her mother had  a little rest _____ supper.

       A. in      B. at      C. on      D. after

 (  )2. I don' t need any  help. I can  do the work _____.

       A. at home          B. at school

        C. with myself       D. by myself

 (  )3. The Shute family ___ the southern part of  America.

       A. live in          B. lives on

       C. live on          D. lives in

 (  )4. Who was ____ , the doctor or  Mr. Shute?

       A. the sadest   B. sadder   C. sader   D. the saddest

 (  )5. He looked at  me _____ a long time.

       A. to     B. for      C. after      D. past

 (  )6. ____ Shutes ____ going to London for  a holiday.

       A. The , is    B. / , is   C. The , are   D. The , be

 (  )7. You must go  to see the  doctor if you _____ ill.

       A. will be      B. were     C. may      D. are

 (  )8. The Smiths had  a second boy ______ Jack.

       A. to call    B. called     C. calls    D. calling

 (  )9. Please help yourself _____ anything you  like.

       A. to       B. at       C. with       D. of

 (  )10. Get up  and get ______ quickly.

        A. to dress    B. dressing   C. dress   D. dressed

 (  )11. Did you  play _____ basketball  yesterday?

         A. a       B. the      C. an      D. /

 (  )12 — May  I speak to  Jack , please?

       — ______.

        A. You are welcome    B. Thank you

        C. I am Jack           D. This is Jack speaking

 (  )13. — Where is  my book ?

        — ______.

        A. Yes , it' s on the  desk      B. You must read it

         C. Here it is               D. I' ll take it

 (  )14. After I  wrote a letter to  my grandpa , I __ to bed.

        A. go     B. went      C. goes     D. will og

 (  )15. Help _____ to the  cake , please .

        A. you      B. your      C. yourself      D. youself

 (  )16. Must we  go to the  farthest island? No , you ____.

        A. may not            B. must not

        C. can not             D. needn' t 

 (  )17. Lily fell ___ her bike , but she  didn' t hurt _____.

        A. into , herself         B. off , herself

        C. of , himself          D. onto , herself

 (  )18. The girl is  sad _____ she is poor.

        A. but      B. because     C. so    D. with

 (  )19. I enjoy _____ very much.

        A. cook     B. cooks    C. to cook    D. cooking

 (  )20. — Would you  give me your pen?

        — ______.

        A. Here are you         B. Here it is

        C. Here they are         D. Here are they

 Ⅳ. 完成对话: 10%

 A: Why not  go swimming?

 B : That' s  1     2  idea.

 A : Are you   3     4  swimming?

 B : Yes ,   5     6  .

 A : When and  where shall we  meet?

 B : At two  o' clock  7  the school gate , shall we?

 A : That' s   8     9  . Bye.

 B :   10  .

 1. ______ 2. ______ 3. ______ 4. ______ 5. ______

 6. ______ 7. ______ 8. ______ 9. ______ 10. ______

 Ⅴ. 用所给动词的正确形式填空: 20%

  1. He ____(come) to see us  when he has  time tomorrow.

  2. _______(not take) the books out  of the reading-room.

  3. We won' t go  until we ________ (get) it back again.

  4. There _______ (be) something wrong with his  car.

  5. I must help my  mother _______ (do) the  cooking this         afternoon.

  6. The old  man _______(buy) a colour TV  set yesterday.

  7. If my  father lets me  out , I ________ (go) with  you.

  8. I' m glad ________ (help) you.

  9. His classmates ________(work) on the  farm now.

  10. He ________(like) skating in  winter very much.

 Ⅵ. 用适当的反身代词填空: 10%

  1. He needs no  help because he  can do it _______.

  2. Look! The cat  is washing _______.

  3. Come into the  room and find a  seat for _______.

  4. You teach _______ , don' t you?

  5. The story ______ is good , but he  didn' t tell it  well.

  6. On Sundays , my brother and  I clean the  room _____.

  7. My parents clean their room _______.

  8. Do you  enjoy _______ at the party?

  9. The girl is  to young to  get dressed _______.

  10. Don' t tell me  the answer. Let  me do it  by _______.

 Ⅶ. 阅读理解: 15%

 (A)

 Today is  Saturday. Peter doesn' t go  to school on  Saturday afternoon. He' s playing a  ball near his  house. His father comes to  him and begins to  talk about his  school with him.

 “Who is the  best student in  your class?”“I am , Dad.”answers Peter.

 “Why?”“Only I can  answer my teacher' s questions in  class.”

 “What  questions?”“They often ask  us‘Who don' t understand me’, and  only I put  up my hand.”

 “And who is  the worst in  your class?”“Our teachers are.”

 “Why?”“They can' t answer even the  easiest questions,”says  Peter,“They always ask  us to answer.”

 根据短文内容判断正误:对的打“√”,错的打“×”.

 (  )1. Peter doesn' t go  to school on  Saturday afternoon.

 (  )2. Peter is  the best student in  his class.

 (  )3. Peter often doesn' t understand his  teachers.

 (  )4. Peter thinks he  is better than his  teachers.

 (  )5. Peter' s teachers can' t answer the  easiest questions.

 (B)  A Clever Boy

 Peter was  ten years old. One  day his friend Paul said to  him ,“I' m going to  have a birthday party on  Saturday. Peter, can you  come?”

 Peter asked his  mother and she  said ,“Yes , you can  go.”She phoned Paul' s mother to  tell her.

 Before Peter went to  the party , his mother said to  him ,“Now , Peter , don' t forget to  be polite. Don' t ask  for food. Wait until someone gives it  to you.”

 “All right , Mum.”Peter answered. And  he went to  Palu' s house on  his bicycle.

 There were a  lot of chidren at  the party. They played together for  an hour , and then Paul' s mother gave them some food , but she  forgot to give Peter any. He  waited politely for  a few minutes and  then he held his  plate up in  the air and  said loudly ,“Does  anyone want a  nice clean plate?”

 (  )1. Who was  going to have a  birthday party?

       A. Peter.       B. Paul.      C. Their friends.

 (  )2. What did  Paul invite Peter to?

       A. He asked Peter to  have a dinner.

       B. He asked Peter to  see a film.

       C. He asked Peter to  come to his  birthday party.

 (  )3. What did  Peter' s mother say  to him before he               went?

       A. She told him  to eat nothing at  the party.

       B. She told him  not to be  polite and ask  for food.           C. She told him  to to be  polite and not  to ask for             food.

 (  )4. Why did  Peter hold his  plate in the  air and say             “Does anyone want a  nice clean plate?”

        A. Because he wanted the  others to see  that there              was nothing to  eat in his  plate.

      B. Because he wanted the  others to know that                   he had  already eaten  up all  the food.

       C. Because he wanted the  others to see  that his                 plate was nice and  clean.

 (  )5. Who gave them some food?

       A. Paul.     B. Paul' s mother.    C. Paul' s friends.

 初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

 第二十七单元(105—108课)试卷

 Ⅰ. 找出与所给单词发音相同的单词: 20%

 (  )1. m i nute  A. t i dy   B.  i sland   C. m i stake  D. sh i ne

 (  )2.  wh ole  A.  wh o  B.  wh y    C.  wh at    D.  wh ich

 (  )3. s ay s    A. pl ay    B. p ay s    C. b e d     D. w ai t

 (  )4.  th en    A. bo th    B.  th in     C. ei th er   D.  th ird

 (  )5.  a sleep   A. pl a te  B.  A pril    C.  a nimal   D. a ddress

 (  )6. gr ea t    A. r ea l    B. m ea n    C. h ea lth   D. ag ai n

 (  )7. ex a mple A.  a nswer B. f a mily   C. n a me   D. w a nt

 (  )8. inter e st   A. gu e ss  B.  e leven   C. w e nt    D. sh e

 (  )9. p u t      A. m u m   B. b u t      C. p u ll     D. st u dy

 (  )10. cr y      A. diar y    B. bab y      C. cit y      D. sk y 

 Ⅱ. 按括号中的要求写出相应的形式: 15% , 每空1.5分.

 1. interest (形容词) _________  2. left (反义词) ________

 3. bring (过去式) __________  4. healthy (名词) _______

 5. stop (现在分词) _________  6. class (复数) ________

 7. taught (原形) ____________  8. sing (过去式) _______

 9. hit (过去式) _____________ 10. diary (复数) ________

 Ⅲ. 选择填空: 20%

 (  )1. Don' t worry about your child. I' ll _____ him while           you are away.

       A. take care of          B. take a look

       C. take after            D. take good care

 (  )2. _____ she woke up  and began to  cry.

       A. Half an hour after      B. Half an hour later

       C. Later half an  hour      D. After an hour

 (  )3. He made faces to  make the baby _____.

       A. to laugh    B. laughed   C. laughing   D. laugh

 (  )4. The teacher asked the  girl to show him ____ book.

       A. other one          B. another

       C. one another         D. other

 (  )5. My father will take ____ to the  zoo this Sunday.

       A. I and my  brother       B. my brother and  me

       C. me and my  brother      D. my brother and  I

 (  )6. We can  find many places of _____ in FuZhou.

       A. interesting           B. interested  

       C. interest              D. interests

 (  )7. _____ time they had  in the park yesterday!

       A. What good           B. What a good

       C. How good            D. How a good

 (  )8. There is _____ car on  the road.

        A. no      B. some     C. not     D. any

 (  )9. We don' t like him ______.

       A. no more           B. some more

       C. any more           D. the more

 (  )10. I left my  girl ______.

        A. by myself         B. in myself

        C. by herself          D. by her

 (  )11. You could buy  her a bike, ___ it may  be too dear.

         A. and      B. but      C. if     D. when

 (  )12. We can  see ____ in his garden.

        A. all kind of  flower       B. all kinds of  flower

        C. all kind of  flowers      D. all kinds of  flowers

 (  )13. He is  the tallest ______ the brothers.

        A. of      B. in      C. at      D. for

 (  )14. Would you  please _____ me an interesting story?

        A. speak     B. tell     C. talk    D. say

 (  )15. He won' t come back ____ the end  of the month.

        A. by      B. but      C. until      D. on

 (  )16.“Happy  birthday to you!”“______.”

        A. Happy birthday to  you , too   

        B. The same to  you

        C. Thank you         D. You' re all  right

 (  )17. He bought a  new bike ___ he liked it  very much.

        A. and      B. but     C. or    D. when

 (  )18. Tom is  very poor ____ he always enjoys himself.

         A. of      B. and      C. or     D. but

 (  )19. ____ the radio , I want to ____ to it.

        A. Open , hear          B. Turn on , listen

        C. Opened , listened      D. Turned on , listened

 (  )20. You' d better _____ this bag  of oranges to your               parents.

         A. take    B. to take    C. bring     D. to bring

 Ⅳ. 对句子划部分进行提问: 15% , 每空1.5分.

  1. I often skate  in  the park .

    _____ do you often skate?

  2. You must take  a  coat  with you  tomorrow.

     _____ must we take with us  tomorrow?

  3. It' s  Jim' s  pen.

    _____ pen is it?

  4. The book  on  the desk  is his.

     _____ book is his?

  5. Tom had  to stay at  home today  because he  was ill.

     _____ _____ Tom have to  stay at home?

  6. The farm is   50 kilometres from the  city.

     _____ _____ away is the  farm from the  city?

  7. The tall building has  twenty floors.

     _____ _____ floors does the  building have?

 Ⅴ. 根据短文意思 , 每空填入一个适当的词 , 使意思          完整: 15% , 每空1.5分.

 Li  Ping' s classmates went   1   the Summer Palace last Saturday afternoon. li  Ping didn' t go.  He looked  2  Aunt Huang' s baby. The  child was   3  ten months old.  4  first the  baby was asleep. Later she  woke  5  and began   6  cry. Li  Ping talked to  her and let  her listen to the  music. But the  baby still cried. then Li  Ping started to  sing , and the baby stopped   7  . She listened   8   watched. Li  Ping danced ,    9    faces and  did kinds  10   things all  that afternoon. The  baby laughed and  laughed.

 1. ______ 2. _______ 3. _______ 4. ______ 5. _______

 6. ______ 7. _______ 8. _______ 9. ______ 10. _______

 Ⅵ. 阅读理解: 15%

 (A)

 Tom  lived  in a  big city with his  wife and his  two children. One  Saturday afternoon Tom  took his blue car  out of the  room and washed it.  Just then one  of his friends came to  visit him. The  friend looked at  the car for  a minute. Then he  said to Tom,“That' s a  nice car. Is  it yours?”

 “Sometimes,”Tom answered.

 The  friend was surprised (惊奇的).“Sometimes?”he said.“What do  you mean?”Tom told the  friend slowly.“When there' s a  party in the  city , my daughter , Rose , uses it. When there was  a basketball game , it is  my son , Jim' s. After I  wash it , and it  looks very nice and  clean, my wife drives it  to go shopping. When it  needs washing, it is  mine. ”

 根据短文内容判断正误:对的打“√”,错的打“×”.

 (  )1. Tom' s car  was  black.                      5%

 (  )2.Tom himself washed the  car one Saturday                   afternoon.

 (  )3. When there was  a basketball game , Rose used the           car.

 (  )4. There were four people in  Tom' s family.

 (  )5. Tom' s friend often helps him  wash his car.

 (B)  A. Beautiful Hat

 Mr. Jones had  a few days' holiday. So  he said ,“I' m  going to the  zoo by train.”He  put on his  best clothes , took a  small bag , went to  the station and  got into the  train. He had  a beautiful hat  and he often put  his head out  of the window on  the way and  looked at the  green trees. But  the wind pulled off  his hat.

 Mr. Jones quickly took his  old bag and  threw it out  of the window , too.

 The  other people in  the carriage (车厢) laughed.“Is  your bag going to  bring your beautiful hat  back?”they  asked.

 “No,”Mr. Jones  answered.“But there is  no name and  no address in  my hat and  there is a  name and address on  the bag. Someone is  going to find them near each other , and he' s going to  send me the  bag and the  hat.”

 (  )1. Mr. Jones lived _____.

       A. near the zoo          B. far from the  zoo

       C. in a very big  city     D. far from the  station

 (  )2. We may  think every time Mr. jones went out ____.

      A. he bought a  beautiful hat

      B. he wrote down his  name and address on  his hat

      C. he put on  his best clothes

      D. other people laughed at  him

 (  )3. Mr. Jones threw hih  bag out of  the window                  because ______.

        A. his bag was  too old

        B. he only wanted to  get back his  hat

        C. he was too  sad to think out  a better idea

        D. he hoped someone could send him  the hat and              the bag

 (  )4. He didn' t take off  his hat on  the train because __.

       A. it was cold on  the train

       B. he wanted more people to  see his beautiful hat

       C. he wanted to  look nicer

       D. other people wanted to  look at his  hat

 (  )5. Which is  right?

       A. Mr. Johns found his  hat and when he  got to                 the zoo.

         B. There was  much money in  Mr. Jones'  bag.

        C. Mr. Jones made a  silly (可笑的) mistake.

       D. The other people on  the train helped him  to                  get back his  hat.

 初中英语素质检测试卷集第二册

 期末检测试卷

 Ⅰ. 语音知识:

    A) 找出划线部分读音不同于其他三个的词: 5%

 (  )1. A. l a st     B. b a sket      C.  a nswer    D.  a lone

 (  )2. A. addre ss  B. under s tand C. hu s band   D. re s t

 (  )3. A. sh ou t    B. cl ou dy     C. s ou th      D. s ou thern

 (  )4. A. ca n dle   B. gra n dson  C. u n cle      D. garde n

 (  )5. A. id ea      B. s ea son    C. t ea ch      D. r ea ch

 (  )6. A. cr y       B. b y         C. read y      D. fr y

 (  )7. A. thr ow     B. sl ow       C. gr ow       D. t ow n

 (  )8. A. c oo k      B. s oo n      C. t oo th      D. n oo dle

 (  )9. A. mach i ne   B. sh i ne     C.  i sland      D. t i ger

 (  )10. A. turn ed    B. look ed    C. jump ed    D. watch ed

     B) 选择下列各组句子的正确语调: 2%

 1. — Who' s that?

   — This  is Han Meimei.

   — Can  you take a  message for Lucy , Meimei?

   — Certainly.

   A. 升升降降          B. 升降降降

   C. 降降升降          D. 降升升降

 2. — Where are  you from?

   — Can  you guess?

   — You' re from Australia , aren' t you?

   — Yes , I am.

   A. 降升降降           B. 升升降降

   C. 升降升降           D. 降降降降

 Ⅱ. 词汇知识:

    A) 选择正确的选项, 使单词完整、正确: 5%

 (  )1. r __ lly     A. ea     B. ear    C. ae     D. eer

 (  )2. en __ gh    A. o     B. ou     C. au    D. on

 (  )3. ag __ n     A. ei     B. ai      C. ea     D. e

 (  )4. t __ night   A. a      B. er      C. o      D. or

 (  )5. rad __      A. iou     B. eo     C. io     D. oi

    B) 按括号中的要求写出相应的形式: 10%

 1. fat (比较级) ___________  2. himself (复数) ________

 3. clever (同义词) _________ 4. can' t (过去式) ________

 5. I (反身代词) ___________ 6. smelt (原形) __________

 7. farther (同音词) _________ 8. large (反义词) ________

 9. heavy (副词) __________   10. friend (形容词) ______

 11. problem (同义词) _______ 12. will not (缩写) _______

 13. bolw (过去式) _________ 14. interesting (名词) _____

 15. photo (复数) _________   16. poor (反义词) _______

 17. south (形容词) ________  18. wait (现在分词) _____

 19. tooth (复数) ________    20. popular (最高级) _____

    C) 词语释义: 选择意思与句中划线部分最接近的    答案: 5%

 (  )1. He could not  wash himself or   get dressed .

       A. 脱衣服      B. 穿衣服     C. 得到衣服

 (  )2. They  enjoyed themselves  very much in  the park.

       A. 炫耀自己    B. 自我欣赏   C. 玩得痛快

 (  )3. There are   over  fifty students in  our class.

        A. only       B. less than       C. more than

 (  )4. English names are   not the  same as  Chinese names.

       A. not the same to       B. different from

       C. different to

 (  )5. Don' t worry. We  have  lots  of   friends here.

       A. a lot       B. many      C. much

 Ⅲ. 选择填空: 10%

 (  )1. ____ the tiger jumped into the  river.

       A. With the word        B. With these words

       C. For the words        D. In the words

 (  )2. My grandpa often tells me _____ in the  street.

       A. play             B. don' t play

       C. to not play       D. not to play

 (  )3. Jim ____ the light before he  left the room.

       A. turned off   B. opened   C. turned on   D. closed

 (  )4. Mr and  Mrs. Shute had a  son _____ James.

       A. called    B. call     C. to call     D. calling

 (  )5. He is  a ____ man. He always drives the  car ____.

       A. care , carefully        B. careful , carefully

       C. carefully , careful      D. careful , care

 (  )6. I need the  English book. ____ me the  book when            you come to  schol tomorrow.

       A. To bring    B. Bring    C. To take    D. Take

 (  )7. You must keep the  meeting-roon _____.

       A. clean    B. to clean    C. cleaning    D. cleaned

 (  )8. — Where' s Mary?

      — I' m not  sure. I think she ____ help her  mother               at hme.

      A. have to          B. maybe has to

       C. had to           D. may have to

 (  )9. He met  an old man _____ his way _____ the                cinema yesterday morning.

        A. in , to     B. on , to     C. to , in    D. on , in

 (  )10. Do you  know ______?

        A. where does he  live      B. where he live

        C. where he does live      D. where he lives

 (  )11. — Help _____ to some chicken , Li Lei.

        — Thank you , Mr. Brown.

        A. yourselves   B. himself   C. yourself   D. you

 (  )12. Be careful! There ____ a lot  of ____ on the road.

        A. is , traffics          B. is , traffic

        C. are , traffics         D. are , traffic

 (  )13. He didn' t go  to bed _____ he finished his                   homework last night.

        A. until      B. when     C. if     D. because

 (  )14. We came to  Australia _____ a bad time of  year.

         A. from      B. at      C. in      D. for

 (  )15. They often go  swimming in summer holidays. __.

        A. So we do         B. So we

        C. So do we         D. We do

 (  )16. The ___ lesson is  the most difficult in  Book Two.

        A. five      B. fifty      C. fifteen     D. fifth

 (  )17. Excuse me , can you ____ me the  way to the                 nearest shop?

         A. talk      B. say      C. tell      D. speak

 (  )18. What _____ bad weather!

        A. a      B. an     C. /      D. the

 (  )19. Let' s give her _____ to eat.

        A. something different       B. different something

        C. anything different         D. different anything

 (  )20. If it ____ tomorrow , we won' t go  to the park.

        A. will rain     B. rain    C. rained    D. rains

 Ⅳ. 根据要求完成句子.

    A) 完成对话 , 每空一词: 10%

 A : Summer holidays will  1  . What are  you going to  do?

 B : Dad will   2   me to  our home town in  Guangdong.         We' ll  3  our grandparents there.

 A : Oh , they' ll  4  happy to  see you again.

 B : Sure. What are  you going to  do then?

 A : I' m going to  visit some cities.

 B : What  5  are you  going to visit?

 A : Beijing , Shanghai and  Hangzhou.

 B : Oh , they are  all places of   6  interest in  China. Are         you going to  Guilin ,   7  ?

 A : I' d like to ,  8  I don' t have  9  time this summer           holidays.

 B : I think you' ll  10   yourself.

 A : I' m sure I  will.

 1. ______ 2. ______ 3. ______ 4. ______ 5. ______

 6. ______ 7. ______ 8. ______ 9. ______ 10. ______

    B) 句型转换: 10% , 每空1分:

 1. What' s wrong with you? (改为同义)

   What' s _____ _____ with you?

 2. It will be  fine. They' ll go to  the zoo. (用 if 来合并句       子)

   _____ it _____ fine , they will go  to the zoo.

 3. The box  is very heavy. He  can' t carry it. (用 too…to        合并句子)

   The box  is _____ heavy for him _____ carry.

 4. He didn' t go  to school yesterday  because he  was ill .         (就划线部分提问)

   _____ didn' t he come to  school yesterday?

 5. Don' t forget to  come early tomorrow. (改为同义)

   _____ to come early tomorrow.

 6. There is  something wrong the  bike. (改为一般问句)

   _____ there _____ wrong with the  bike?

    C) 交际英语: 5%

 (  )1. — My  brother fell off  his bike and  hurt himself.

      — _____.

      A. It doesn' t  matter     

      B. He should be  more careful

      C. Don' t worry     

      D. I am sorry to  hear that

 (  )2. — Could you  go out and  play football with us?

      — _____. I  have a lot  of work to  do.

      A. I' m afraid          B. Of course

      C. Certainly           D. I' m afraid not

 (  )3. — Is  this  your pen?

       —Yes , it is.

       — _____.

      A. What' s wrong        B. Here you are

      C. Here are you         D. Here is it

 (  )4. — Shall we  go out for  a walk?

       — ______.

       A. Are you going out  with me?

       B. That' s a good idea    

       C. It' s very kind of  you

       D. Thank you for  asking me

 (  )5. — May  I come in?

       — _____.

       A. Who are you         B. What are you  doing

       C. Come in , please       D. Don' t do it

 (  )6. — Where does your mother work?

       — She works in  a middle school.

       — _____.

       — She teaches English.

       A. What does she  teach 

       B. Does she teach Enlglish

       C. Who does she  teach    D. What is she  doing

 (  )7. — Help  yourself to some fish.

       — _____.

      A. Help yourself , too      B. Thank you

       C. I' ll do it              D. You are so  kind

 (  )8. — Would you  like to go  to a football match this               evening?

       — _____.

        A. No , not at all          B. Thanks. I' d love to

        C. I will                 D. I have no  time

 (  )9. — _____ it is  today!

       — Yes , Let' s go  to the park.

       A. What a fine date        B. How fine

       C. What fine day           D. How cold

 (  )10. — Happy birthday!

        — _____.

        A. You are welcome        B. You are so  kind

        C. I am  very  glad           D. Thank you , Lucy

 Ⅴ. 用所给动词的正确形式填空: 8% , 每空1分.

  1. It often rains in  summer here but  it ________ (rain)          hard last night.

  2. It' s time for  supper. Let' s stop _________ (read).

  3. Every day  the old tiger made one  of the smaller             animals __________ (bring) him  something to eat.

  4. Where' s Bob? I want _________ (ask) him a  question.

  5. Her leg _________ (hurt) yesterday , so she  went to           see the  doctor yesterday.

  6. What are  you doing now? I ________ (listen) to the           music.

  7. Thanks for ________ (give) me the  beautiful skirt. I' d         love to wear it.

  8. The party will start at  eight tomorrow evening. Don' t        forget _________ (come) before  eight.

 Ⅵ. 完形填空: 10%

 Tom  was twelve years   1  . He  was not a  very good pupil. Often he  didn' t do his   2   by himself.

 One  day his maths (数学) teacher   3  at Tom' s homework and  saw that he  got all his  answers  4  . He  was very pleased and  quite surprised (惊奇). He called Tom  to his desk and  said to him,“You got  all your homework right   5   time , Tom. What happened (发生)? Did your father   6  , too?”

 Tom' s father helped him   7   his homework , but not   8  . yesterday evening his  father was busy and  not at home. so  Tom answered ,“No , sir. He  was busy  last   9  , so I   10   do it  with the help of  my mother.”

 (  )1. A. young   B. ago      C. age        D. old

 (  )2. A. work    B. things    C. housework  D. homework

 (  )3. A. saw     B. looked    C. felt        D. read

 (  )4. A. good    B. mistaken  C. wrong     D. right

 (  )5. A. this      B. that       C. one        D. more

 (  )6. A. do       B. say       C. write       D. help

 (  )7. A. with     B. in        C. for         D. at

 (  )8. A. many    B. few       C. often       D. quite

 (  )9. A. evening   B. late       C. morning    D. time

 (  )10. A. must    B. had to    C. may       D. can 

 Ⅶ. 看图填空: 10%

 One  day a  1  takes a  piece of meat   2  a shop. He  comes to a   3   .  There  4  a wooden bridge over it.  When he is  running over the  bridge , he looks into the   5  . He   6  another dog  with a piece of  meat in his   7  . He  wants to   8   it. So  he  9  his mouth. Just then his  piece of meat falls   10   the river.

 1. ______ 2. ______ 3. _______ 4. _______ 5. _______

 6. ______ 7. ______ 8. _______ 9. _______ 10. _______

 Ⅷ. 阅读理解: 10%

 (A)

 Mr. Green was  a teacher in  a big city in  the north of  England. He usually went to  France or Germany (德国) for a  few weeks in  his summer holidays , and he  spoke French and  German (德语) quite well.

 But  one year Mr. Green said to  one of his  friends ,“I' m going to  have a holiday in  Japan. But I  don' t speak Japanese , so I' ll go  to evening class and  have Japanese lessons for  a month before I  go.”

 He  studied very hard for  a month , and  then  his holidays began and  he went to  Japan.

 When  he came back a  few weeks later , his friend said to  him ,“Did you  have any trouble with your Japanese when you  were in Japan?”

 “No , I didn' t  have any trouble with it ,”answered Mr  Green.“But the  Japanese did!”

 根据短文内容判断正误:对的打“√”,错的打“×”.

 (  )1. Mr. Green was  a Frenchman and  he spoke French           very well.

 (  )2. Mr. Green had  Japanese lessons because he  wanted          to visit Japan.

 (  )3. Mr. Green stayed in  Japan for a  few weeks.

 (  )4. The Japanese understood Mr  Green very well in             Japan.

 (  )5. Mr. Green spoke Japanese very well.

 (B)

 In  the past people sent  all  their letters by  train or ship. Now  most letters still go  by ship or  by train , but some people send them by  plane. You send a  letter by plane so  that your friend may  get it quickly. A  letter takes about twelve days to  go five days now , but soon the  time may be  made shorter.

 At  first people were afraid to  send letters by  plane. They thought that the  plane may fall and  their friends may  not get the  letters. So they sent two  letters —one letter by  plane and the  other by train or  ship. They wanted to  make sure that their friends would get  the letters. Planes are  now almost as  safe and sure as  trains or ships. Now  more and more people send their letters by  plane.

 (  )1. Many years ago , people sent all  letters _____.

       A. by train          B. by train or  ship

       C. by ship           D. by plane and  by ship

 (  )2. A letter by  plane is _____ a letter by  ship.

       A. as fast as         B. not as fast as

       C. safer than         D. faster than

 (  )3. If you  send a letter from England by  train , it can           get to India in _____ days.

        A. twelve    B. five    C. seventeen    D. twenty

 (  )4. A long time ago  people sometimes sent _____ by             plane and by  trains or by  ships to be  safe.

        A. two same letters        B. one letter

        C. many letters            D. two different letters

 (  )5. Which is  right?

       A. People are still afraid to  send letters by  plane.

       B. Planes are faster than ships but  are not as  safe              as ships now.

      C. Planes are faster than trains and  are also as                  safe as trains.

        D. People send all  their letters by  plane now.

 初二英语第二十四单元练习卷

 一、指出下列每组单词划线部分的发音与所给单词           划线部分读音相同的一个单词:

 (  )1. t i dy    A. t i ger   B. afr ai d   C. an i mal  D. Apr i l

 (  )2. pr o blemA. radi o   B. ar ou nd  C. cr o ss   D. seas o n

 (  )3. inst ea d A. gr ea t   B. sp ea k   C. t ea ch   D. h ea lthy

 (  )4. r ou nd  A. w ou ld  B. b ou ght  C. c ou nt   D. c ou ntry

 (  )5. visit ed   A. tir ed   B. land ed   C. play ed   D. laugh ed

 (  )6. b a by    A. f a t     B.  a nything C. m a tter  D. mist a ke

 (  )7. w a shing A. w a ter  B. husb a nd C. underst a nd D. w a nt

 (  )8. tid y      A. sk y    B.  y es      C. bus y     D. cr y

 (  )9. gard e n   A. larg e   B. probl e m  C. r e st     D. pock e t

 (  )10. u s ually A. mi s take B. hu s band C. plea s ure D. me ss age

 二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

 1. tidy (比较级) ___________  2. baby (复数) __________

 3. fat (反义词) ________ 4. wash (第三人称单数) ______

 5. cry (现在分词) __________ 6. tidy (过去式) _________

 7. little (最高级) ___________ 8. thin (最高级) ________

 9. round (同义词) _________ 10. tired (比较级) ________

 三、汉译英:

 1. 整理房间: ___________________

 2. 帮助某人做某事: _____________________

 3. 呆在家里: ____________________

 4. 每五分钟: ____________________

 5. 保持房间的整洁: ______________________

 6. 没问题: ____________________

 7. 帮忙洗衣服: __________________

 8. 仔细检查某人: _________________________

 9. 感到疲劳: ___________________

 10. 多参加运动: __________________

 四、选择填空:

 (  )1. I sometimes play _____ football after school.

       A. /      B. a      C. an      D. the

 (  )2. It took him  more than a  year _____ to draw a               beautiful horse in  five minutes.

       A. learning              B. learned  

       C. to learn              D. to learning

 (  )3. After carrying water I  felt ______.

       A. tried       B. tired       C. good      D. tiring

 (  )4. I have to  wash ______ clothes  after school.

       A. every     B. each     C. all the     D. the all

 (  )5. The doctor looked ______my mother very carefully.

        A. to       B. of      C. at       D. over

 (  )6. We must keep our  classroom ______.

        A. dirty              B. clean and tidy   

        C. cleanly            D. easily

 (  )7. What do  you do _____the house when you  are at            home?

        A. round      B. at      C. over      D. on

 (  )8. It' s very kind of  you to help me ____ my English.

       A. learning      B. with      C. to      D. on

 (  )9. _____ to catch the  early bus?

        A. Have you          B. Do you have

        C. Does he has       D. Did you had

 (  )10. Can you  give me the  answer ____ this question?

        A. of       B. on     C. at      D. to

 (  )11. I ____ my pen  everywhere but I  didn' t ____ it.

        A. looked after , find      B. looked for , find

        C. foundl , look after      D. foun , look for

 (  )12. ____ you tell me  where our teacher is?

        A. Can     B. May     C. Must    D. Have to

 (  )13. At last the doctor said,“There' s nothing __ you.”

        A. ill about            B. bad with

        C. wrong to           D. wrong with

 (  )14. Do you  know how much meat ____ in the  fridge?

        A. are there            B. there are

         C. is there            D. there is

 (  )15. He ____ to bed  until he finis hes  his homework.

        A. goes  B. won' t go  C. didn' t go  D. isn' t go

 (  )16. If you  do that , you' ll soon feel _____.

        A. much healthier       B. much healthy

        C. enough healthy       D. more healthier

 (  )17. You had  better _____ the food _____.

         A. work , good          B. made , hot

         C. to get , cold          D. keep , hot

 (  )18. There are ____ days in  a month than there are  in            a year .

         A. many    B. more    C. fewer    D. less

 (  )19. You may _____ go to  see the doctor.

        A. must    B. had to    C. has to    D. have to

 (  )20. She goes to  see her aunt _______.

        A. every three day    B. each three day

        C. every three days    D. three every days

 五、句型变换:

 1. I  have to sit  down and rest  every five minutes .

   ___________________________________________

 2. He had  to  find  out the answer .

    ___________________________________________

 3. I  mean  you  eat too much food .

   ____________________________________________

 4. They talked and  laughed  happily .

   _____________________________________________

 5. The students are  all working very hard. (改为感叹句)

   _____________________________________________

 6. Don' t answer the  question. You think it  over. (用            before 联成一句)

    _____________________________________________

 7. You are  free. You had  better go with us. (用 if 联成       一句)

   _____________________________________________

 8. She had  to stay at  home. She was  ill. (用because 联成       一句)

    _____________________________________________

 9. The baby went to  sleep. His mother came back. (用         aftrer 联成一句)

    ____________________________________________

 10. I come to  school early. He  comes to school very            early. (用比较级联成一句)

     ____________________________________________

 六、用情态动词can , may , must和can' t , mustn' t 填空:

 1. _____ I have a  look at your photo?

 2. _____ your sister play the  piano?

   Yes , she ______. She is  a good player.

 3. The baby is  sleeping. We ______ talk so loud.

 4. Please write it  clearly , I ______ see it.

 5. My son ______ write English now. But  he _____ speak       a little Enlgish. 

 6. You ______ study harder than before.

 7. Where is  Tom going next week? He ___ go to  London.

 8. When the  lights are red , the traffic _______ stop.

 9. He' ll come to  help you if  he ______.

 10. Little Tom ______ move this big  box.

 七、用所给动词的正确形式填空:

 1. I  finished ________(read) the  book. You may _______        (take) it away.

 2. We must ________ (listen) to the  teacher  in class.

 3. Look! The bus _______(come). Let' s _______(hurry).

 4. I' m glad _______(hear) the good news.

 5. I  had better _______(go) home now.

 6. the temperature _______(stay) above zero in  the day         time tomorrow.

 7. Do you  enjoy ________(water) the  trees in the  garden?

 8. When _____(be) you born? I _____(be) born in  1983.

 9. _____ you _____(have) lunch at  school or at  home last       term?

 10. My father usually __________ (watch) TV in  the            evening. But he __________ (not watch) TV last night.

 八、用所给词的正确形式填空:

 1.  I _______ get up at  six in the  morning. (usual)

 2. Don' t climb up  the tall tree. It' s _______. (danger)

 3. He writes ________ in his  class. (care)

 4. He can  do the work very _______. (good)

 5. Kate is  over there. These flowers are _______. (she)

 6. Many _______ come to  our country every year. (visit)

 7. He runs _______ than I. (show)

 九、阅读理解:

 It  was evening. Mike had  done his homework , but mary was  still sitting at  the table.

 “What are you  doing?”asked Mike.

 “Algebra (代数). The answer won' t come out.”said Mary.

 “Let me show you.”

 “No , I' ll  work it  out  myself.”

 Half  an hour passed. And  an hour.

 “I' m  going to bed ,”said  Mike angrily.“Here  is the answer. Look , I' ve put  it on the  table.”Mary didn' t even turn her  head. Mike got  into the bed  and fell asleep. Mary  worked for  a long time. She  washed her face in  the cold water and  again sat down at  the table. The  answer to the  problem lay beside her. But  Mary didn' t want to  look at it.

 The  next day she  got an excellent mark (优秀分数) for algebra , and this didn' t surprise anyone in  her class. But  Mike knew very well what ‘excellent’had cost her.

 (  )1. Mike had  done his lessons in  the evening , but               Mary _______.

        A. did      B. isn' t      C. hadn' t    D. has , too

 (  )2. Algebra was _____ for Mary.

       A. easy    B. difficult     C. easily    D. difficultly

 (  )3. Mike ______ and went to  bed.

       A. put the algebra book on  the table .

       B. finished watching TV

       C. put the answer on  the table

       D. washed his face in  the cold water

 (  )4. At last Mary ______.

       A. finished her homework all  by herself

       B. looked at the  answer

       C. was tired and  went to bed

       D. was sitting at  the table all  the night

 初二英语第二十五单元练习卷

 一、指出下列各组单词划线部分的发音与所给单词           划线部分读音相同的一个单词:

 (  )1.  i sland    A. p i cnic    B. t i dy    C. th i ck   D. Apr i l

 (  )2. al o ne   A. n o body  B. pr o blem  C. t o night  D. c o me

 (  )3. p u sh   A.  u ntil   B. Aug u st   C. en ou gh   D. c ou ld

 (  )4. sug a r   A. nob o dy   B. p ar ty    C. l ar ge   D. c ar rot

 (  )5. sm e ll   A. gr ea t   B.  a nybody   C. veg e table   D. b e

 (  )6. underst a nd  A. isl a nd   B. d a nger  C. mist a ke  D. f a t

 (  )7. pi c nic   A. on c e    B.  c ry    C. rea ch    D. pla c e

 (  )8. far th er  A.  th in   B. bir th day  C. fea th er  D. sou th

 (  )9.sandwich es A. classmat es B. wiv es C. holiday s D. pag es

 (  )10.  ice    A. hu s band  B.  sh ine  C. unu s ually D.  s unny

 二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

 1. cry (反义词) _________  2. hit (现在分词) _________

 3. we (反身代词) _______  4. healthy (比较级) ________

 5. usual (反义词) ________ 6. push (第三人称单数) ___

 7. smell (过去式) ________  8. can (过去式) __________

 9. farther (同音词) _______ 10. tidy (副词) __________

 三、汉译英:

 1. 多好的主意啊! : ___________________

 2. 把船拉出水面: ___________________

 3. 独自地: __________________

 4. 在岛上登陆: ___________________

 5. 环顾四周: _____________________

 6. 感觉有点怕: _____________________

 7. 不再: _______________  8. 立刻: _________________

 9. 保持凉快: ___________ 10. 去野餐: ______________

 四、选择填空:

 (  )1. There is  going to ____ English film this evening.

       A. have an            B. be an  

       C. have a              D. be a

 (  )2. You look ____ today. What' s wrong ____ you?

       A. tired , with           B. tiring , to

       C. tire , with            D. tires , on

 (  )3. Li Ming does his  homework ______ than I.

       A. more careful         B. much carefully

       C. more carefully        D. much careful

 (  )4. Did they spend _____money on  their trip to  New            Youk?

       A. few      B. many      C. lots      D. much

 (  )5. Do you  have _____ to tell me?

       A. interesting anything     B. anything interesting

       C. interesting  something    D. something interesting

 (  )6. _____ your sister.

       A. Not worry for        B. Not to worry about

       C. Don' t worry about    D. Don' t worry with

 (  )7. Is it  time ______ our supper?

       A. to       B. in      C. for      D. on

 (  )8. Xiao Li  is _____ in the reading-room now.

       A. not longer         C. not any long

       C. no longer          D. no long

 (  )9. ____ the picnic basket up  here to my  place.

        A. Take      B. Bring      C. Make      D. Have

 (  )10. We must _____ the food hot.

        A. work      B. get     C. have     D. keep

 (  )11. Shall we  go to ____ island for  fishing?

        A. near   B. nearer  C. the nearest   D. nearly

 (  )12. Does ____ live on  the island?

        A. someone          B. anybody

        C. many people       D. some ones

 (  )13. The twins did  it all _____.

        A. by themselves         B. by himself

        C. by them              D. themselves

 (  )14. The child could pull the  boat ____ the riverside              by himself.

         A. to up     B. on    C. up     D. up to

 (  )15. He wanted ____ some bananas in  the fruit shop.

        A. buys     B. buying    C. to buy    D. buy

 (  )16. There is ____ srong with my  bike. I must ask ___           to mend it  for me.

        A. something , anybody     B. anything , somebody

        C. something , somebody    D. anything , anybody

 (  )17. A monkey is looking for  something __ in the trees.

        A. eat      B. to eat     C. eating     D. eats

 (  )18. — Have  you _____ Australia?

        — Yes , I have.

        A. been to            B. gone to   

        C. be to              D. go to

 (  )19. There ____some dangerous animals ___ this island.

        A. may are , in          B. may be , on

        C. may have , on        D. may has , in

 (  )20. ____ Kate feel afraid of  dangerous animals?

        A. Was      B. Were      C. Did     D. Do

 五、介词填空:

 1. They will pick some bananas _____ their picnic lunch.

 2. The children started to  walk _____ the island.

 3. Where are  the workers? They  are _____ work.

 4. Tohe children pulled the  boat up _____ the water.

 5. The picnic basket was  no longer _____ the tree.

 6. There is  something wrong _____ my bike. Can  you           help me?

 7. Her uncle' s house is  far _____ here.

 8. They went there on  foot _____ by bus.

 9. She has  to help _____ the cooking.

 10. Can you  come out ____ a walk ____ the park?

 六、句型变换:

 1. The students went to  that island for   a picnic . (划线提       问)

   _____________________________________________

 2. The children could pull the  boat up  from  the water .         (同上)

   _____________________________________________

 3. He wants to  go  to  the nearest island  tomorrow. (同上)

   _____________________________________________

 4. Mr Li began to  learn English  the  year before last .(同上)

   ______________________________________________

 5. You can  see something unusual in  the picture. (改为        疑问句)

   ______________________________________________

 6. There is  something in the  next classroom. (改为否定        句)

    _____________________________________________

 7. His aunt has  to go to  see a doctor this morning.(同         上)

    _____________________________________________

 8. Show them your photo. (同上)

    _____________________________________________

 初二英语第二十六单元练习卷

 一、指出下列各组单词划线部分发音与所给单词划线部分读音相同的一个单词:

 (  )1. s ou thern A. s ou th   B. l au gh  C. y ou ng  D. r ou nd

 (  )2. oper a tion A. c a ndle  B. vill a ge  C. d a nger D.  a nything

 (  )3. f al l      A. h al f    B. l o ng    C.  au tumn D. sh al l

 (  )4. w or se    A. w or d   B. sh or t   C. p or ridge D. st or y

 (  )5. cl e ver    A. sh e     B. h ear     C. h e lp    D. b e gin

 (  )6. t au ght    A. d o ctor   B. n o t   C. l o t    D. br ou ght

 (  )7. th e mselves A. dr e ss  B.  e njoy  C. probl e m  D. mys e lf

 (  )8. inst ea d    A. cl ea n   B. m ea t    C. h ea d    D. s ea

 (  )9. p oor      A. d oor   B. s ure   C. d oor bell   D. Ind ia n

 (  )10. mon ey   A. monk ey     B. k ey    C. th ey    D. s ay

 二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

 1. teach (过去式) _________  2. poor (反义词) ________

 3. fall (过去式) ___________ 4. feel (过去式) _________

 5. sad (反义词) _________ 6. they (反身代词) _________

 7. hit (过去式) __________ 8. hurt (现在分词) ________

 9. month (复数) _________ 10. he (反身代词) _________

 三、汉译英:

 1. 从自行车上摔下: ______________________

 2. 自学英语: ________________

 3. 动手术: __________________

 4. 随便吃蛋糕: ______________________

 5. 过得快乐: _______________

 6. 第一次骑自行车: _________________________

 7. 一节游泳课: ____________________

 8. 又一张莉莉的照片: ___________________________

 9. 穿衣服: ___________________

 10. 并非每个人: _____________________

 四、选择填空:

 (   )1. Yesterday he  fell _____ his bike and  hurt himself.

       A. of      B. out     C. off      D. over

 (   )2. He is  rich and can  buy _____a lot of  good things.

       A. myself      B. himself     C. him    D. son

 (   )3. He will leave for  America ______.

       A. the next month             B. last week

       C. next day                   D. next month

 (   )4. They have a  daughter ______ Jane.

        A. called      B. calls      C. calling     D. to call

 (   )5. So the  next day they _____ her to  a doctor.

        A. take       B. takes      C. taking      D. took

 (   )6. _____ time we  had last night!

        A. What good               B. What a good

       C. How good                D. How a good

 (   )7. Not everybody in  our class ____ good at  English.

       A. is       B. are       C. isn' t       D. aren' t

 (   )8. Please help yourself _____ anything you  like.

        A. at       B. with       C. to       D. of

 (   )9. _____ you sure she' ll like it?

       A. Do       B. Will       C. Are       D. Were

 (   )10. People enjoy _____ during the  holidays.

        A. yourselves             B. themselves

        C. themself               D. them

 (   )11. This is _____ interesting film. We  all like it.

         A. /       B. the       C. a      D. an

 (   )12. You must go  to see the  doctor if you ____ ill.

         A. will be      B. were      C. may     D. are

 (   )13. They were quite ____ to hear the  news.

         A. please   B. pleasure   C. pleased    D. to please

 (   )14. Get up  and get _____ quickly.

        A. dressed    B. dress    C. dressing    D. to dress

 (   )15. It was  to  dark. I ____ see nothing.

        A. can     B. could    C. must     D. have to

 (   )16. I' d like to  have _____ try.

        A. the second              B. second

        C. a second                 D. the other

 (   )17. They found there ___ something wrong with their            car.

         A. was       B. is      C. are      D. were

 (   )18. — ______?   — I' d  like to borrow some books.

         A. Who are you        B. What do you  want

         C. Can I help you      D. How are you

 (   )19. — What' s the  date today?  — ______.

        A. Today  is Wednesday 

        B. It' s a sunny day  today

        C. It' s cloudy         D. It' s January 3rd

 (   )20. ___ Smiths ___ going to move into a  new house.

         A. The , is    B. The , are    C. / , is    D. A , are

 五、填上适当的反身代词:

 1. The little boy  can look after ________ now.

 2. The children wash ________ before breakfast.

 3.“Lily  and Lucy! Help ________ to some cakes.”said         Mrs Shute.

 4. I' m going to  mend my bike ________ this afternoon.

 5. We don' t need their help. We  can finish the  work all        by ________.

 6. The girl often looks at _________ in the  mirror.

 7.“Wang  Fei! This maths problem is  not easy. You     must ask our  teacher _________.”said Li Ming.

 8. The school _________ is very large , but there are  not  many teachers and  students in it.

 六、句型变换:

 1. My father goes to  work  by  bus . (划线提问)

   ______________________________________________

 2. The Shute family lived in   the southern  part of  the USA. (同上)

    _____________________________________________

 3. They called him   James . (同上)

    _____________________________________________

 4.  His  sister and his  parents  had to  help him. (同上)

    _____________________________________________

 5. There was  a good doctor  in  a town not  far away .( 同上 )

    _____________________________________________

 6. He could not  wash himself or  get clressed. (改为反意问句)

   ______________________________________________

 7. There was  something wrong with the  child. (改为疑问句)

   ____________________________________________

 8. Jim is  fat. (改为感叹句) ________________________

 9. You' d better stay here. (改为否定句)

   _____________________________________________

 10. He bought himself a  lot of presents. (改为疑问句)

   ______________________________________________

 七、用所给动词的适当形式填空:

 1. Look ! A  lot of students _______ (dance) near the  river.

 2. Zhang Li ________ (like) to play basketball. Look , she ________ (play) with her  classmates over there.

 3. He ______ (study) much harder this term than he  did last term.

 4. _____ (be) there any  apple trees here a  few years ago?

 5. my brother usually ____ (do) his lessons in  the evening.

 6. What ______ you ______ (do) the day  before yesterday? I ______ (do) some reading.

 7. The teacher had  to let the  boy _______ ( go) home.

 8. I  hope it ______ (be) fine tomorrow.

 9. He wanted _____ (find) out the  answer to the  question.

 10. _____ (be) Tom' s shoes old  or new?

 八、改病句:

 (  )1.  When  spring  comes , it is  getting   warm  and warm .

         A           B          C           D

 (   )2. No , I   couldn' t   listen   anything   at  all .

                 A       B       C       D

 (  )3.  Do  you   like   rice   for      supper  today?

        A         B          C      D

 (  )4.  Are  there   any     people    on    that  inland?

         A          B      C      D

 (  )5.  The  doctor said he   can  do  nothing   to  help  him.

         A                 B       C        D

 (  )6. I am   sure  there  may  be  some  danger  animals   on    that island.

 (  )7. He    is    looking     out    the    window .

             A      B       C           D

 (  )8.  Here   are  a story  about  poor people in   the  USA.

         A   B           C                 D

 (  )9.  Would  you please  to  tell  me an   interesting   story ?

         A               B              C      D

 (  )10. He  will  take  his  mother  to  hospital  the  next  day .

               A          B         C          D

       

 初中英语第二十七单元练习卷

 一、指出下列各组单词划线部分发音与所给单词划           线部分读音相同的一个单词:

 (   )1. hol i day  A. t i dy   B.  i sland   C. m i stake   D. sh i ne

 (   )2.  wh ole   A.  wh o  B.  wh y    C.  wh at     D.  wh ich

 (   )3. m u sic   A. p u ll   B. h u sband C. un u sual  D. b u sy

 (   )4. d ia ry     A. p ai r   B.  air    C. d ia gram    D. c are ful

 (   )5.  a sleep   A. pl a te  B.  A pril   C.  a nimal  D.  a ddress

 (   )6. gr ea t     A. r ea l    B. m ea n   C. h ea lth    D. ag ai n

 (   )7. ex a mple A.  a nswer   B. f a mily   C. n a me   D. w a nt

 (   )8. inter e st  A. gu e ss    B.  e leven   C. w e nt    D. Sh e

 (   )9. p u t      A. m u m    B. b u t     C. p u ll    D. st u dy

 (   )10. cr y      A. diar y     B. bab y     C. cit y   D. sk y

 二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

 1. interest (形容词) ________ 2. left (反义词) _________

 3. bring (过去式) __________ 4. healthy (名词) ________

 5. stop (现在分词) _________ 6. class (复数) __________

 7. taught (原形) ____________ 8. sing (过去式) ________

 9. hit (过去式) _____________ 10. diary (复数) ________

 三、汉译英:

 1. 停止做某事: _____________ 2. 扮鬼脸: __________

 3. 把某人单独留下: ________________

 4. 名胜: _____________   5. 照顾: ________________

 6. 醒来: ______________  7. 各种各样: __________ ____

 8. 越哭越厉害: ___________________________

 9. 把整个情况告诉某人: ___________________

 10. 睡着了: _____________________

 四、选择填空:

 (   )1. Don' t worry about your child. I' ll _____ him while you  are away.

        A. take care of            B. take a look

        C. take after               D. take good care

 (   )2. _____ she woke up  and began to  cry.

        A. Half an hour after       B. Half an hour later

        C. Later half an  hour       D. After half hour

 (   )3. He made faces to  make the baby ______.

        A. to laugh   B. laughed   C. laughing   D. laugh

 (   )4. The teacher asked the  girl to show him ____ book.

        A. other one B. another  C. one another  D. other

 (   )5. My father will take _____ to the  zoo this Sunday.

        A. I and my  brother       B. my brother and  me

        C. me and my  brother     D. my brother and  I

 (   )6. We can  find many places of _____ in Fuzhou.

        A. interesting  B. interested C. interest  D. interests

 (   )7. _____ time they had  in the park yesterday !

       A. What good             B. What a good

        C. How good             D. How a good

 (   )8. There is _____ car on  the road.

        A. no      B. some      C. not     D. any

 (   )9. We don' t like him _____.

        A. no more              B. some more

        C. any more             D. the more

 (   )10. I left my  girl ______.

        A. by myself           B. in myself

        C. by herself           D. by her

 (   )11. You could buy  her a bike, __ it may  be too dear.

        A. and      B. but      C. if      D. when

 (   )12. We can  see _____ in his garden.

         A. all kind of  flower      B. all kinds of  flower

         C. all kind of  flowers    D. all kinds of  flowers

 (   )13. A foreign friend visited our  village and _____.

         A. we       B. ours      C. us       D. our

 (   )14. He is  the tallest _____ the brothers.

         A. of       B. in      C. at      D. for

 (   )15. Would you  please ____ me an interesting story?

          A. speak      B. tell      C. talk      D. say

 (   )16. He won' t come back ____ the end  of the month.

         A. by       B. but       C. until       D. on

 (   )17. He was  tired , so he stopped _____.

        A. to have a  rest         B. had rest

        C. having a rest          D. have a rest

 (   )18. We may  have a meeting tomorrow, but we ____.

        A. have               B. don' t have

        C. don' t have to       D. may not have

 (   )19. Who has  the fewest apples, Tom, Li Lei ___ Kate?

         A. and        B. or        C. but        D. with

 (   )20. Why does she  look so _____.

        A. worry    B. worrying    C. worried    D. worries

  五、在必要的地方填上适当的冠词:

 1. Tom and  Mike talked for _____ hour and ____ half this afternoon.

 2. You may  tell Dick _____ whole story.

 3. Walk along _____ road , and take _____ first turning on _____ left.

 4. There is _____ American boy  in our class. His  name is _____ Tom.

 5. Grandma is  ill. I must take her  to ______ hospital.

 6. Summer holidays will begin _____ next month.

 7. ____ old woman has  two children , ____ son and ____daughter. ____ son is _____ doctor and ____ daughter is ____ teacher.

 8. I  think you' ll have ______ good time.

 9. Mr and  Mrs Shute had _____ daughter called Jane. Then they had _____ second child … ____ son.

 10. One day , ____ Shutes heard that thers was ____ good doctor in _____ town not  far away.

 六、句型变换:

 1. He has  to wash all  the plates and  things  after meals .  (划线提问)

   _____________________________________________

 2. You need to  wear  lots  of warm clothes . (同上)

    _____________________________________________

 3. I' d like to  take the one   on the  right . (同上)

   ______________________________________________

 4. He comes to  see us  once  a year . (同上)

   ______________________________________________

 5. We really enjoyed  working on  the farm . (同上)

    _____________________________________________

 6. Jim and  his friends went to  help  the  farmers . (同上)

   ______________________________________________

 7. Peter has  to stay at  home. (改为疑问句)

   ______________________________________________

 8.  My mother does morning exercises every day. (同上)

    _____________________________________________

 9. They are  going to have a  football match next Sunday.(同上)

    _____________________________________________

 10. They have been there before. (同上)

     ____________________________________________

 11. I caught a  cold yesterday. (同上)

    _____________________________________________

 12. I shall go  to the zoo  by bike tomorrow. (同上)

    _____________________________________________

 七、用所给动词的适当形式填空:

 1. I _____(tell) him the  news as soon as  I _____(see) him.

 2. The workers _______ (not go) home until they _______ (finish) the work last night.

 3. It often ______ (rain) in summer. It ______ (rain) hard last night. It _______ (not rain) now.

 4. Tom and  Mike _____ (be) much  taller this year than they ______ (be) last year.

 5. It' s time for  breakfast. Let' s stop _______ (read).

 6. When my  children _____ (be)young , I _____ (be) busy all  day long. I  often ______ (clean) the  house after the  children ______ (go) to bed.

 7. When I ______ (show) him the  book , he ______ (say) it ______ (be) a good book.

 8. I _____ (see) him six  months ago when he ______ (be) in hospital.

 9. Please ______ (be) there at  2 : 00 . Don' t let  us ______ (wait).

 10. His mother ______(make) him ______(do) the washing himself.

 八、改错句:

 (  )1. There is  going   to have  a  sports meet   in  our 

                        A           B       C

 school  next  month .

           D

 (  )2. Our English teacher   is    nearly  forty , but she   looks                             A     B                  C

  more  younger  than  she is.

    D

 (  )3.   It   is   time    for   go   to school .

        A      B     C          D

 (  )4. When he   reached  home he  turned  on  the radio 

                  A                   B

 and   listen  to the   weather report . 

      C              D

 (  )5. She usually  washes  her clothes , cleans  the  floor ,                         A                        B

 and  keeps everything  to  clean  and tidy  on  Sunday morning .                      C                  D

 (   )6. Must I   clean    the  room  now ? No , you  mustn' t .

                A     B         C              D

 (  )7. Everything  are   much  lighter   on  the moon than on                     A       B       C

 the   earth .

      D

 (   )8. In winter  it is   much colder   in  Beijing  than  Fuzhou .             A                B        C             D

 (   )9. She had   a swim  this morning ,  hadn' t   she ?

                 A         B         C    D

 (  )10.  I' ll  go to   play with  you if  I  am  going to be 

          A           B                 C

 free   tomorrow .

         D

 英语语音训练

 选出发音不同的一个:

 1. A. m a p       B. l a nd        C. h a ppen       D.  a ny

 2. A. w a nt       B. w a s        C. wh a t         D. w a ter

 3. A. r e lay       B.  E nglish     C.  E ngland      D. wom e n

 4. A. mach i ne    B. pol i ce       C. pol i ceman    D.  i t

 5. A. c o me       B. s o n         C. l o ve         D. b o x

 6. A. d o          B. wh o         C. wh o se       D. w o man

 7. A. b u s         B. tr u ck        C. res u lt        D. b u sy

 8. A. r u ler        B. p u t          C. f u ll          D. s u gar

 9. A. ni c e       B.  c ity        C. bi c ycle       D. deli c ious

 10. A.  g ane       B. a g e          C.  g o           D. ba g

 11. A.  h e        B.  h and         C.  h our         D.  h urry

 12. A.  s it        B. work s         C. boy s          D. glas s

 13. A.  s ure       B. Rus s ian      C.  s ugar         D. ea s y

 14. A.  s port      B.  s leep       C.  s chool        D. plea s ure

 15. A. si x        B. ne x t        C. e x pensive    D. e x ample

 16. A. r ai n        B. s ay          C. m ay be         D. s ai d

 17. A.  al l         B. c al l          C. ch al k         D.  al so

 18. A. h al f       B.  al veady      C. s al t           D.  al most

 19. A. c ar       B. p ar ty         C. h ar dly         D. w ar m

 20. A. sug ar       B. w ar m       C. qu ar ter      D. tow ar ds    21. A. d au ghten    B.  au tumn    C.  Au gust     D. bec au se

 22. A.  au nt       B. bec au se    C.  Au stralia   D.  Au stralian

 23. A. pl ea se     B.  ea st         C. t ea pot      D. br ea d

 24. A. gr ea t      B. br ea d      C. w ea ther     D. alr ea dy

 25. A. id ea       B. r ea l       C. br ea k       D. r ea lly

 26. A. rec ei ve    B. k ey        C. th ey         D. h e

 27. A.  ei ther      B.  ei ght       C. n ei ther     D. h i de

 28. A. for ei gn     B. monk ey    C. k ey         D. bas ke t

 29. A. h er         B. t er m       C. p er son      D. player

 30. A. f ew        B. bl ew        C. dr ew        D. gr ew

 31. A. d ear        B. h ear        C. cl ear        D. p ear

 32. A.  ear ly        B. l ear n       C.  ear th       D. h ear t

 33. A. h ere         B. wh ere       C. th ere       D. h air

 34. A. w ere        B. h ere        C. h ear        D. pion eer

 35. A. l ie          B. d ie         C. t ie          D. p ie ce

 36. A. p ie ce        B. f ie ld       C. fr ie nd      D. fr ee

 37. A. f ir e         B. b ir d        C. f ir st        D. d ir ty

 38. A. classr oo m    B. r oo m      C. t oo         D. ch oo se

 39. A. f or          B. sh or t       C. c or ner      D. w or k

 40. A. w or k        B. w or se      C. w or ld      D. tract or

 41. A. y ou ng       B. en ou gh     C. tr ou ble     D. gr ou nd

 42. A. c ou gh       B. br ou ght     C. th ou ght    D. f ou ght

 43. A. th ou gh      B. y ou         C. thr ou gh     D. gr ou p

 44. A. c ou ld       B. w ou ld      C. sh ou ld     D. thr ou gh

 45. A. seri ou s      B. fam ou s    C. darger ou s   D. bl ou se

 46. A. h ow         B. kn ow       C. t ow n       D. cr ow d

 47. A. d oo r        B. p oo r       C. fl oo r       D. d oo rbell

 48. A. f our        B. y our       C. c our se      D. h our

 49. A. j our ney     B. col our      C. neighb our    D. small er

 50. A. Tuesd ay     B. tod ay      C. yesterd ay      D. sund ay

 51. A. bl ue         B. tr ue       C. q ue ue        D. fr ui t

 52. A. b ui ld        B. b ui lding   C. s ui t          D. h i t

 53. A. d ur ing       B. Th ur sday   C. t ur n         D. n ur se

 54. A. Sat ur day    B. t ur n       C. n ur se        D. h er

 55. A. tea ch er      B.  ch icken    C. su ch       D. ma ch ine

 56. A. su ch        B. s ch ool     C.  ch ristmas   D. heada ch e

 57. A. cou gh       B. hi gh        C. bou gh t    D. strai gh t

 58. A. E ng lish     B. lo ng er      C. a ng ry      D. si ng er

 59. A.  n o         B. ha ng       C. tha n k      D. u n cle

 60. A.  th ink       B. ear th        C.  th ird       D.  th is

 61. A. sta tion     B. opera tion    C. ques tion    D. inren tion

 62. A.  wh at        B.  wh en       C.  wh ose     D.  wh ile

 初中英语总复习系列

 选择所给动词的适当形式填空:

 A

 speak , say , stay , live , give , get , be

 I  heard from my  brother last week. He lives is  the USA. He _______ in his  letter that he  would come back next month. If  he comes back , he _______ a suprise. Now  we _______ in a tall new  building. We _______ here fer only  three months. The  key to my  new house _______ to us  four months ago. I  think he must be  quite happy when he  hears the news.

 B

 stop , take , eat , like , want , begin , cry

 A  busy mother asked her  young son to  take his baby sister out  into the garden and  look after her  for an hour while she  was doing some work in  the house. Suddenly the  baby _______ to cry.“Billy , what' s the  matter with Sunsan? Why _______ she _______?”shouted the  mother to her  son.

 “Because she _______ my coins(硬币),”answered Billy.

 “Well , let  her play with a  few of them if  it _______ her crying,”said  the mother.

 “But I know that , she wants to  keep them,”answered Billy.“She _______ two of  them already!”

 C

 be , go , take , visit , work , stay , meet

 Jim _______ Kate in  the street a  few days ago. The following is  their dialogue.

 J : Hello, Kate. Glad to  meet you here. Where _______ you _______ since last week?

 K : Xiamen. It' s a  very beautiful place. ______ you ______ it?

 J : Yes , I' m. I  think I' d better _______ with Chen Hao , because his  father ________ there .

 K : Yes , You' re right.

 D

 study , learn , come , have , begin , go , teach

 My  English teacher is  Miss Gao. She  is only thirty. Though she  is young. She _________ English very well. We _______ a lot  from her since she ________ to teach us.  All of us  enjoy ________ English  classes. I hear Miss Gao  will go to  study in America soon. I  hope she ________ back as  soon as possible and  will teach us  again.

 E

 live , stay , rain , send , go , come , be

 Dear  Hong Ying,

 I' ve just heard from Li  Mei that you' re been back in  Fuzhou for holidays. While you _______ with your family , why don' t you ________ down and  see us for  a few days? It  has not begun to ________ yet , so with luck , we _______ able to  see some places of  in terest when you  come.

 Did  you receive my  last letter? It _______ to you  at your school address in  Beijing last month. 

 Well , think of  coming to see  us , and we hope you  can come soon.

 Best  wishes to you!

                      Yours,

                       Li Dang (and Lin  Hua)

 F

 look , visit , come , begin , take , do , go

 A : Summer holidays _________ soon. What' re you  going to ________?

 B : My parents __________ me to  our home town. We' ll __________ our grandparents there.

 A : They' ll be  very happy to  see you again.

 B : Sure . We  may ________ by air.

 A : I hope you' ll have a  good time there.

 B : Thank you.

 G

 may , love , do , work , be , can , visit

 Everyone ________ his hometown. So ________ I . My  hometown isn' t very large , but she' s beautiful. Ther _______ a lot  of changes since 1980. Ten years ago  you ________ see few TV  sets here , but there are  many now. People are  busy _________. I hope my  hometown will be  more beautiful soon.

 H

 say , buy , be , go , sell , come , speak

 Look! Alice ________ to the  assistant in the  book shop. She _________ a book on  art.

 “Where  are Jack and  Joan?”

 “Sorry , I  don' t know. They ________ here just now. Perhaps they ________ to the  Children' s Palace. I  think they ________ back in  an hour.”

 I

 worry , change , turn , kill , get , remember , keep

 Many  years ago , farmers _________ very angry with hawks because they were eating lots of  thair chickens. The  farmers thought hawks must ________. So  many hawks were killed. After that , the farmers didn' t have to ________ about their chickens. But  field mice came out  and ate up  a lot of  crops.

 Hawks ate  both chickens and  field mice. They ate  more field mice than chickens. When the  farmers killed a  lot of hawks the  balance of nature ________. It' s important for  us _________ the  balance of nature.

 J

 skate , swim , make , do , cover , throw , turn

 I  like winter best. Though it' s very cold ,  It' s good for_________. I  often go skating on  Sundays with my  father. When it  snows everything ________ white. Trees and  houses ________ with  thick snow. How  beautiful the world looks! My  friend and I  like to ________ snowmen. Sometimes we  make snow balls  and ________ them at  each other. That' s a  very interesting game. Do  you like winter?

 初二英语第一单元练习卷

 一、指出下列各组单词划线部分的发音与所给的单词相同的一个单词:

 (   )1. p a per  A. st a nd   B. S a turday  C. s a me  D. m a ny

 (   )2. p ai r    A. d ear    B. w ear      C. h ear    D.  ear ly

 (   )3. four th  A.  th en   B.  Th ursday  C. fa th er  D. bro th er

 (   )4. m ay    A. tod ay   B. Sund ay   C. Frid ay  D. Mond ay

 (   )5. sh or t   A. b or row  B. f or get    C.  or ange  D. f or ty

 (   )6. s e cond  A. w e lcome           B.  e raser

              C.  e vening            D.  e leven

 (   )7. t i me    A. wr i te   B. h i ll    C. w i th   D. f i sh

 (   )8. th ir d     A. driv er   B. t ur n   C. ov er    D. farm er

 (   )9.  sh op    A. tea ch er  B. s ch ool C. lun ch  D. ma ch ine

 (   )10. less o n  A. c o lour  B.  w ho   C. b o x   D. br o ther 

 二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

  1. short (反义词)_________ 2. four (序数词) ________

  3. shop (现在分词) _______ 4. one (序数词) _________

  5. pair (同音词) __________ 6. lesson (同义词) _______

  7. by (同音词) ___________  8. his (主格) ___________

  9. foot (复数) ____________  10. same (反义词) ______

 三、将下列汉语译成英语:

  1. 下次______________________

  2. 这学期____________________

  3. 一小张纸__________________

  4. 步行上学__________________

  5. 听我说____________________

  6. 看上去一样________________

  7. 第一课____________________

  8. 点名______________________

  9. 到达学校__________________

  10. 买东西___________________

 四、选择填空:

 (   )1. The two  pencil-boxes _____.

        A. look the same       B. looks the same

        C. look same           D. looks same

 (   )2. There are _____ on the  table.

       A. a piece of  paper    B. a piece of  papers

        C. two pieces of  paper  D. two pieces of  papers

 (   )3. Does Han  Meimei _____ a nice schoolbag ?

        A. has     B. have     C. haveing    D. is

 (   )4. How does Jim  go to school every day? ___ foot.

        A. On      B. on      C. By      D. by

 (   )5. I have your names _____ this piece of  paper.

        A. in       B. on       C. at       D. of

 (   )6. Look! Who _____ basketball over there ?

        A. are playing   B. is playing  C. playing  D. paly

 (   )7. Welcome back _____ school , boys and  girls !

        A. at       B. in       C. to      D. on

 (   )8. _____ him come in.

        A. Doesn' t let           B. Don' t lets

        C. Don' t let             D. don' t letting

 (   )9. A : Thank you  very much.   B : _____.

       A. You  are welcome    B. It doesn' t matter

        C. You are right     D. No , don' t thank me

 (   )10. What time _____ your father_____ to work very             morning.

         A. does , goes          B. is , going

         C. does , go            D. is , goes

 (   )11. Would you  like to have _____?

         A. a bread             B. some breads

         C. a piece bread        D. some bread

 (   )12. Now let  me _____ your names.

        A. to call    B. call   C. called   D. calling

 (   )13. I' m sorry _____.

        A. to late   B. of late   C. I late   D. I' m late

 (   )14. This is  Lesson One , _____.

         A. First lesson       B. the first lesson

         C. first lesson        D. lesson first

 (   )15. It _____ matter this time.

        A. isn' t     B. doesn' t    C. don' t     D. aren' t

 (   )16. Please don' t be  late _____.

         A. the next time       B. the next times

         C. next time           D. next times

 (   )17. _____ he _____ English now ?

        A. Is , readding          B. Is , reading

        C. Does , read           D. Does , reading

 (   )18. Wei Hua _____ have lunch in  the school.

         A. doesn' t often         B. don' t often

         C. often don' t           D. often doesn' t

 (   )19. There _____ twenty-five boys and  twenty-six girls            in our class.

        A. has     B. have    C. is     D. are

 (   )20. Where' s Tom? He _____ his homework in  the              classroom.

         A. does    B. do     C. is doing    D. are doing

 五、介词填空:

  1. Please write _____ the piece _____ paper.

  2. Welcome _____ our factory , Mr Green.

  3. How many students are  there _____ Class One?

  4. He  often plays football _____ the afternoon.

  5. We don' t go  to school _____ Sunday.

  6. Who is  the English teacher _____ Class Two ?

  7. Don' t forget your things early _____ the morning.

  8. He gets up _____ six _____ the morning.

 六、句型变化:

  1. Tom reads English. (用现在进行时改写)

    _____________________________________________

  2. Jim' s mother does some shopping every Sunday. (改成一般疑问句)

     ____________________________________________

  3. Han Meimei   is  making a kite now . (划线提问)

     ____________________________________________

  4. There' s a  woman in the  room. (改成复数形式)

     ____________________________________________

  5. Please call me  Lily. (改成否定句)

    _____________________________________________

  6. There are  a lot of  apples in the  basket.(改成否定句)

    _____________________________________________

  7. Kate usually has  lunch at school. (用 now 改写)

    _____________________________________________

  8. The girl   in  red  is Tom' s sister. (划线提问)

    _____________________________________________

 9. Is she  having supper now?(用usually … at home改写)

   ______________________________________________

 10. She does housework every day.(改写成一般疑问句)

     ____________________________________________

 七、用所给动词的适当形式填空:

  1. I like ________ (swim) in the  river. Now I  would like        ________ (play) football.

  2. Look! The  twins ________ (put) on  their sweaters.

  3. There _____ (be) a pen  and some pencils on  the desk.

  4. Kate _________ (not read) English now. She ________        (read) Chinese.

  5. ________ (not be) late next time.

  6. It' s ten  thirty now. It' s time ________ (go) to bed.

  7. Lily _________ (not have) any erasers.

  8. Can he ________ (wirte) in  English ?

  9. _____ you ______ (want) _____ (go) with me to  the          shop ?

  10. ______ (look) at the  blackboard. ______ (not  look) at          your books.

  11. May I __________ (borrow) your bike ?

 12. Would you  please _________ (help) me with my              English?

 八、改病句(每句只有一处错 , 指出并订正在横线上)

 (   )1. _____ Please let   me   calling   your   names .

                       A    B     C     D

 (   )2. _____   Look !  Mike  is   runing   with  the nice kite.

               A         B   C      D

 (   )3. _____ I  have   your  names  in  this piece  of  paper.

                A    B         C           D

 (   )4. _____ Lucy  and  Lily  look   like  the  same .

                   A        B    C       D

 (   )5. _____   What' s  he  doing ? He is   writes   on  the 

                 A        B           C   D

              blackboard.

 (   )6. _____The two   men  are  playing   the  basketball  over                          A         B    C            D

             there.

 (   )7. _____   Does  Wei Fang  have   a long ruler? Yes , she                  A              B  C       

               has .

               D

 (   )8. _____ This is   our    the  first lesson ,   so  I  don' t 

                      A    B              C    D

             know all your names.

 (   )9. _____ Mrs. Green  is  doing  housework. Mr. Green 

                          A

               is   reading  and  writes .

              B    C          D

 (   )10. _____ He  doesn' t   has  his  lunch   at  school.

                    A    B        C   D

 九、汉译英(每空只填一个词)

  1. 这次没关系。

    It ______ ______ ______ time.

  2. 这是第三个男孩。他在吃东西吗?

    This is _____ _____ boy. _____ he _____ something?

  3. 这是红色的铅笔。你有黑色的吗?

     This is a  red pencil. _____ you _____ a black _____?

  4. 这些妇女正在商店买东西。

    The _____ are doing some _____ in the  shop.

  5. 别叫我李雷。我是李明。

     ______ ______ me Li Lei. I  am Li Ming.

  6. 他们正在一大张纸上写名字。

    They are  writing their names ______ a ______ _____         of paper.

  7. 下次请早点到这儿来。

     Please come here ______ ______ time.

  8. 我可以用你的自行车吗? 当然可以! 给你。

     ______ I ______ your bike? ______! Here you are.

 初二英语第二单元练习卷

 一、指出下列各组单词划线部分共有几种发音:

 A: 一种读音 B: 两种读音 C: 三种读音 D. 四种读音

 (   )1. A. s oo n      B. m oo n    C. bedr oo m   D. f oo d

 (   )2. A. p ar ent     B. h ar d      C. p air        D. c ar

 (   )3. A. s ea        B. br ea d     C. m ea n      D. gr ea t

 (   )4. A. an o ther   B. fr o m      C. s o         D. d o

 (   )5. A. u s ually    B.  s ister      C. swim s      D.  s chool

 (   )6. A. tr ai n      B. pl a ne      C. aw ay       D. w ay

 (   )7. A. pol i ceman B. sh i p       C. r i de       D. ch i ldren

 (   )8. A. m y        B. Lil y       C.  y ellow     D.  y our

 (   )9. A. T u esday   B.  u sually    C.  u ncle      D. r u ler

 (   )10. A. w al k      B. h al f       C. t al k       D.  al l 

 二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

  1. eight (序数词) ________ 2. sun (同音词) _________

  3. see (同音词) _________  4. five (序数词) _________

  5. foot (名词复数) _______ 6. Canada (形容词) _______

  7. right (反义词) _________ 8. many (同义词) ________

  9. have (第三人称单数)_____10. leave(现在分词)_____

 三、将下列汉语译成英语:

  1. 乘火车______________________

  2. 每年____________________

  3. 步行回家__________________

  4. 我们学校的学生__________________

  5. 散步的好天气____________________

  6. 骑自行车________________

  7. 离开家____________________

  8. 我们中多少人______________________

  9. 乘公共汽车__________________

  10. 来自加拿大___________________

  11. 喜爱走路_____________________

  12. 去上班_______________________

 四、选择填空:

 (   )1. How many boys ____ in the  class ?

       A. have    B. is there    C. are there    D. has

 (   )2. Would you  like _____ with me this afternoon ?

        A. going shopping      B. to go  shopping

        C. going to shop       D. to go shoping

 (   )3. His father _____ at half past ten  every evening.

        A. goes    B. go     C. going     D. is going

 (   )4. What time _____ every day ?

       A. do you go  to work   B. do you  go to the  work

       C. do you go  working    D. you go to  work

 (   )5. It' s a  fine day ____ a walk.

       A. for      B. at      C. in      D. on

 (   )6. Does she often have bread for  breakfast every day?           Yes , she _____.

        A. has      B. have      C. does      D. do

 (   )7. How ___ your father ___ to work every day ?

        A. is , going             B. is , goes

        C. does , go              D. does , goes

 (   )8. How many birds _____ in the  picture ?

       A. are there can  you see   B. can you  see

       C. is there can  you see      D. have

 (   )9. Where is  Li Lei? He ____ in the  classroom.

       A. does his homework  B. is doing his  homeworks

       C. does his homeworks  D. is doing his  homework

 (   )10. He _____ his lunch  at  school.

         A. doesn' t have        B. don' t have

         C. hasn' t              D. haven' t

 (   )11. How many of _____ come to  school by bike ?

        A. they    B. them    C. students    D. their

 (   )12. Our teacher usually _____ home.

         A. walk    B. walks    C. walks to    D. walk to

 (   )13. Can we  see _____ moon in the  daytime ?

         A. a       B. an      C. the       D. /

 (   )14. I don' t like this dress. Do  you have _____ one ?

        A. an another   B. another   C. others   D. other

 (   )15. Would you  please _____ here ?

         A. to sit    B. sitting    C. sit    D. is sitting

 (   )16. He often comes to  Beijing _____ train.

         A. on      B. in      C. by      D. at

 (   )17. What time _____ she _____ home every day?

         A. is , leaving          B. does , leave

         C. is , leaves          D. do , leave

 (   )18. My friend comes from England. Every year he __            home ___ his parents.

         A. goes , with           B. goes to , with

         C. goes , and            D. goes to , and

 (   )19. It' s seven thirty in  the evening. The  students ___            their homework.

        A. are doing   B. is doing   C. do   D. does

 (   )20. Sometimes he  goes to school _____ foot.

        A. by     B. on    C. in     D. at 

 五、介词填空:

  1. It' s a  fine day ______ a swim.

  2. She goes home every year ______ his parents.

  3. I like to  be ____ foot. But today I  go to school ____        bus.

  4. How many _____ you come from Canada ?

  5. She often helps her  mother _____ housework.

  6. He usually gets up _____ five _____ the morning.

  7. Wher' s your father? He' s _____ work.

  8. My father usually buys food _____ supper _____ his          way home.

 六、句型变化:

  1. I can  see  two  ships in  the picture. (划线提问)

    _____________________________________________

  2. Uncle Wang  is  driving a car . (同上)

    _____________________________________________

  3. His mother usually goes to  work  on  foot . (同上)

    _____________________________________________

  4. He is  doing his homework at  home. (用usually 改写)

    _____________________________________________

  5. There' s some tea  in this glass. (改成一般疑问句)

    _____________________________________________

  6. Look at  the blackboard. (改成否定句)

     ___________________________________________

 七、用所给动词的适当形式填空:

  1. He _________ (not have) his lunch at  school. He ____        (have) it at home.

 2. Tom ________ (like) swimming very much. Look , he          _________ (swim) in the river now.

  3. Let' s ________ (go) to the  shop now.

  4. I' m sorry I _____ (be) late. It __________ (not matter).

  5. Sometimes my  father _______ (go) to work by  car.

  6. ______ he ______ (do) his homework? Yes , he is.

  7. Would you  please ____________(come) with  us to the        room?

  8. Listen , one of  the students ____________ (sing) under        the tree.

  9. How many students in  your class ____________ (ride)        their bikes to  school ?

  10. What ______ you ________ (can see) in the  picture?

 八、改病句(每句只有一处错 , 指出并订正在横线上)

  1. ____  Do  you often  read  books? No, I  usually   see TV.

          A            B                C    D

  2. ____ I want  go   shopping .  Would  you like  to  go  with                    A     B       C             D

          me?

  3. ____ He  often   helps  Uncle Wang  does  housework  on                  A     B                C             D

          Sundays.

  4. ____  Look , there  are  many  woman   over  ther under                 A         B          C     D

          the tree.

  5. ____ It' s  a  fine day   for  a  walking .  That' s  right.

             A          B      C        D

  6. ____  It' s  time  for   go  to  school.  Let' s  go.

          A       B    C           D

  7. ____  Everyday  he  leaves   home   at  about seven thirty.

            A           B     C   D

  8. ____ Mr Green  doesn' t   reading . He   is   writing .

                     A      B        C   D

 九、汉译英(每空只填一个词)

  1. 你通常坐小车上班吗?

     _____ you usually _______ to work _______ car?

  2. Lucy 是美国人, 每年和父母一起回家。

    Lucy _____ _____ the USA. Every year she  goes            home _____ her parents.

  3. 他每天七点半吃早饭。

    He _____ _____ at half past seven _____ morning.

  4. 你是步行还是骑车上学?

     Do you go  to school _____ _____ or _____ _____?

  5. 你母亲是怎么去购物的?

     _____ _____ your mother go  to the shop? On  foot.

  6. 现在十点。该睡觉了。

    It' s ten  now. It' s time _____ _____ to bed.

 十、从A栏中选出B栏的答句 , 填入括号内。

              A

 (   )1. May I  borrow your bike?

 (   )2. It' s a  fine day for  a walk.

 (   )3. How does he  come here?

 (   )4. I' m sorry I' m late. 

 (   )5. How many girls can  you see in  the picture?

 (   )6. Thank you  very much.

 (   )7. What' s he  doing?

 (   )8. What time does he  come here every day?

 (   )9. Are you  on foot or  by bike?

 (   )10. Don' t you  have lunch at  school?

        B

A. That' s all  right.

B. By bike.

C. It doesn' t matter.

D. He' s watching TV.

E. At six  thirty.

F. Yes , I do.

G. Eight.

H. Certainly! Here you  are.

I. That' s right.

J. By car.

 初二英语单元试卷

Ⅰ. 找出一个划线部分的读音不同于其它三个的词.

(   )1. A. paper    B. away    C. page     D. eraser

(   )2. A. broken   B. evening  C. these    D. Chinese

(   )3. A. ship      B. fifth      C. machine D. fridge

(   )4. A. morning  B. forget    C. forty     D. short

(   )5. A. sea       B. leave     C. speak    D. sweater

Ⅱ. 词汇:

   A) 根据句子的意思 , 用适当的词填空.

 1. Sunday is  the first day  of the week. So  Thursday is         the _________ day of the  week.

 2. — ________ do you  usually go to  work ?

   — I  usually walk.

 3. There is  a lot of  bikes over there. _________ second         one is Jim' s.

 4. Please _________ your answer on  the blackboard.

 5. I don' t like this book. Please give me ________.

   B) 根据括号内汉语意思, 完成下列句子.

 1. Morning , Mr Wu!  I see you' re ______ ______(步行)        today ?

 2. Don' t you  usually come to  school ______ ______(骑        自行车) ?

 3. Does she _______ _______ (离开家) at six ?

 4. She goes home ______ ______(每年)with his  parents.

 5. I usually come to  school by bus. ______ ______ (怎         么样) you ?

Ⅲ. 选择填空.

(   )1.There is __“I”and __“u”in the word“ruler”.

       A. a , an    B. a , a     C. an , a    D. an , an

(   )2. Look at _____ sun. How  fine it is !

       A. the       B. a       C. an       D. /

(   )3. Could you  help _____ put the bags in  the car?

       A. our       B. us       C. ours       D. we

(   )4. _____ I walk to  school.

       A. Some time         B. Sometimes  

       C. Some times         D. Sometime

(   )5. They come to  China _____ ship.

       A. on     B. in     C. over      D. by

(   )6. What time do  you usually _____ home?

       A. get    B. get to    C. get up    D. get down

(   )7. Do you  often _____ a book? No , I often ____ TV.

       A. see , look            B. read , look

       C. read , see            D. read , watch

(   )8. How much meat _____ in the  shopping basket ?

       A. is it    B. there is    C. is there   D. are there

(   )9. Does she  have a bike? Yes , she _____.

       A. have       B. has      C. do      D. does 

(   )10. He goes to  the factory _____ his bike.

        A. on      B. by      C. ride      D. over

(   )11. It' s eight. We _____ an English lesson.

        A. have    B. having    C. has    D. are having

(   )12. Can' t you  see a panda ? _____.

        A. Yes , I can' t          B. Yes , I can 

        C. No , I can          D. Not , I can' t

(   )13. My brother isn' t short. He  is _____.

        A. long    B. tall     C. big    D. young

(   )14. _____, I don' t have a  pen.

        A. Excuse me          B. I' m glad

        C. I' m sorry            D. Thanks

(   )15. It' s _____ have supper.

        A. time for   B. time to   C. time  D. the time to

Ⅳ. 按要求改写下列句子.

 1. Mrs King likes milk. (改为一般疑问句)

   _____ Mrs King _____ milk ?

 2. Throw the  frisby like this. (改为否定句)

   _____ _____ the frisby like this.

 3. I can  see two maps on  the wall. (划线提问)

   _____ _____ maps can you  see on the  wall ?

 4. She gets up  at 6 : 30 in  the morning. (同上)

   _____ _____ does she get  up in the  morning ?

 5. They study in  a middle school. (用Jim 作主语改写)

    Jim ______ ______ a middle school.

Ⅴ. 用括号内动词的适当形式填空.

 1. Now let  us __________ (go) by train.

 2. Look , the cat __________ (run) up he  tree.

 3. Listen , who __________ (sing) in the next room ?

 4. He usually __________ (call) me in  the evening.

 5. My mother sometimes __________ (come) to work in          the afternoon.

Ⅵ. 看图写话 , 每空一词.

Look at  the ______. The sun                         is in the  sky (天空). The ______                         is  in  the  sky , too. We  can  see                         two ______ on the sea. Two young                       ______ and their son  are going to                      the ________. They like swimming                       ______ the sea. There ______ a house over there. There are  two ______ behind the house. Look! Eight ______ are ______ in the  sky.

Ⅶ. 完形填空.

Mr Wu  is 1___ teacher of  English. He is 2___ young, but he  is not 3___. He  is tall. 4___ fifty students in  his class. They all  like 5___.

Now it' s four 6___ the afternoon. Look , the students 7__in the  classroom. Mr Wu is  there, too. He 8___ them to study English. He is  a good teacher, 9___ he is  a good friend 10__them all.

(   )1. A. the       B. a        C. an       D. /

(   )2. A. no       B. not a    C. not any  D. not

(   )3. A. old       B. short     C. tall      D. strong

(   )4. A. There are  B. There is  C. Has     D. Have

(   )5. A. they       B. them     C. him     D. he

(   )6. A. of         B. at        C. on      D. in

(   )7. A. are working            B. is working

       C. work                  D. working

(   )8. A. help                   B. helping   

       C. is helping              D. are helping

(   )9. A. but      B. and      C. so      D. or

(   )10. A. in      B. on       C. of      D. at

Ⅷ. 阅读理解.

It is  a fine Saturday morning. My  parents and I  are on a  bus. There are  a lot of  people on it.  Some of them come from America and  England. Some are Canadians and  Australians. They are  all our friends. All  of us are  going to the  Great Wall (长城).

There are  another two Chinese on  the bus. One  is a young man. He  is driving the  bus. The other is  a nice girl. She  is a guide (导游) of our  friends and she  speaks English very well. She is  talking about the  Great Wall with them. I'm listening to  them. I know they all  like the Great Wall and  want to go  there very much. So  we take the  same bus.

 (   )1. — How  is the air  on Saturday morning?

       — It' s ____.

       A. blue   B. dry (干的)  C. very clean   D. nice

(   )2. How many countries (国家) do the people on  the            bus come from ?

       A. Five.     B. Four.      C. Three.      D. Six.

(   )3. — What  are our friends going to  do ?

       — They are  going to _____.

       A. talk with the  girl       B. see the Great Wall

      C. take the  same bus      D. Beijing

(   )4. There is  a _____ guide on the  bus.

       A. boy      B. man     C. American     D. girl

(   )5. The guide can  speak good _____.

       A. English             B. Chinese and English

       C. Chinese            D. Chinese or English

 初二英语 Unit 3 练习卷

一、指出下列各组单词划线部分共有几种发音:

a. 一种读音 b. 两种读音 c. 三种读音 d. 四种读音

(   )1. A. twelfth   B. second   C. very       D. delicious

(   )2. A. any      B. many    C. mooncake  D. than

(   )3. A. heavy    B. breakfast  C. please      D. great

(   )4. A. usually   B. put       C. sun        D. hungry

(   )5. A. young    B. trousers    C. delicious   D. house

二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

 1. hungry (反义词) ________  2. family (复数) ________

 3. day (反义词) ___________  4. ninth (基数词) ______

 5. big (比较级) ___________  6. heavy (最高级) ______

 7. nice (比较级) __________   8. old (最高级) ________

三、用所给动词的适当形式填空:

 1. She ______(read) a picture-book in  the classroom now.

 2. My mother ______ (do) some cooking every day.

 3. There _____ (be) many students in  the park.

 4. My eraser is ______ (new) than his.

 5. This dog  is _______ (hungry) of  all. It eats _______          (much) food.

 6. Tom is  one of ______ (tall) boys in his  class.

四、选择填空:

(   )1. Mid-Autumn Day  usually comes ___ September ___           October.

       A. on , and            B. in , or  

       C. after , and          D. before , after

(   )2. My teacher is  standing ___ the open air ___ our             classroom.

       A. in , near   B. near , near   C. by , by   D. on , in

(   )3. Look! He  has a nice picture. ___ is nicer than ___.

       A. My , him          B. Mine , him

       C. Mine , his         D. He , I

(   )4. In our  class everyone _____ English very much.

       A. like      B. likes     C. is like    D. is liking

(   )5. Would you  like _____ apples ?

       A. to have any         B. have some

        C. having some         D. to have some

(   )6. He would like me ____ him an  English book next           time.

       A. to buy    B. buy     C. buys     D. buying

(   )7. This apple is _____ of all.

       A. redder               B. the redest   

       C. the reddest           D. reddest

(   )8. My mother gets up _____ than my  father every              morning.

五、看图填空:

 1. Tom' s box  is ______ than Jim' s. Jack box  is               ______than Jim' s. ______ box is  the heaviest.

 2. The first ruler is ______ than the  second one.

   The third ruler is ______ than the  second one.

   The first ruler is ______ ______ of all.

 3. The maths (数学) book is ______ than the  En-

   glish book. The Chinese book is _____than the 

   maths book. The  Chinese book is _____ _____

   ______ all.

 4. The apple is ______ than the  egg. The banana 

   is _______ than the  egg. The apple is _______

  _____ of all.

 初二英语Unit 4 练习卷

一、指出划线部分的发音与所给单词相同的一个:

(   )1. full  A. blue   B. ruler    C. put      D. but

(   )2. food A. foot    B. moon   C. goodbye  D. book

(   )3. month A. nothing  B. second  C. shop  D. long

(   )4. bell    A. these  B. when  C. delicious  D. machine

二、选择填空:

(   )1. The boys are  going to play ___basketball tomorrow           afternoon.

       A. the      B. a      C. /       D. an

(   )2. Wei Hua  is going to  get some banana ____ Lucy.

       A. to       B. for       C. in      D. on

(   )3. It' s time ____ go to  school.

       A. for      B. to      C. for us      D. to me

(   )4. It' s too  cold (冷的). Put ____, please!

       A. your coat in         B. your coat odd

       C. on your coat         D. off your coat

(   )5. Li Tao' s English is ____ than Li  Ping' s.

       A. much better           B. a little good

       C. very better            D. a little best

(   )6. There is  only _____ water in the  glass.

       A. a few     B. few     C. little    D. a little

(   )7. What are  you going to  do ____ next week ?

       A. in      B. on     C. /      D. of

(   )8. — Why  don' t you come with me?  — ____.

       A. Sure                 B. Certainly

       C. That' s a good idea    D. Oh , hi

三、句子转换:

 1. Why don' t you  come with us?

    ______ ______ ______ with us ?

 2. This ruler is  long. That ruler is  quite long.

    That ruler is ______ ______ this one.

 3. Jim is  seven. Tom is  ten. Peter is  twelve.

   Jim is ______ than Tom. Peter is ______ than Tom.         Jim is _____ _____ of the  three. Peter is _____ _____        of the three.

四、用所给动词的适当形式填空:

 1. Jim often _________ (have) a swim in  the morning.

 2. She ________ (not like) English.

 3. I _________ (make) a paper plane next week.

 4. It _____ (be) seven now. Mike and  Joan __________         (have) breakfast.

 初二英语单元测试卷(Unit 1 ~ 3)

一、语音

   指出划线部分的读音与所给单词相同的一个: 10%

(  )1. usually   A. television B. those  C. yours   D. skirt

(  )2. walk     A. wash     B. water   C. what   D. watch

(  )3. moon    A. book     B. look   C. floor   D. do

(  )4. long      A. night     B. hungry C. autumn D. kind

(  )5. parent    A. hair      B. farm    C. carry   D. car

(  )6. glass     A. sure      B. English  C. excuse  D. bus

(  )7. autumn   A. Australia            B. daughter 

               C. blouse              D. about

(  )8. than      A. eighth               B. twelfth

               C. another              D. thank

(  )9. delicious  A. policeman  B. fine  C. driver  D. frisby

(  )10. sun      A. student     B. full   C. must   D. put二、词汇

A) 找出适当的字母或字母组合, 使单词完整、正确:

(  )1. Th __ sday   A.  or    B. er     C. ur    D. ea  8%

(  )2. ei __ h       A. gh    B. ght   C. pht    D. ph

(  )3. blackb __ d   A. or     B. ur    C. ar     D. oar

(  )4. O __ ber      A. to     B. toc    C. cto    D. tou

(  )5. f __ th        A. or     B. our    C. ou    D. ur

(  )6. pion __    A. ier     B. eir    C. eer    D. ior

(  )7. r __ d      A. ou    B. oun   C. own   D. aun

(  )8. __ dle       A. med   B. mi    C. mid   D. me 

B) 按要求写出下列单词的相应形式: 10%

1. tall (反义词) _________  2. three (序数词) _________

3. foot (复数) ___________  4. shop (现在分词) _______

5. hungry (比较级) _______  6. nine (序数词) _________

7. good (比较级) _________  8. big (最高级) __________

9. sun (同音词) __________  10. lesson (同义词) _______

C) 将下列汉语译成英语: 5%

1. 下次_________________ 2. 这学期_______________

3. 看上去一样___________ 4. 点名_________________

5. 呆在户外_____________

三、选择填空:25%

(  )1. There are ____ on the  table.

      A. a piece of  paper      B. a piece of  papers

      C. two pieces of  paper    D. two pieces of  papers

(  )2. How does Jim  go to school every day ? ____ foot.

       A. On      B. on      C. By      D. by

(  )3. I have your names ____ this piece of  paper.

      A. in       B. on      C. at       D. of

(  )4. Look! Who ____ basketball over there?

      A. are playing  B. is playing  C. playing  D. play

(  )5. Welcome back ____ school , boys and  girls.

       A. at      B. in      C. to       D. on

(  )6. I' m sorry ____.

      A. to late    B. of late    C. I late    D. I' m late

(  )7. This is  Lesson One , ____.

       A. First lesson            B. the first lesson    

       B. first lesson            D. lesson first

(  )8. “____ do you  call these cakes ?”

      “We call them mooncakes.”

       A. Why     B. How     C. What     D. When

(  )9. The classroom ___ three doors and  many windows.

      A. there is    B. there are    C. have    D. has

(  )10. He is  going to help me ____ my English.

        A. to      B. with     C. at      D. on

(  )11. He is ____ in the  class.

        A. young  B. younger   C. the youngest   D. older

(  )12. His English is  the best ____ the three.

        A. of       B. in      C. than       D. all

(  )13. This ruler is ____ than that one.

        A. short             B. much shorter

        C. much short        D. more shorter

(  )14. I' d like you ____ an English song.

        A. singing us         B. to sing us

       C. singing our        D. to sing our

(  )15. My pencil is  longer than ____.

        A. him    B. Lily   C. Lily' s    D. our

(  )16. He will be  back ___ school ___ tomorrow  morning.

        A. to , on    B. at , in    C. to , in    D. at , /

(  )17. It' s a  fine day ____ a walk.

       A. for      B. at      C. in      D. on

(  )18. How ____ your father ____ to work every day.

       A. is , going             B. is , goes   

       C. does , go              D. does , goes

(  )19. Can we  see ____ moon in the  daytime ?

       A. a       B. an      C. the      D. /

(  )20. Our teacher usually ____ home.

        A. walk    B. walks    C. walks to    D. walk to

(  )21. People eat  mooncakes ____ Mid-Autumn  Day.

        A. on       B. in       C. at       D. /

(  )22. I like the  mooncakes ____ eggs ____ them.

       A. has , in      B. with , in      C. have , with

(  )23. We don' t like to  go out ____.

        A. at the night           B. at night

        C. in the night           D. in night

(  )24. Everyone in  Chine ____ eating mooncakes.

        A. like    B. likes    C. is liking    D. is likes

(  )25. What' s  the English ____ Zhong Qiu  Jie?

        A. ou      B. in      C. for     D. with

四、句型转换:16%

1. Marry wants to  go shopping. (划线提问)

_______________________________________________

2. I usually go  to school by bus. (同上)

_______________________________________________

3. Peter listens to  the radio. (改为现在进行时)

_______________________________________________

4. He is  answering the teacher' s questions. (划线提问)

_______________________________________________

5. Please call me  Lily. (改成否定句)

_______________________________________________

6. Kate usually has lunch at  school. (划线提问)

_______________________________________________

7. The girl in red is  Tom' s sister. (同上)

_______________________________________________

8. She does housework every day. (改成一般疑问句)

_______________________________________________

五、根据下列句子的内容,按顺序整理成对话:8%

A. May I  have a look at  it ?

B. Ah , you' re reading the  newspapers.

C. Thank you.     

D. Yes , there' s a funny (有趣的) story.

E. Oh , I' m not  doing anything. Is  there something              interesting in the  newspaper ?

F. You' re welcome.

G. Yes , I am.  What are you  doing ?

H. Certainly. Here you  are.

  1. (   )2. (   )3. (   )4. (   )5. (   )6. (   )7. (   )8. (   )

六、完形填空:15%

It is  1___ o' clock. The children 2___ to school by  car every day , 3___ today they are  going to school on  4___.

It is  ten o' clock. Mrs  Sawyer usually 5___ at home in  the morning , but today she  is going to  6___.

It is  four o' clock. In  the afternoon Mr  Sawyer 7___ tea 8___ the living room. but  this afternoon she  is drinking 9___in the  garden.

It is  six o' clock , In the  evening , the children usually do  their 10___ , but 11___ they 12 ___ in the  garden.

It is  nine o' clock Mr  Sawyer usually 13__ his newspaper at  night. But he  14___ his newspaper tonight. At  the moment , he is  reading 15___ interesting book.

(  )1. A. at eight   B. in eight   C. eight    D. the eight

(  )2. A. go        B. goes       C. si going  D. are going

(  )3. A. and       B. but        C. or       D. so

(  )4. A. feet       B. their foot  C. foot      D. the foot

(  )5. A. lives       B. live        C. stays     D. stay

(  )6. A. the shops  B. shop       C. shopping D. shops

(  )7. A. drink usually             B. usually drink

      C. drinks usually            D. usually drinks

(  )8. A. at         B. on         C. in        D. of

(  )9. A. a tea      B. tea         C. teas       D. the tea

(  )10. A. homework              B. homeworks

       C. the homework          D. the homeworks

(  )11. A. in this evening          B. at this evening

       C. this evening            D. on the evening

(  )12. A. play    B. are playing   C. are play    D. plays

(  )13. A. sees    B. reads         C. looks       D. watch

(  )14. A. doesn' t read            B. doesn' t look

       C. isn' t reading            D. isn' t looking

(  )15. A. an      B. a      C. the      D. /

七、用动词的适当形式填空:3%

1. Li Lei  usually ___________ (watch) TV  on Saturday          evening.

2. My father ___________ (work) at 6 : 30 every day.

3. Listen , one of  the students ___________ (sing) under         the tree.

 

 初二英语期中练习卷(Unit1--7)

 一. 找出一个划线部分读音不同于其它三个的词:5%

 (  )1. A. pion eer    B. h ear       C. h air    D. y ear 

 (  )2. A.  ch icken    B. ma ch ine   C. ch eap   D. rea ch 

 (  )3. A.  th ird       B.  th row      C. wi th    D. mon th

 (  )4. A. w al l       B. sm al l      C. t al l    D.  al so

 (  )5. A. min u t      B. b u s        C. c u p    D. h u ngry

 二.词汇:10%

 A. 根据句子的意思, 用适当的词填空:5%

 1. We hare three m______ in  a day .

 2. It can  be d_______ to  climb trees.

 3. There are  many a_____ in  the Zoo.

 4. The apples are  too high and  they are hard to  r_____.

 5. W______ is  the third day  of a  week.

 B. 根据汉语意思 , 有词组的适当形式填空 (每空一          词)5%

 1. Look! The  children are ____  _____ _____ _____ (玩      得很高兴) in the  park.

 2. Jim ____ _____ _____ (善于) English.

 3. Monkeys are  jumping and running _____  _____ ____       (一直)

 三. 选择题:20%

 (  )1._____ first girl is  ____ shortest of  all.

    A. A, the      B. The, the    C. the , a   D. A ,× 

 (  )2. It's time _____ supper now.

    A. for       B. to have      C. with     D. to

 (  )3.Would you  like to come? ______

      A. I like              B. Yes , I'd love to

      C. No , I don't        D. Yes, thanks

 (  )4. There are  ______ people in  the USA than in               China.

      A. many      B. much     C. few      D. fewer

 (  )5. Let's go  and ______ the  pandas .

      A. look      B. lood at     C. see     D. have a look     (  )6. Linda is  better _____ English than Jim.

      A. at        B. on       C. in       D. with

 (  )7. I'm  going  to  help  you ____ your  homework___          ___ evening.

       A. in  at   B. with on  C. with  this   D. with in

 (  )8._______ troursers  are  longer than ______

      A. My  your       B. Mine   yours 

      C. Mine    your     D. My  yours

 (  )9. Let's ______ half  past six.

      A. make it         B. make   at

      C. make it at       D. make

 (  )10. Please  give me  ______ paper.

       A. A piece big  of      B. a piece of  big

       C. a big piece         D. a big piece of

 (  )11.They have ______ homework to  do.

       A. many   quite       B. a  lot quite

       C. quite   many       D. quite a lot  of 

 (  )12. --_____ is  the  farm form our  school?

        --- About  three   kilometres.

       A. How   long      B. How   far 

       C. How  much     D. How many

 (  )13. They are  going to play ___  football tomorrow.

       A. a     B. an      C. the     D. /

 (  )14. Give me  ______,  please.

       A. a few paper        B. a little  tea  

       C. a  few bread        D. a little  apples

 (  )15. The  Greens  _______ having lunch.

       A. is     B. do     C./      D. are

 (  )16. I hear  one of  the students ____ from England

       A. come  B. comes   C. is  coming   D.are coming

 (  )17. Please come to  school _____ earlier.

        A. a little    B. a few    C. some     D. little

 (  )18. I _______ a  basketball tomorrow.

       A. go to  watch       B. am going to  see

       C. go to see         D. am going to  watch

 (  )19. It's cold (冷) outside. ______more clothes

       A. Wear      B. Put on    C. take off   D. Have

 (  )20. ______ delicious the  apples are !

      A. How     B. What    C. How  a    D. What  a

 四. 改写句子:9%

 1. Why don't you  go with your mothte. (改为同义句)

    Why _____  _____ with your mother?

 2. Ann is  younger than Bill. (改为同义句)

   Bill is  _____  _____  Ann.

 3. It's  eight kilometres  from here to  my school. ( 划线提问)

   _______  ______ is it  from here to  your school.

 4. There is  a knife on  the table .(改为复数)

   There _____ _____ _____ on  the table.

 5. We are  going to meet  outside the  school gate . (同3 )

   ______ ______ you  going to meet?

 6.  We are going to  come back  at  eleven . (同3)

   ______ _______ are  you going to  come back?

 7.  They have no  classes on Saturday. (同义替换)

    They ______ have _____ classes on  saturday.

 8. Put on  your shoes, Please. (否定祈使句)

   ______ put on  your shoes , please.

 9.  This lesson is  very easy. (改为感叹句)

   ______  ______ the lesson is  !

 五. 口语应用. (10%)

 1. -- You speak English  very  well.

   --- _____________________________

    A. No, I don't think   B. No, my English isn't good

    C. Thank you        D. You speak  better than I.

 2. --- Shall we  go and see  the elephant?

   --- _________________________________

    A. let's go to  see the panda.

    B. no , let's go and  see the panda.

    C. No,  I can't go        D. Yes , I  can  go

 3. --- Give me  some paper , please.

   ---- _________________________

    A. Give  you         B. No, I can't

    C. Here  you are      D. Yes , please

 4. —  May I borrow your pen ?

   ---- _______________________

   A. sorry, it's brken      B. You  can't

   C. No, you mustn't   D. You are  welcome.

 5.--- We're going to  watch a football game (比赛).

     Why not go  with us?

  --- ___________________

   A. that's  a good idea      B. Good ideas

   C. I can  go               D. thank you

 六. 用所给动词的正确形式填空: (10%)

  1. I want ______ ______ (go) to the  shop with you.

 2. Sometimes my  partents ________ (watch) TV  on              Saturday evening.

  3. There _____ (be) a football match (比赛) this evening.

  4. They ______ ______ (work) hard on the  farm.

  5. The twins _____ _____ _____ _____ (play) basketball          next Sunday.

  6. We' d like you _____ _____ (pick) the apples with us.

  7. Let Mary _______ (have) a good time.

  8. He likes _______(swim) best in  Summer (夏天) .

  9. Why not _______ (ask) that policeman.

  10. The boy _____ _____ (not watch) TV every evening.

 七. 看图填词: 11%

  1.                          2.

  

   _____ _____ _____ _____       three _____ of _____

  3.

   

   The ______ looks ______ ______ duck

  4.

   

    

 

    Li Ming is  good at _______

  5.

    

    LiLy is  good at _______

 八. 完型填空: (10%)

 1___  Sunday today. There are  a lot of  people 2___ the park. 3___! Some students are  boating on the  lake (湖). Six boys 4___ a game. 5___ old man  is walking 6___ the garden(花园) . There are some 7___ over there. They are  8___ kites. Some young people are  reading 9___ the tree. All  of 10___ are having a  good time.

 (  )1. A. This' s    B. That' s     C. It      D. It' s

 (  )2. A. in        B. on         C. to      D. with

 (   )3. A. See       B. Watch     C. Look   D. Look at

 (  )4. A. are play   B. are playing C. to play D. are to  play     (  )5. A. a         B. the        C. An     D. /

 (  )6. A. around    B. of         C. for     D. with

 (  )7. A. child      B. children    C. student  D. boy

 (  )8. A. fly        B. flies        C. flying    D. to fly

 (  )9. A. under      B. on         C. of       D. for

 (  )10. A. they      B. them       C. theirr    D. theirs

 九. 阅读理解(10%)

 (A)

 Dear  Lucy ,

 I' m  in Beijing now. I  will spend (度过) the next years here. I' m in  No. 6 Middle School. It' s a  good school. The  people thered are  very friendly. My  best friend is  Wei Hua and  my favourite (爱好) is roast Beijing duck (北京烤鸭).

 Now  I' m writing to  you in my  bed room. We  have a new  home here in  China. It' s different from our  old home in  New  York. Our  new house is  white , and the old  one is red. The  walls of my  bedroom are blue. My  mother is watering some flowers. My  father is mending a  car. I' m going to  do my homework. Please write back soon.

                                        Love from

 Sam

 (  )1. What school is  Sam in ? _____.

       A. No. 5 Middle School   B. No. 6  Middle School

       C. No. 7 Middle School   D. No. 1 Middle School     (  )2. Who' s Sam' s best friend in  China ? _____.

       A. Li Lei    B. Lucy   C. Jim   D. Wei Hua

 (  )3. What colour are  the walls of  Sam' s bedroom? ___.           A. Red    B. White   C. Blue    D. Green

 (  )4. What' s Sam' s father doing ? _____.

       A. Mending a plane     B. Watering some flowers

       C. Mending a car       D. Teaching English

 (  )5. Where' s Sam  from ? _____.

       A. England    B. Australia    C. America    D. Japan

 (B)

 Mary  has four cousins (堂、表兄弟/姐妹). They are  Betty , Peter , Bill  and Ann. Mary is  the oldest of  the five. Betty  is  thirteen years old. She' s two  years  younger than Mary and  one year oler than Peter. Bill is  nine and Ann , the youngest , is seven years old.

 Both  Betty and Peter like running. They can  run very fast. Peter is  one  of the  fastest boys in  his class. Mary and  Betty like swimming. Mary swims much faster that Betty.

 Mary  and Betty study in  a middle school. Peter , Bill and  Ann are in  Primary school. They don' t often work hard , but  Betty does. She  works the hardeest.

 (  )1. How mary people are  there in this passage (短文)?

       A. Five    B. Four    C. three     D. six

 (  )2. How old  is Mary ?   She is _____ old.

       A. thirteen years         B. two years

       C. eleven years          D. fifteen years

 (  )3. Bill is _____ younger than Peter.

       A. two years            B. three years

       C. one years            D. we don' t know

 (  )4. _____ like running.

       A. Betty                B. Mary and Peter

       C. Betty and Peter       D. Peter

 (  )5. “A primary school”means (意思是) _____.

       A. 中学    B. 初中    C. 幼儿园    D. 小学

 十. 改病句. 5%

 (  )1. We   are going to  the park  with  Kate  on   next  Friday.

               A              B        C   D

 (  )2. Would you  like to have any  bananas ?

         A        B     C     D

 (  )3. There  are  many bikes  over  there .  One  of them   are  broken.

              A                B           C       D

 (  )4. He  usually   walks   to  home   on  foot .

            A      B      C       D

 (  )5.  Can  you  come  back   a  little   earliest  this evening ?

        A           B      C       D

 初二英语听力训练与测试 Unit 1 ~ 2

 一、 听句子, 选择你所听到的正确的单词 (每小题念一遍)

 (   )1. A. red      B. twelve    C. dress    D. read

 (   )2. A. say      B. stay       C. may     D. way

 (   )3. A. wall     B. small      C. talk      D. call

 (   )4. A. bag      B. bed       C. black    D. back

 (   )5. A. first      B. third      C. shirt      D. skirt

 二、听句子, 选择正确的答案: (每小题念一遍)

 (   )1. I think the  shop is _____.

       A. open    B. clean     C. closed    D. big

 (   )2. We don' t have _____ lessons on  Saturday morning.

        A. two     B. six     C. three     D. four

 (   )3. Li Lin  is helping Lucy with her _____.

        A. Chinese    B. English    C. French    D. German

 (   )4. Look at _____. How  nice it is !

        A. the blue sea           B. the blackboard

        C. the red house          D. the white flower

 (   )5. May I  ahve _____, please ?  Certainly.

       A. a bottle of  orange       B. a cup of  tea

       C. a piece of  paper         D. two pieces of  bread

 三、听对话, 选择正确的答案: (对话念两遍)

 (   )1. A. It' s the  last day of  this term today.

       B. It' s the first day  of this term today.

       C. It' s the first Sunday of  this term today.

       D. It' s the third Monday of  this term today.

 (   )2. A. Yes , he is.           B. No , they aren' t.

       C. No , not everyone.    D. Yes , they are.

 (   )3. A. Mr Gao.             B. Mr Wu.

       C. Miss Chen.            D. Mrs Wu.

 (   )4. A. English.   B. French.   C. Chinese.   D. Russian.

 (   )5. A. She likes it  a little.

       B. She likes it  very much.

       C. She doesn' t like it  at all.

       D. Sorry , I don' t know.

 四、听录音, 选择意思相似的句子: (每句念两遍)

 (   )1. A. There is  little food on  the table.

       B. There is not  much food on  the table.

       C. There is too  much food on  the table.

       D. There is much food on  the table.

 (   )2. A. Do you  go to work by  bus every day ?

       B. Do you go  to work by  car every day ?

       C. Do you walk to  work every day ?

       D. Do you go  to work by  bike every day ?

 (   )3. A. My father is  at home at  six every morning.

       B. My father is  at work at  six every morning.

       C. My father goes home at  six every morning.

        D. My father comes back home at  six every morning.

 (   )4. A. Lucy is  helping them with their French.

       B. Lucy is helping them to  study English.

       C. Lucy is helping him  to study English.

       D. Lucy is helping them with their Chinese.

 (   )5. A. All right.             B. No.  

       C. Not at all.            D. It doesn' t matter.

 (   )6. A. Lily is  from France. 

       B. Lily comes from England.

       C. Lily comes from Japan.

       D. Lily is  from Australia.

 初二英语听力训练与测试 Unit 1~7

 一、 听句子, 选择你所听到的正确的单词 (每小题念一遍)

 (   )1. A. walk      B. talk      C. wall      D. small

 (   )2. A. hers       B. work    C. shirt      D. girl

 (   )3. A. watch     B. water     C. walk     D. also

 (   )4. A. blue       B. broom    C. soon     D. food

 (   )5. A. bus        B. nut       C. but      D. last

 二、听录音, 选择意思相似的句子: (每组念两遍)

 (   )1. A. This pen  is longer than that one.

       B. This pen is  heavier than that one.

       C. This pen is  cheaper than that one.

       D. This pen is  newer than that one.

 (   )2. A. Jim goes to  work at a  quarter past eight.

       B. Jim goes to  work at a  quarter to eight.

       C. Jim goes to  school at a  quarter past eight.

       D. Jim goes to  school at a  quarter to eight.

 (   )3. A. Li Ping is  doing his homework.

       B. Li Ping is  doing some reading.

       C. Li Ping is  doing some cleaning.

       D. Li Ping is  doing some washing.

 (  )4. A. My brother usually takes a  bus to work , but                  sometimes he  walks.

        B. My sister usually walks to  work.

        C. My brother usually rides a  bike to work.

        D. My sister usually takes a  bus to school.

 (   )5. A. They are  going to Shanghai  at  seven thirty.

       B. They are going to  meet at seven thirteen.

       C. They are going to  meet at the  school gate.

       D. They are going to  stay there.

 三、听对话, 选择正确的答案: (对话念两遍)

 (   )1. Jim is  going to bed ___ because he  is going to ___           tomorrow.

        A. early / play  basketball    B. early / work on a  farm

        C. late / have a rest        D. late / stop the work

 (   )2. Jim and  his friends are  going to _____.

       A. help some farmers clean the  houses

       B. help some farmers learn English

       C. help some farmers pick oranges

       D. help some farmers pick apples

 (   )3. _____ asks Jim  to let her  go with him.

       A. Jim' s friend , Kate      B. Jim' s younger brother

       B. Jim' s younger sister    D. Jim' s mother

 (   )4. Jim' s younger sister ___ help him  with the apple pick.

       A. can     B. can' t      C. does      D. doesn' t

 (   )5. At last Jim  is going to _____.

        A. let her go  with him    B. let him stay at  home

        C. tell Mother about it    D. play a game with her

 四、听短文, 选择正确的答案: (短文念两遍)

 (   )1. A. England.   B. America.  C. Australia.  D. Canada.

 (   )2. A. Ten.       B. Eleven.    C. Twelve.   D. Twenty.

 (   )3. A. Blue.      B. Red.       C. Green.    D. Black.

 (   )4. A. His father.              B. His mother.

       C. His teacher.             D. Polly.

 (   )5. A. A lot.                  B. A lot of.

       B. Few.                   D. A little.

 初二英语第十二单元练习

 一、指出与所给单词划线部分发音相同的一个单词:

 (   )1. f or get  A. w or se  B. sp or t     C. doct or   D. p or ridge

 (   )2. f oo d   A. n oo dle  B. b oo kshop C. c oo k    D. f u ll

 (   )3. J a nuary A. d a te    B.  a nimal   C. veget a ble D. t a ble

 (   )4.  u ncle   A.  u sually  B. J u ne     C. p u zzle   D. J u ly

 (   )5. t i ger    A. n i nth   B. g i ve      C. l i ve      D. l i ft

 (   )6. st ay     A. m ay                B. weekd ay 

              C. Saturd ay            D. yesterd ay

 (   )7. M ar ch  A. qu ar ter  B. st ar t     C. dr aw    D.  au tumn

 (    )8. c o ld     A. ag o      B. p or ridge C.  O ctober D. sec o nd

 (   )9. F e bruary A. n e ver              B. veg e table

               C. chick e n             D. r e member

 (   )10. r ea d    A. id ea     B. s ea      C. gr ea t     D. h ea d

 二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

  1. stop (过去式)_________ 2. dumping (名词复数)_____

  3. cold (比较级)_________ 4. has (现在分词)__________

  5. forget (反义词)________ 6. half (复数形式)_________

  7. after (反义词)_________ 8. thirty (序数词)__________

  9. before (同义词)________ 10. carry (过去式)_________

 三、将下列汉语译成英语:

  1. 开家长会______________________

  2. 早餐吃稀饭____________________

  3. 几天前_________________________

  4. 下课后_________________________

  5. 最喜欢的食物___________________

  6. 放学后踢足球___________________

  7. 有点冷__________________________

  8. 三点钟之前______________________

  9. 在十二月三日____________________

  10. 练习本_________________________

 四、选择填空:

 (   )1. —What' s the  date today?  —_____.

        A. It' s Monday            B. It' s Wednesday

        C. It' s on September 2     D. It' s October 1

 (   )2. What _____ you _____ for lunch yesterday?

        A. do , have          B. did , having

        C. did , have          D. did , to have

 (   )3. We started this lesson _____.

       A. three days before       B. three days after

       C. before three days       D. three days ago

 (   )4. There are  sixty minutes in _____ hour.

        A. a      B. an      C. the      D. this

 (   )5. —Did you  have your lunch at  twelve?  —_____.

       A. Yes , I had     B. I had my  lunch at eleven

       C. No , I didn' t   D. No , I hadn' t

 (   )6. Would you  like _____?

        A. some noodles            B. any noodles

        C. some noodle             D. any noodle

 (   )7. Sunday is _____ day in  a week.

        A. the first          B. the last

        C. the second        D. best

 (   )8. They _____ a meeting this evening.

        A. have not            B. don' t have

        C. have no            D. not have

 (   )9. When _____ you _____ home yesterday?

        A. did , get to          B. do , get

        C. were , get         D. did , get

 (   )10. —Did you  have lunch at  school or at  home today?

        —_____.

         A. I have  it at  home    B. Yes , I had it  at home             C. No , I didn' t          D. I had it  at school

 (   )11. My father __ here yesterday , but he __ back today.

         A. isn' t , is              B. didn' t , is

         C. wasn' t , is            D. weren' t , was

 (   )12. _____ out of  the window in  class.

        A. Don' t to look          B. Do not look

        C. Please not look         D. Don' t look

 (   )13. What _____ you _____ after breakfast every day?

         A. do , do            B. did , do

        C. were , do          D. are , doing

 (   )14. Which is  your _____?

         A. favourite month         B. favourite months

         C. best favourite month     D. favourite monthes

 (   )15. _____ you _____ to see him  last Monday?

        A. Did , went          B. Did , go

        C. Were , go           D. Do , go

 (   )16. —_____ did you  see him?  —About a  week ago.

        A. How long           B. How often   

        C. When               D. How

 (   )17. We are  going ___ two Chinese lessons next week.

         A. to have     B. to be    C. have     D. having

 (   )18. I' m hungry. Please _____ me something to  eat.

        A. to bring     B. to take    C. bring    D. take

 (   )19. There aren' t many apples on  the tree, but you  can            pick _____.

        A. a few    B. a little    C. much     D. many

 (   )20. There are _____ days in  a year.

        A. three hundreds and  sixty-five

        B. three hundreds sixty-five

        C. three hundred and  sixty-five

        D. three hundred sixty-five

 五、根据句意,填入适当的词:

  1. There are  twenty-four ________ in a day.

  2. November comes before ______ and after ______.

  3. June 1st  is _______ Day.

  4. I was  in England three years _______.

  5. _______ is the  last day of  a week.

  6. What was  the date the  day _______ yesterday?

  7. It' s much colder today _______ yesterday?

  8. I met  my friend on  my _______ to school.

 六、按要求变换下列句型:

  1. I like May  the  best. (同义替换)

    May is  my ______ ______.

  2. Taking a  short rest after lunch is  good for our  health. (同上)

    It' s good for  our health _____ _____ a short rest after lunch.

  3. August comes after July. (同上)

    July comes _______ _______.

  4. They had  a class meeting  after class . (划线提问)

    ______________________________________________

  5. He bought some fruit this morning. (改一般疑问句)

    ______________________________________________

  6. Sam had  bread and  rice for breakfast this morning.(同4)

    _____________________________________________

  7. It' s June 2nd  today. (用yesterday 改写)

    ______________________________________________

  8. They are  having a good time now. (用last week 改写)

    ______________________________________________

 七、用所给动词的适当形式填空:

  1. When ____ you usually ______ (start) your meeting in  the morning?

  2. How many classes _____ you _____ (have) last week?

  3. —____ you ____ (do) eye exercises yesterday?

    —Yes. I ____.

  4. There _____ (be) a football game last Friday.

    There __________ (be) another football game next week.

  5. I ________ (not do) my homework yesterday because I _____ (be) ill bed.

  6. —____ he ____ (do) his homework at  home yesterday evening?

    —Yes. He  always _____ his  homework at home.

  7. Mr Green ______ (come) to China two  weeks ago. And  he ______________ (stay) here  for two years.

  8. Bill _______ (go) to school on  foot yesterday. His  bike ____ (be) broken.

 八、阅读理解:

One  day a monkey looked through the  window of our  classroom. It was  very hungry and  wanted to find something to  eat. First it  looked in the  cupboard (碗橱) but there was  nothing there. Then Miss Tan , out teacher came in.  She didn' t see  the monkey and  she began to  write on the  blackboard. The monkey opened Miss Tan' s desk and  found an apple. And  it began to  eat it. After it  finish the apple , he jumped on  to John' s knee (膝盖) and looked at  John' s book , When Miss Tan  asked a question , the monkey put  its hand up!  Miss Tan was  very surprise (惊讶) and the children laughed (笑). The  monkey jumped out  of the window.

(   )1. The Monkey jumped into the  classroom because _____.

       A. it wanted to  answer Miss Tan' s questions.

       B. it wanted to  look for an  apple.

       C. it wanted to  play with John.

       D. it wanted to  look for  something to eat.

(   )2. The Monkey found an  apple _____.

       A. in John' s desk           B. on John' s knee

       C. in Miss Tan' s desk       D. on Miss' s desk

(   )3. There was _____ in John' s desk.

       A. not anything            B. a lot of  books

       C. many apples            d. Jon' s school bag

(   )4. _____ answered Miss Tan' s question.

      A. John    B. the monkey    C. Nobody   D. all the students

(   )5. Which of  the following is  true?

       A. The monkey jumped away at last (最后) .

       B. The monkey didn' t leave the  classroom at last.

       C. The monkey passed the  apples from one  student to another.

       D. All the students listened to  Miss Tan very carefully (认真地).

初二英语第十三单元练习卷

一、指出下列各组单词划线部分共有几种发音:

A:一种    B:两种    C:三种    D:四种

       A           B          C          D

(   )1. because      aunt        score       before

(   )2. bought       touch        found       delicious

(   )3. France       ago         date        January

(   )4. quick        quarter       question     quite

(   )5. enjoy        went         often        when

(   )6. move        second       November   popular

(   )7. mean        meant        cleaner      idea

(   )8. always       usually       yesterday    wasn' t

(   )9. finished      watched       wanted      stayed

(   )10. write        wrong          rest         when     

二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式

  1. get (过去式)_____________ 2. stay (过去式)_____________

  3. France (形容词)__________  4. quick (副词)_____________

  5. reach (现在分词)__________ 6. will (过去式)____________

  7. did (原形动词)____________ 8. English (国家名称)_______

  9. less (反义词)_____________ 10. need (过去式)___________

三、将下列汉语译成英语:

  1. 保持忙碌________________________

  2. 在上学的路上_____________________

  3. 搬到北京_________________________

  4. 住在法国_________________________

  5. 在十点半之前_____________________

 6. 这个问题的答案___________________

  7. 休息一会儿_______________________

  8. 两玻璃杯水_______________________

  9. 煮晚饭___________________________

  10. 一整天__________________________

四、选择填空:

(   )1. —What' s the  date today?  —_____.

       A. April the twenty-third    B. April the twenty-three

       C. April the twenty third   D. April the  twenty three

(   )2. The boy  stayed here _____ yesterday.

       A. all day   B. all the  days    C. all days   D. a day

(   )3. —_____ do you  come to China?

       —Because  the people here are  very friendly.

       A. Why      B. How      C. What time      D. When

(   )4. —How long did  you play football yesterday?  —_____.

       A. Never                      B. Always

       C. More than two  hours         D. Sometimes

(   )5. My mother usually has _____ rest after lunch.

       A. a few    B. a little     C. little    D. few6.

(   )6. The little girl ran  to me _____.

       A. quickly     B. quick      C. quite      D. quitely

(   )7. Does your grandpa _____ with you?

       A. enjoy to live           B. enjoyed living

       C. enjoy living            D. enjoying living

(   )8. Please give me _____.

       A. two glass of  teas       B. two glasses of  teas

       C. two glasses tea         D. two glasses of  tea

(   )9. She often helps her  mother _____.

       A. do housework          B. do houseworks

       C. does housework         D. does houseworks

(   )10. They stayed in  the room for _____.

        A. half an hour           B. half hour

        C. half of an  hour        D. half hours

(   )11. —Who taught you  English last term?  —_____.

        A. Mr Wu is            B. Mr Wu was

        C. Mr Wu does          D. Mr Wu did

(   )12. There is _____“m”in the  word“number”.

        A. a      B. an      C. the     D. /

(   )13. We are  going to _____ a busy day  tomorrow.

        A. have     B. take     C. be     D. having

(   )14. He often buys food for  supper _____.

        A. on one' s way  home     B. on him way  home

        C. on his way  to home    D. on his way  home

(   )15. —Shall we  have a short rest?  —_____.

       A. Yes , you shall        B. Yes , we do

       C. That' s right          D. That' s a good idea

(   )16. _____ me an  English book , please.

       A. Bring     B. Take     C. Carry     D. Borrow

(   )17. _____ you _____ to work by  bus last week?

        A. Do , go    B. Did , went    C. Did , goes   D. Did , go

(   )18. —What day  is today?  —_____.

        A. It' s July 1 , 1995          B. It' s a fine day  today

        C. It' s a fine day  for a walk  D. It' s Wednesday

(   )19. Who is  going to _____ at the  meeting?

        A. speak     B. say    C. talk     D. tell

(   )20. —Is Peter better than yesterday? 

       —No , he  is a little _____.

        A. bad      B. best      C. worst      D. worse

五、介词填空:

  1. Every day she  gets up _____ 7 o' clock _____ the morning.

  2. Please answer the  questions _____ page 50.

  3. He was born _____ the morning _____ Jan. 13 , 1991.

  4. He had porridge and  fruit _____ lunch every day.

  5. How many days are  there _____ a year?

  6. The students are  going to the  zoo _____ class.

六、按要求变换下列句型:

  1. I was born in Paris on  January 15 , 1982. (划线提问)

   _________________________________________________

  2. The Green family moved to  the town a  month ago. (同上)

    __________________________________________________

  3. Mike didn' t come to  school because he  was ill. (同上)

    __________________________________________________

  4. We didn' t do  eye exercises this morning. (改为肯定句)

    __________________________________________________

  5. The children had  a good time in  the park. (同义替换)

   The children _______ _______ in the  park.

  6. They usually have a  rest for thirty minutes after lunch. (同上)

    They usually have a  rest for _____ _____ _____ after lunch.

  7. Mr Wang never goes to  work late. He  always  gets to  his office the  earliest of all. (同上)

   Mr Wang _____ never _____ _____ work. He  always ______ his  office the earliest of  all.

  8. My brother had  nothing for breakfast. (同上)

   My brother _____ have __________ for breakfast.

七、用所给动词的适当形式填空:

  1. _____ they _____ (leave) China  last month?

  2. Kate ______ (stay) at  home and did  her homework.

  3. Do they enjoy ______ (live) in China?

  4. There _____ (be) a  meeting yesterday evening.

  5. —Where _____ (be ) Jack , Do you  know?

   —Sorry , I don' t know. He _____ (be) here a  moment ago.

  6. My mother _____ (keep)me busy yesterday.

  7. Who ________ (clean) the  classroom? Bill did.

  8. They ________ (not have) any meetings yesterday. They _________ (have) it next Juesday.

  9. She _______ (not be) in the office ten  minutes ago.

  10. He _______ (study)in  the No. 1 Middle School. He ______(start) in this school fifteen months ago.

八、改病句: (每句只有一处错, 指出并订正在横线上)

(   )1. He got a new  work here , so his  family moved here. __

           A       B           C              D

(   )2. Uncle Wang enjoys to making kites for the  students. __

                    A   B   C          D

(   )3. He bought much meat and  vegetables on his way  home.__

                 A    B         C       D

(   )4. How far it is from the  town to the  city? _____

            A   B    C           D

(   )5. Because I  have a lot  of homework to  do , I didn' t go 

                 A      B                       C

       to see him  yesterday. _____

        D

(   )6. My teacher gave me  two pieces of  paper with  answers 

                               A             B

         on   it. _____

         C   D

(   )7. Did you  get home half past ten  ago yesterday? _____

        A       B    C          D

(   )8. Yesterday I  went to Jim' s home and find he  was ill in

                  A                 B    C      D

       bed. _____

九、完形填空:

A  few years 1___ there was  a man 2___ Johnbson is  England. One day  he said 3___ one of  his friends ,“ I am  going 4___ China for  my holidays (假期) this year. But  I 5___ know Chinese. So  I am going to  study it 6___ I go.”He studied very hard 7___ a month , then he  8___ to China for  his holidays. He  came back 9___ a few  days. He told his  friend that he  didn' t enjoy himself in  China 10___ he couldn' t understand amybody and  no one understood him.

        A          B         C          D

(   )1. before       after        ago         them

(   )2. called       calling      call         name

(   )3. to           for         at          in

(   )4. for          to         with        from

(   )5. don' t       really        do        doesn' t

(   )6. after        before       from        when

(   )7. for          in          with         on

(   )8. goes        went        going       is going

(   )9. after        before        later         for

(   )10. because      so          why         but

初二英语期末试卷练习

一、指出与所给单词划线部分发音相同的一个词:

(   )1. opposite   A. total             B. conductor

                C. porridge          D. hope

(   )2. diagram   A. will    B. April    C. ticket   D. dialogue

(   )3. said      A. train    B. again   C. say     D. says

(   )4. town      A. out     B. grow    C. autumn D. know

(   )5. health    A. clothes  B. than    C. with    D. thirtieth

(   )6. fruit      A. building            B. build

                C. popular            D. June

(   )7. listenen   A. carried             B. needed

                C. helped             D. wanted

(   )8. beeter     A. conductor          B. worse

                C. more              D. born

(   )9. sure       A. sir    B. soccer   C. machine   D. touch

(   )10. example  A. last   B. wash    C. animal    D. diagram    二、找出适当的字母或字母组合,使单词完整:

(   )1. re __ ber     A. mem    B. men     C. mon    D. min

(   )2. condu __     A. tor      B. ter      C. tur     D. tir

(   )3. vill __ e      A. ag       B. eg       C. ig      D. agg

(   )4. hospit __     A. al       B. er       C. el      D. ul

(   )5. be __ se      A. cor      B. kau      C. cau    D. kou

(   )6. e __ cise      A. xor      B. ker      C. xer     D. ker

(   )7. s __ eet    A. tr      B. dr      C. st      D. ds

(   )8. t __ n      A. er      B. ur      C. ir      D. or

(   )9. Fran __    A. ch      B. sh      C. ce     D. se

(   )10. __ our    A. wh     B. w      C. h      D. ph

三、用所给词的正确形式填空:

  1. Can you tell me  the way to  the _______ hospital? (near)

  2. Don' t run so _______ in the  street. (quick)

  3. He _______ his car to  work every day. (driver)

  4. December is the _______ month of  the year. (twelve)

  5. I have _______ books than you. (few)

  6. Please put these _______ on the  table. (vegetable)

  7. How many _______ can the  students have ? (guess)

  8. _______ very much. (thank)

  9. You must do  the work _______. (you)

  10. He lived in  China for _______ than one  year. (little)

四、选择填空:

(   )1. ____ in my  class are very good at  running.

       A. Some of girls        B. Some of the  girl

       C. Some of  the girls    D. Some girl

(   )2. What is  she ____?

       A. finding             B. looking

       C. looking for          D. look for

(   )3. There are  some new words on  the blackboard.

       Please ____.

       A. write it down              B. write down it

       C. write them down          D. write down them

(   )4. You had  better ____ late for the  meeting.

       A. not be            B. not to be

       C. be not             D. don' t be

(   )5. —How is  your brother?  —____.

       A. He' s very good          B. He' s very old

       C. He' s very well           D. He' s very strong

(   )6. I' m hungry. Please ____ me something to  eat.

      A. bring      B. take     C. to bring     D. to take

(   )7. I ____ him , but I ____ nothing.

       A. heard , listened             B. listened to , heard

       C. listen , hear                D. hear to , listen

(   )8. —How ____ you ____ there?  —I walked there.

       A. do , go to           B. did , go

       C. were , go            D. did , go to

(   )9. —Please pass me  a pen , please.  —____.

       A. Give you             B. All right

       C. That' s all right        D. That' s right

(   )10. __ and __ the first turning , you' ll find the  post office.

        A. Take right , take         B. Turn the right , take

        C. Take right , turn         D. Turn right , take

(   )11. My mother ____ a rest after work.

        A. have  not            B. has not

        C. doesn' t have           D. doesn' t has

(   )12. September comes ____ August.

        A. about      B. behind      C. after    D. befrore

(   )13. We must read and  write ____.

        A. careful    B. carefully    C. carefuly   D. care

(   )14. Mike has ____ a lot  of good friends at  school.

        A. quite     B. many     C. very     D. some

(   )15. There  are ____ students in  our grade.

        A. three hundreds of        B. three hundred of

        C. three hundreds          D. three hundred

(   )16. His father went to  London ____ 1991.

        A. in      B. on      C. at      D. from

(   )17. ____ I open the  window?

        A. Shall      B. Do      C. Am      D. Would

(   )18. —May I  borrow your pen ?  —____.

        A. No , you can' t             B. Yes , thank you

        C. Sorry , I' m using it  now    D. Excuse me , I can' t

(   )19. —____ is she ?   —She is  a teacher.

        A. Who      B. What      C. Whose     D. Which

(   )20. It' s ____ walk from our  school to the  station.

        A. half an hour' s          B. half a hour' s

        C. half an hour           D. half a hour

(   )21. —Happy new  year!  —____.

        A. Thank you           B. That' s all right

       C. Good-bye           D. The same to  you

(   )22. Which floor do  you ____?

        A. live on     B. live     C. live in     D. live at

(   )23. Li Lei  likes the mooncake ____ nuts ____ it.

        A. with , on              B. with , in

        C. not , in               D. has , in

(   )24. Sometimes the  students eat the  food ____ the road.

        A. on      B. in      C. under      D. at

(   )25. Many young people like to  work in ____.

        A. the America           B. the USA

        C. an USA              D. an America

(   )26. I like May ____ January.

        A. best of             B. best than

        C. better than         D. better of

(   )27. The chicken is  ten yuan a  kilo. That' s ____ dear.

        A. too many           B. too much

        C. many too          D. much too

(   )28. —Where did  you buy the  trousers?

        — I ____ in  the shop near here.

        A. bought it            B. buy them

        C. bought them         D. buy it

(   )29. Can you  find the anwser ____ this question?

        A. of      B. to      C. with      D. in

(   )30. Did you  do ____ homework?

      A. your all    B. all your    C. you all    D. all you

五、连词成句:

  1. ill , because , didn' t  he , come , was , here.

    __________________________________________________

  2. on , please , along , and , the , first , right , walk , road , take , turning.

    __________________________________________________

  3. than , yesterday , it , much , is today , colder.

   ___________________________________________________

  4. put , he , the , fridge , yesterday , meat , in.

   ___________________________________________________

  5. last , floors , he , use , doesn' t , life , the , why , the for , three.

   __________________________________________________

  6. closed , eyes , the keep , their , students , other.

    __________________________________________________

六、按要求变换下列句型:

  1. He lived in  Japan for about three years. (划线提问)

    __________________________________________________

  2. It' s October 30 , 1995. (同上)

    __________________________________________________

  3. He found a pen on  the road. (同上)

    __________________________________________________

  4. He went to  school on foot. (用 by bike 改为选择问句)

   __________________________________________________

  5. He was late for  class yesterday. (用 early 改为选择问句)

    __________________________________________________

  6. My mother has  her lunch at  the factory. (改一般疑问句)

    __________________________________________________

  7. He was born in  a small village not  far from Beijing. (同义替换)

   He was  born in a  small village ________ Beijing.

  8. She had a  short rest. After that she  helped he mother. (同上)

   She helped her  mother _________ she  had a short rest.

  9. I like football best. (同上)

   Football is  my ________ sport.

 10. He didn' t like living in  the city , so he  moved to the             village. (同上)

    He  moved to the  village ________ he didn' t like living in          the city.

七、用所给动词的适当形式填空:

  1. What _____ you _____ (do) the  day before yesterday?

  2. Listen! Who ________ (sing) an  English song over there?

  3. There _____ (be) a  football game tomorrow afternoon. But they ________ (not watch) it. They ______ (have) three classes then.

  4. Who _______ (speak) at  the meeting now? Mr  Wu _____, I think.

  5.—What _____ you _____ (do) here?

   —I _______ (read) a book. I ________ (borrow) it form our  teacher this morning.

  6. Thursday _______ (come) after  Wednesday.

  7. Class Three _______ (help) the farmers _______ (pick) apples next week.

  8. Lily likes _____ (be) busy all the  time. She _______ (clean) the house and _______ (wash) all the  clothes yesterday.

  9. It' s six o' clock now. Iyt' s time _______ (get) up.

  10. It ____ (be) too  late. You' d better ______ (not walk) home. You need _______ (catch) a bus.

八、改病句:(每句只有一处错, 指出并订正在横线上)

(  )1. The students  go  to work on the  farm the day after 

                  A           B            C      D

       tomorrow.   _______         

(   )2. Please   be   carefully   to   climb  the  ladder. _______

              A      B     C    D

(   )3. You must finish your homework today and take it  here              A                                B   C      D

       tomorrow. _______   

(   )4. You' d better look after you and  keep  healthy. _______

                   A        B       C     D

(   )5. —When do you  start this lesson?

              A       B 

       —About  ten minutes ago. _______

                   C    D

(   )6. Do you  enjoy living in  the Paris? _______

       A        B     C        D

(   )7. I am sorry coming late  to  school. _______

        A    B     C         D

(   )8. I go to the People' s Park with my  father two days ago.

        A  B  C                D

(   )9. There are  many apples in  the box. Some of them is bad.

                 A                        B   C  D

(   )10. You had  better don' t let him go. _______

                       A   B  C   D

九、汉译英:(每空只填一个词)

  1. 这些农民和警察 , 因为他们不知道去车站的路。

  The farmers _______ _______ the policeman because the            didn' t know _______ _______ _______ the station.

  2. 我找不到钢笔了。我还以为在抽屉里。

   I can' t find my  pen. _____ _____ _____ _____ in  the desk.

  3. 看, 这女孩在为老人捡起车票。

   Look , the girl _____ _____ _____ the ticket for  the old man.

  4. 我下次要更加小心。

   I' ll ______ ______ ______ next time.

  5. 学生喜欢下课后打篮球。

   The students ______ ______ basketball ______ ______.

  6. 我一九八三年三月十三日出生。

   I ______ ______ ______ March 13 , 1983.

  7. 这个瓶子里的牛奶比那个瓶里的少。

   There is ______ ______ in this bottle ______ in that one.

  8. 在阳光下看书对我们的眼睛有害吗?

   ______ ______ in the sun  bad ______ our eyes?

十、选择正确的译文:

(   )1. 当她到家时, 喝了一杯水然后开始做家务。

    A. When she got  home , she has a  glass of water and               then began to  do housework.

    B. When she got  home , she had a  glass of water and               then begin to  do housework.

    C. When she gets home , she had  a glass of  water and               then begin to  do housework.

    D. When she  got home , she had  a glass of  water and               then began to  do housework.

(   )2. 孩子们非常喜欢划船。

    A. The children like to  boating very much.

    B. The children very much like boating.

    C. The children very like boating.

    D. The children like boating very much.

(   )3. 在离他家五公里的一间办公室上班。

    A. John works in  an office is  five kilometres from his  home.

    B. John works in  a office is  five kilometres from his  home.

    C. John works in  a office five kilometres from his  home.

    D. John works from his  home five kilometres an  office.

(   )4. 他父母亲星期天经常带他上公园。

    A. His parents often take him  go to the  park on Sunday.

    B. His parents often take him  to the park on  Sunday.

    C. His parents often take him  going to the  park on Sunday.

    D. His parents often take him  to go  to the park on  Sunday.

(   )5. 她比我更擅长于爬山。

    A. She is  better than I  at climbing the  hill.

    B. She is best than I  to climbing the  hill.

    C. She is the  best than I  in climbing the  hill.

    D. She is better than I  to climb the  hill.

十一、完形填空:

It  1___ August. A lot  2___ people went to  the seaside for  their holidays (假期). This time the  town near the  seaside invited (邀请) some good singers to  sing in the  park , so that (为了) people could 3___ a good time druing (在…期间)their holidays. They sang every evening for  a week.

But  on the first evening it  rained (下雨). The singers were under cover (遮盖), but the people had  to sit 4___ the open air. The  singers sang very 5___ , but there 6___ only one  man listening. The man  was sitting in  a chair , under an  umbrella (雨伞).

After  some time , one of  7___ came over to  the man and  8__ ,“I am sure you  like music (音乐). It' s so  good of you  to sit here and  9___ to us.”

“No ,”said the  man ,“I 10___ like music at  all. Please finish 11___ and then I  am going 12___ the door and  go home.”

(   )1. A. be        B. is        C. was       D. were

(   )2. A. of        B. the       C. /          D. many

(   )3. A. has       B. have      C. having    D. had

(   )4. A. in         B. at        C. on        D. hwith

(   )5. A. better      B. best      C. good      D. well

(   )6. A. is         B. was       C. were      D. are

(   )7. A. the singers            B. the singer

      C. a singer               D. singers

(   )8. A. said       B. say       C. says       D. saying

(   )9. A. listen      B. hear      C. hearing    D. listening

(   )10. A. am not   B. not       C. don' t      D. no

(   )11. A. be quick  B. quick      C. quickly    D. to be  quick

(   )12. A. to open   B. to close   C. opening   D. closing

十二、阅读理解:

Tom  was worried. He  got a letter from the  policeman a week ago. They told him  to go to  the police station when he  got the  letter. Tom  didn' t know why  the policeman wanted him. He  went to the  police station yesterday and  now he is  not worried. At  the station a  policeman told him  that they found his  lost (丢失的) bike. The policeman said that five days ago  they found his  bike in a  small village four hundred miles (英里) away. They said they were going to  give it back to  Tom soon. Wkhen Tom  heard the news , he was  very surprised (惊讶). He never thought he  should (竟然) find the  bike. He lost it  twenty years ago  when he was  a boy of  fifteen.

(   )1. The letter is  from _____.

       A. one of Tom' s friend in  the police station

       B. one of the  policemen in the  police station

       C. Tom' s friend in  the town

       D. the policeman in  a small village

(   )2. Tom was  worried because _____.

       A. he could not  find his bike

       B. the police station was  very far away

       C. he didn' t know the  policeman

        D. he didn' t know why  the policeman wanted hime

(   )3. When did  Tom buy the  bike?

       A. fifteen years ago        B. five days ago

       C. yesterday               D. We don' t know

(    )4. Which of  the following is  true?

       A. The policeman didn' t want to  give the bike back to  Tom.

       B. Tom found the  bike in the  police station.

       C. Tom found the  bike  in a  small village.

      D. Tom could get  back his bike soon.

初二英语听力 Unit 8 ~14 练习

一、听句子,选择所听到的单词:每题念一遍

(   )1. A. be    B. ill       C. before    D. busy

(   )2. A. all    B. draw     C. wall      D. small

(   )3. A. blue   B. broom   C. school    D. soon

(   )4. A. less   B. left      C. let       D. best

(   )5. A. dear   B. here      C. near      D. hear

二、听录音,选择与原句意思相似的句子:每题念两遍

(   )1. A. The students give the  ball to everyone.

      B. The students pass the  ball from the  first one to  the               second one.

       C. The students pass the  ball one by  one.

       D. The students get  the ball from the  teacher.

(   )2. A. We need a  car to go  to the farm.

       B. We had better go  to the farm by  bike.

       C. We had better go  to the farm by  train.

       D. We had better go  to the farm by  bus.

(   )3. A. The shop is  near the factory.

       B. The shop is  in the factory.

       C. The shop is  far from the  factory.

       D. The shop is  nine kilometres away from the  factory.

(   )4. A. My father goes to  work early every day.

       B. My father never goes to  work lae every day.

       C. My father never goes to  work early every day.

       D. My father always goes to  work late every day.

(   )5. A. Mr Wu  lives in a  big house in  a small village inside             the city.

      B. Mr Wu lives in  a small house in  a big village outside            the city.

      C. Mr Wu lives in  a big house in  a small village not  far            from the city.

      D. Mr Wu lives in  a small house in  a small village far              from the city.

三、听录音,回答问题:短文念两遍

(   )1. A. To their friend' s.         B. To their mother' s.

      C. To their daughter' s.       D. To the doctor' s.

(   )2. A. On foot.    B. By bus.    C. By train.    D. By air.

(   )3. A. To get  off the bus.        B. To buy tickets.

       C. To get their tickets ready.

       D. To show their tickets.

(   )4. A. Mr and  Mrs Cooper' s.     B. Some boys' .

       C. The conductor' s.           D. A group of  girls' .

(   )5. A. It doesn' t matter.          B. Not at all.

       C. You don' t need any  tickets.

       D. Better late than never.

四、听问句,选出最恰当的答案:每句念两遍

(   )1. A. Go swimming.          B. Play basketball.

       C. Go to bed.            D. Take a walk.

(   )2. A. On foot.               B. At eight.

       C. For an hour.           D. Have a talk.

(   )3. A. More than two  year.    B. Less than five yuan.

       C. One kilometre.         D. Three cups.

(   )4. A. Before class.           B. Five minutes.

       C. Every day.             D. Two days.

(   )5. A. Two eggs and  a cup of  tea.

       B. Have a drink.      

       C. Nothing much.

       D. Have breakfast with my  parents.

初二英语第十五单元练习卷

一、指出与所给的单词划线部分发音相同的一个单词:

(  )1. message  A. always   B. ladder   C. village   D. cinema

(  )2. moment  A. hope     B. porridge  C. worry   D. another

(  )3. cinema   A. letter    B. ticket    C. question D. never

(  )4. pleasure  A. healthy   B. speak    C. idea     D. reach

(  )5. enough   A. out      B. about    C. could   D. young

(  )6. wear      A. near     B. hair      C. dear    D. early

(  )7. zoo       A. book    B. foot      C. moon   D. good

(  )8. afraid    A. tiger     B. again     C. fruit    D. dialogue

(  )9. ring      A. ticket    B. April     C. inside   D. police

(  )10. cinema  A. second   B. come     C. place   D. care

二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

  1. story (复数)__________       2. ring (过去式)_________

  3. begin (现在分词)_________    4. next (反义词)_________

  5. hot (最高级)_________        6. remember (反义词)__________

  7. way (复数)_________          8. photo (复数)__________

  9. free (反义词)_________        10. meet (过去式)_________

三、将下列汉语译成英语:

  1. 接电话 _________________      2. 现在、此刻 _____________

  3. 把…记下来 _______________    4. 摘苹果 ________________

  5. 在一张纸上 ________________   6. 在电影院 ______________

  7. 过得很愉快 ______________________   

  8. 用梯子爬上树 ____________________

  9. 去年十月份________________   

  10. 帮忙摘收苹果 ___________________

四、选择填空:

(  )1. This is  his telephone number. Please write ____.

      A. them down           B. down it    

      C. down them           D. it down

(  )2. ____ the way , do you  know where he  lives?

      A. By        B. On        C. In       D. At

(  )3. Last week Wang Wei ____ a lot  of apples.

      A. buy       B. buys      C. bought      D. buying

(  )4. I' m sorry , I ____ out when you ____ me.

       A. am , called            B. was , call

       C. was , called            D. am , call

(  )5. Look! There are  many oranges ____.

      A. in the  tree           B. on the tree

      C. with the tree         D. under tree

(  )6. Picking apples was ____, buy they really ____.

     A. hard work , enjoyed it        B. a hard work , enjoyed it

     C. hard works , enjoyed them    D. hard work , enjoyed them

(  )7. I ____ I can' t help you  with your maths.

      A. afraid      B. afraided      C. am afraid     D. was afraid

(  )8. Does your teacher often ____ you some stories?

      A. say       B. talk       C. speak       D. tell

(  )9. Is he ____ to reach the  apple?

      A. enough tall           B. tall enough

      C. much tall             D. tall much

(  )10. He always ____ a notebook with him.

        A. brings     B. takes      C. carries     D. get

(  )11. Most of  them went to  the farm ____ Sunday.

       A. in      B. at      C. on      D. from

(  )12. The Turners ____ a good time in  the park last Sunday.

        A. have       B. had        C. has        D. were

(  )13. We must get  ready ____ the meeting now.

        A. for        B. of       C. at       D. in

(  )14. — Did the  farmers have a  good harvest last year ? —____.

       A. Yes , they had              B. No , they hadn' t

       C. Yes , they did               D. No , they did

(  )15. He is  in the office ___ the moment.

       A. at       B. on       C. in       D. of

(  )16. —Who ____ those boxes to  the classroom ? — Mike did.

       A. is going to  carry          B. carried

       C. carries                   D. is carrying

(  )17. Last year there ____ only a  few machines in  that factory.

       A. is       B. was       C. are       D. were

(  )18. My coat is  quite big. What about ____?

       A. yours      B. you      C. your      D. yourself

(  )19. He often helps me ____ my lessons.

       A. to       B. in      C. with       D. at

(  )20. He is  going to Australia ____.

       A. the next day            B. next week

       C. the next week           D. on tomorrow

五、将下列句子改成否定句、疑问句,并作肯否定回答:

  1. She did the  work yesterday afternoon.

    __________________________________________________

    ___________________________________________________

    ___________________________________________________

  2. They had a  good time in  the park last Sunday.

   __________________________________________________

    ___________________________________________________

    ___________________________________________________

  3. They wrote down the  sentence on the  paper.

    __________________________________________________

    ___________________________________________________

    ___________________________________________________

  4. There were many flowers at  the shop.

    __________________________________________________

    ___________________________________________________

    ___________________________________________________

  5. There was a  message.

    __________________________________________________

    ___________________________________________________

    ___________________________________________________

  6. They needed help with the  apple harvest last October.

    __________________________________________________

    ___________________________________________________

    ___________________________________________________

六、将下列句子划线提问:

  1. Jim and his  friends went to  help the farmers.

    _____________________________________________________

  2. The children carried the  apples to the  trucks.

    _____________________________________________________

  3. I picked the  most apples.

    _____________________________________________________

  4. We picked six boxes  of  apples on the  farm.

    _____________________________________________________

七、用所给动词的适当形式填空:

  1. Mike and Bill _______ (go) to the  bookshop _______ (buy) some  books.

  2. It' s quite cold today. ________ (put) on your coat , please.

  3. Five days ago , Mike ______ (buy) a new  pen. The next day  he ______ (bring) it to the  classroom and _______ (show) it to me.

  4. Look! Tom and  Mary ________ (fly) kites  over there.

  5. Did they enjoy ________ (read) the picture-book?

  6. It' s six o' clock now. It' s time ________ (get) up.

  7. I ______ (be) busy _______ (clean) the windows. Could you ____(get) some water for  me ?

  8. It was very warm in  the room. When Lily _______ (come) in , she ________ (take) off her coat at  once.

  9. I' m sorry I _____ (be) out when you  rang.

10. Last  Sunday most of  us _______ (go) to the farm and _______ (help) the ffarmers _______ (pick) apples. We  all _______ (enjoy) _______ (work) there.

八、完成下列对话:

Tom: Hello !

Mary: Hello !  May  I 1______ to John?

Tom: Sorry , John 2______ in.

Mary:  Is 3______ Tom speaking?

Tom: Yes. Who' s 4______?

Mary:  5______ 6______ Mary.

Tom: Mary , John is 7______ the cinema at  the 8_______. Can  I 9      _______ a 10 ______ for  him.

Mary: Yes. Could you  11_______ him to 12_______ me , please ?

Tom: OK!

九、改病句:(每句只有一处错, 指出并订正在横线内)

(  )1. We all go to work in  the factory last week. ______

          A  B   C          D

(  )2. Lucy and  Lily helped the  farmers with the  rice harvest in

                     A               B                C

      Saturday afternoon. _______

             D

(  )3. When did you  gave him the beautiful photo ? _______

        A    B       C             D

(  )4. She rang up him and  told him the news. _______

           A    B         C         D

(  )5. I wrote it down in a  piece of paper. _______

          A    B     C             D

(  )6. We are going to play the football this afternoon. _______

              A              B       C    D

(   )7. There are two  big photoes on the  wall. _______

            A       B     C    D

(  )8. They need hand in their homework on time. _______

       A           B            C        D

(  )9. Did you  have good time on the  farm last week ? _______

       A               B     C             D

十、汉译英: (每空只填一个词)

  1. 他们在看电影。 

    They ______ ______ ______ cinema.

  2. 我知道谁摘的苹果最少。

    I know ______ ______ the ______ apples.

  3. 昨天是谁接的电话? 

    Who _______ the _______ yesterday?

  4. 恐怕我记不住。

    I' m afraid _______ _______ _______.

  5. 你的名字怎么拼写? 

    _______ do you _______ your _______?

  6. 恐怕没有足够的人手来摘苹果。

    I' m afraid there ______ not _____ _____ to _____ the apples.

初二英语第十六单元练习卷

一、指出与所给的单词划线部分发音相同的一个单词:

(  )1. cool     A. school    B. good     C. foot      D. book

(  )2. weather  A. fourth    B. health    C. throw    D. they

(  )3. warm    A. park      B. quarter   C. harvest   D. garden

(  )4. season    A. weather   B. speak    C. pleasure  D. healthy

(  )5. Summer  A. puzzle    B. usually    C. popular   D. busy

(  )6. snow     A. how      B. down     C. grow    D. brown

(  )7. autumn   A. brought   B. harvest   C. cold     D. aunt

(  )8. helped    A. answered  B. listened   C. stayed   D. asked

(  )9. really     A. wear      B. idea      C. where   D. hair

(  )10. said     A. rain       B. says      C. eight    D. player

二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

  1. cool (反义词)_________       2. forget (过去式)_________

  3. please (名词)_________       4. skate (现在分词)________

  5. write (过去式)________       6. few (最高级)________

  7. well (比较级)_________       8. early (最高级)_______

  9. Australia (形容词)__________ 10. say (第三人称单数)_______

三、将下列汉语译成英语:

  1. 十张纸 ______________           2. 去溜冰 ______________

  3. 每年的这个时候 _______________ 4. 与…不同 _____________  5. 从八月到十月 _________________    

 6. 为…做准备 ______________        7. 最喜欢春天 ___________ 8. 由于…而感谢某人 ______________

 9. 帮助某人做某事 ______________    10. 脱掉 ______________

四、选择填空:

(   )1. Which colour do  you like ____. red , yellow or blur?

       A. best       B. better       C. more      D. much

(  )2. Autumn is  the best season of ____ in Beijing.

      A. a year     B. the year     C. years      D. the years

(  )3. In winter his  brother often ____ over there.

      A. go skating           B. go to skate

      C. goes skating          D. went to skate

(  )4. —Ann is  a student , isn' t she?   —____.

       A. Yes , she isn' t         B. No , she is

       C. She is                D. No , she isn' t

(  )5. It is  very cold here. You  need ____ warmer clothes.

      A. to wear     B. wearing     C. wear     D. wore

(  )6. Everything ____ to grow in  spring.

       A. begin     B. to begin    C. begins      D. beginning

(  )7. Are you  ready ____ the meeting?

     A. to      B. at      C. for      D. in

(  )8. Lucy ____ in a  small village not  far from here.

      A. is born           B. was born

      C. has born          D. had born

(  )9. —You' re all  from Fuzhou , ____ you?  —Yes , we are.

      A. are      B. are not      C. weren' t      D. aren' t

(  )10. English is  quite different ____ Chinese.

       A. from      B. of      C. in      D. about

(  )11. I think I  like this watch ____ than that one.

       A. good     B. better     C. well      D. best

(  )12. Friday comes ____ Thursday.

       A. after      B. before      C. on      D. from

(  )13. Where ____ Bruce come from?

        A. is       B. do      C. does     D. has

(  )14. ____ the weather like in  your home town now ?

       A. How does    B. How is    C. What' s     D. What was

(  )15. I went to  the station to  ask ____ the train.

       A. for      B. about      C. on     D. in

(  )16. I enjoy ____ English.

       A. studying    B. to study    C. studied     D. studies

(  )17. Our weekend ____ two days now.

       A. last      B. is last      C. lasts      D. lasted

(  )18. She was  ill for a  month but she' s looking ____ now.

        A. good     B. well      C. more well      D. best

(  )19. It is ____ to go  swimming now. It  is so hot.

       A. best      B. the best      C. the better      D. well

(  )20. —Who called me  this morning?  —____ was your mother.

        A. That       B. This        C. She        D. It

五、介词填空:

  1. The weather is  very cold here _______ winter.

  2. It' s very cold _____ this time ______ the year _____ America.

  3. The little boy  was born _______ January 1st , 1992.

  4. Autumn lasts _______ August ______ October in China.

  5. Mary often helps me ______ my English.

  6. Last year we  went to work ______ a farm.

  7. What did you  do ______ the evening ______ March 6?

  8. The old worker came to  our school _____ October 1990.

  9. My parents are  very busy ______ Sundays.

  10. Lin Feng gets up ______ six every morning.

六、用所给动词词组的适当形式填空:

get  to , help…with , get  down , get hotter , get colder ,

get  up get on , go swimming , take off , get home

  1. Look! The Young Pioneers ____ the farmers ____orange picking.

  2. When the teacher _______________ the classroom , the students stopped talking at  once.

  3. It' s very hot  in the room. Please ______________ your coat.

  4. Winter comes after autumn and  the weather _____________.

  5. Look , the old woman ______________ the bus. Let' s help her.

  6. Summer is here and  it _______________.

  7. When I _____________ last Saturday , my parents were waiting for  me.

  8. My brother often _____________ at six  thirty in the  morning.

  9. In summer we  often ______________ in  rivers and lakes.

10. Tom , I can' t _________ from the  tree. Please give me  a ladder.

七、将下列句子改成反意问句:

  1. The twins are  from England.

    _________________________________________________

  2. There were many apples on  the farm.

    _________________________________________________

  3. Kate was born in  a  town near Oxford.

    _________________________________________________

  4. Mr Dick comes from England.

    _________________________________________________

  5. Mary isn' t in  the office.

    _________________________________________________

  6. They helped them with the  apple picking.

    _________________________________________________

  7. They don' t like winter.

    _________________________________________________

 8. They are  going to have a  class meeting this afternoon.

    _________________________________________________

八、根据划线提问:

  1. Ling Ping is  from Shanghai.

    _________________________________________________

  2. The weather is  very cold toay.

    _________________________________________________

  3. This message was  from Han Meimei.

    _________________________________________________

  4. My father was  out when you  rang him.

    _________________________________________________

  5. The students worked very hard on  the farm.

    _________________________________________________

  6. He was ill  yesterday so he  didn' t go to  school.

    _________________________________________________

九、改病句: (每句只有一处错误, 指出并订正在横线内)

(  )1. Bruce' s brother likes to  go swimming  on summer. _______

        A            B         C         D

(  )2. We always put on hats  in winter. ______

            A      B    C   D

(  )3. In autumn the  leaves turn to brown. ______

      A              B    C    D

(  )4. Which book do  you like best , this one  or that one? ______

         A               B    C           D

(  )5. Jim and  his friends went to  help the farmers in last month.

              A          B               C        D

(   )6. He never works in  a hospital , doesn' t he? _______

           A    B     C              D

(  )7. The five month of  the year is May. _______

           A           B      C   D

(   )8. Some of  them went to the  farm by bus. The others students

                      A              B        D

      went there on foot. _______

                  D

(  )9. That' s a small village is not far  from sydney. _______

              A       B     C        D

(  )10. It often rains , sometimes quite heavy. _______

       A        B      C            D

十、完成下列对话:

Mrs  Black: Hello !

Mary: _____ I _______ John:

Mrs  Black: Sorry , John isn' t it.

Mary: Is ______ Mrs Black ______?

Mrs  Black: Yes. ______ is ______?

Mary: ______ Mary , Mrs Black. I______ at four this afternoon , but       nobody was in.

Mrs  Black: Oh , We _____ all ______. John wasn' t back home then.           Can I _________ for him?

Mary: Yes , please. I  can' t help him _____ his lessons this evening ,       I' m afraid. Mother is  ill.

Mrs  Black: I' m sorry ______ that. Just stay at  home and look after           your mother.

Mary: All right. _________. Bye-bye.

Mrs  Black: It' s __________. Good-bye.

初二下英语听力训练(Unit 15 ~16)

一、根据你所听到的句子填写所缺的单词,每题念一遍。

  1. There were not _______ people to  pick apples on  the farm.

  2. The ____ of Australia is  quite different from that of  Beijing.

  3. I' m afraid Li  Ping is out  at the _______ .

  4. It' s much _______ in  the south of  China than in  the north of  China.

  5. I' d like you  to write down Jim' s _______ number.

  6. Lucy was very sorry that she  was out when you _______ .

  7. Could you bring some nice _______ to  school tomorrow?

  8. Jim and his  friends went to  the farm and ____ many apples.

  9. Which month is  colder in China , ________ or December?

10. Will  you please go _______ with me  this afternoon?

二、听录音,选择正确的答案补全句子,每题念二遍。

(  )1. Listen to  the teacher carefully , then ____ the new  words.

      A. write down            B. put down

      C. write out              D. take down

(  )2. The students are  all busy , getting ready for ____.

       A. next term             B. next week

       C. next month            D. next year

(  )3. ____ for coming to  see me.

      A. Thank you            B. Thanks

      C. Thanks a lot           D. Thank you very much

(  )4. Li Ping' s telephone number is ____.

      A.     B.    C.     D.

(  )5. Did you  have a good time ____ last Sunday?

       A. in the park            B. at the cinema

       C. at Ann' s party         D. in the zoo

三、听对话及对话后问题,选择正确的答案,对话念二遍。

(  )1. A. He was  born in a  town near Oxford.

      B. He was born in  a small village far  from London.

      C. He was born in  a city near London.

       D. He was born in  a town far  from Oxford.

(  )2. A. He comes from a  small town not  far from Sydney.

      B. He comes from a  big town not  far from Sydney.

      C. He comes from a  small village not  far from Sydney.

      D. He comes from a  big village not  far from Sydney.

(  )3. A. One year ago.               B. Two years ago.

      C. One and a  half years ago.    D. Three years ago.

(  )4. A. Peter' s aunt.         B. Peter' s father and  mother.

      C. Peter' s mother.        D. Peter' s father.

(  )5. A. Because he  likes snow.

      B. Because he likes skating.

      C. Because he likes making snowmen.

      D. Because he likes playing with snow.

四、听短文,选择正确的答案,短文念三遍。

(  )1. There was  a telephone call from ____ to ____.

      A. Alice , Wei Hua        B. Wei Hua , Alice

      C. me , Alice              D. Wei Hua , me

(  )2. Alice ____ when the  telephone rang.

      A. went swimming          B. went skating

      C. went shopping           D. went fishing

(  )3. Wei Hua' s telephone number was ____.

       A.     B.    C.    D.

(  )4. Alice came home at ____.

      A. five fifteen   B. five fifty   C. four fifteen   D. four fifty

(  )5. After Alice knew everything , she ____ Wei Hua.

       A. went to see             B. gave the  photos to

       C. rang up                D. went shopping with

初二下英语听力训练(Unit 17 ~ 18)

一、听录音选出你在句子中所听到的单词或词组,每题念一遍。

(  )1. A. sun      B. sunnier    C. sunny     D. sunshine

(  )2. A. wind     B. snow      C. rain       D. hot

(  )3. A. skate     B. swim      C. drive      D. sing

(  )4. A. blow      B. blew       C. blue      D. blows

(  )5. A. afraid     B. think       C. sorry      D. sure

(  )6. A. really      B. strongly    C. heavily    D. nearly

(  )7. A. felt       B. fell        C. fall       D. feel

(  )8. A. comes out   B. comes up   C. comes into  D. comes in

(   )9. A. another piece of  meat      B. a piece of  meat

      C. a piece of  bread           D. another piece of  bread

(  )10. A. look out    B. find out    C. write out    D. take out

二、听录音选择你所听到的句子,每题念二遍。

(   )1. A. The snow is  thick , isn' t it?

      B. The snow isn' t thick , is it?

      C. The snow is  thin , isn' t it?

      D. The snow isn' t thin , is it?

(  )2. A. I like wearing a  red hat on  my head.

      B. I like wearing a  red skirt for  my birtthday party.

      C. I like wearing a  red feather in  my new hat.

      D. I like wearing a  red dress for  my birthday party.

(  )3. A. Thanks for  coming to see  me.

      B. Thanks a  lot for coming to  help me.

      C. Thanks for coming to  help me.

      D. Thanks a lot  for coming to  see me.

(  )4. A. Could you  ask him to  call me , please?

      B. Could you ask  him to show it  to me , please?

      C. Could you ask  him to give it  to me , please?

      D. Could you ask  him to pass it  to me , please?

(  )5. A. When it' s summer in  China , it' s winter in  Australia.

      B. When it' s winter in  China , it' s summer in  Australia.

      C. When it' s  autumn in  China , it' s spring in  Australia.

      D. When it' s spring in  China , it' s autumn in  Australia.

三、听对话后判断下列句子是否与原文意思相符,相符用T,不符用F,对话念二遍。

(  )1. Wei Fang' s telephone number is  .

(  )2. Ann is  going to have a  birthday party at  home.

(  )3. The party starts at  two o' clock in  the afternoon next           Saturday.

(  )4. Wei Fang  thinks Jim  can' t go to  the party because he  is ill.

(  )5. Wei Fang will give the  message to Mike.

四、听短文后填入短文中所缺的单词,短文念三遍。

    I was  born in Xiamen-the city near the  sea. The 1_______ there is  nice and clean. In  winter the 2_______ never gets too  cold. We 3_______ wear lots of  warm clothes. We  can see green trees and  4_______ flowers here and  there. Autumn is  a very cool 5_______ . The  wind 6______ from the  sea. Children enjoy flying kites in  the park or  near the sea. The  7 _______ time to  come to my  home town is  from 8______ to 9______ . At  this time of  year , the weather is  quite hot , but the  sea is blue. It' s good to  go swimming in  the 10_______ sea.

初二英语第十八单元练习

一、指出下列与所给单词划线部分发音相同的一个词:

(   )1. feather   A. health    B. birthday  C. weather    D. nothing

(   )2. laugh    A. warm    B. pass      C. because    D. worse

(   )3. wet      A. vegetable  B. harvest   C. enjoy      D. December

(   )4. candle    A. later      B. date      C. plate       D. happy

(   )5. present   A. pleasure  B. always    C. answer     D. second

(   )6. sandwich  A. message   B. catch    C. cheap      D. machine

(   )7. enjoyed   A. laughed   B. wanted   C. looked     D. cleaned

(   )8. health     A. sea       B. reach     C. feather    D. cleaner

(   )9. popular   A. party      B. quarter   C. dangerous  D. ladder

(   )10. says     A. player     B. next      C. may       D. Sunday

二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

 1. dry (比较级)___________      2. snow (形容词)___________

 3. forget (现在分词)__________   4. party (复数)_________

 5. feather (复数)________        6. right (同音词)_________

 7. sandwich (复数)___________   8. think (过去式)_________

 9. wear (过去式)_________       10. easy (副词)_________

 三、将下列汉语译成英语:

 1. 聚会__________________      2. 生日快乐________________

 3. 迟一点________________      4. 等一会儿________________

 5. 恐怕不行______________      6. 再添一点牛奶________________

 7. 请某人参加聚会______________________________

 8. 感到高兴_______________________

 9. 她的所有其他朋友____________________________

 10. 多么美味的食物! ____________________________

四、选择填空:

(   )1. Sorry , I _____ you about it.

       A. forget to tell        B. forget telling

       C. forgot to tell        D. forgot telling

(   )2. —Could you  answer the question?

       —Sorry , there is _____ to think about it.

       A. not time    B. no time    C. not times    D. no times

(   )3. Lucy often goes swimming in  summer , _____.

      A. so does Mike           B. so is Mike

      C. so Mike does           D. Mike does so

(   )4. I _____ you can  come to my  birthday party.

       A. speak    B. hope     C. talk      D. say

(   )5. All of  her _____ friends are now  outside the door.

       A. others    B. another     C. other    D. the other

(   )6. There is  some bread _____ the plate.

      A. with     B. to     C. on     D. in

(   )7. —Could you  pass me the  candle , please?   —_____.

       A. Yes. Here are  you      B. Yes. Here you  are  

       C. Yes. Here is  it         D. No , thank you

(   )8. _____ interesting film it  is !

       A. What an    B. What a     C. How    D. How an

(   )9. —What present _____ your father _____ you for  your birthday?

      —A new  school bag.

      A. does , give    B. did , give    C. is , giving    D. did , gave

(   )10. Last year the  farmers had a  good harvest ___ much of  China.

       A. on        B. at       C. in      D. from

(   )11. Yesterday his  birthday party ___ at six  o' clock and ___ to ten.

        A. starts , goes           B. started , went on

        C. started , went         D. starts , went on

(   )12. The best time ____ to their country is  in autumn.

        A. goes      B. go     C. going     D. to go

(   )13. I' ll stay at  home. It is  raining ____ outside.

       A. heavily    B. heavy     C. big     D. large

(   )14. Tell her  to wear the  red feather ____ her new  hat , please.

        A. on      B. in      C. at       D. above

(   )15. —I hope you  can go to  the cinema with us.

       —I' m sorry , _____ I can' t.

       A. so      B. and      C. because      D. but

(   )16. They are  up ____ in the kitchen.

        A. all the foods         B. the all foods

        C. the all food         D. all the food

(   )17. We are  going to _____ a party on  Saturday.

        A. make       B. do      C. have      D. had

(   )18. He will stay here for _____.

        A. more two days          B. two more day

        C. another two days        D. two another days

(   )19. —I' m sorry , but I' ve lost your pen.  — _____.

       A. It doesn' t matter         B. All right

       C. It' s a pleasure           D. That' s right

(   )20. I' m a  student , _____.

       A. so Ann  am            B. so am Ann

       C. so is Ann              D. so Ann is

五、介词填空:

 1.“I' m going to  his birthday party ______ half ______ four _____ the     afternoon. What ______ you?”

   “I think I' ll go ______ you.”

 2. Polly gave Ann  a feather ______ her birthday.

 3. The doorbell is  ringing. Who is ______ the door?

 4. The weather here is  very different ______ England' s ______ this       time ______ year.

 5. Mike often goes swimming ______ a lake ______ his home ______     summer.

 6. Thanks a  lot for asking me ______ your party.

六、句型变换:

 1. Ann is  going to have her  party at home. (划线提问)

   

 2. Most of  us went to  Ann' s party yesterday. (同上)

 3. The dumplings are  delicious. (改为感叹句)

 4. They are  beautiful clothes. (同上)

 5. They didn' t go  to the cinema  yesterday afternoon. (改为反意问句)

 6. The party starts at  half past seven in  the evening. (同上)

七、用所给动词的适当形式填空:

 1. Where _____ (be) Xiao Lin ? Sorry , I don' t know. But  I _______     (see) him in the  classroom a moment ago.

 2. Mr Smith _________ (work) in China in  1993. He enjoyed _______    (live) in China very much.

 3. Would you  like _________ (have) some  more milk?

 4. Thanks a  lot for _________ (ask) us to your birthday party.

 5. My sister ________ (do) her homework every evening , but now  she    _________ (write) a  letter to my  father.

 6. We _______ (have ) a party in  the classroom last Saturday evening.

   Most of  us ________ (enjoy) ________ (sing) very much.

 7. It _____ (be) hot today. But  I think it _____ (be) cool later on.

 8. We _____ (help) the workers ______ (run) the machines next month.

 9. There ______ (be) some bread on  the pate.

 10. Thanks a  lot for ________ (give) me such a  beautiful sweater.

    I' d ________ (love) ________ (wear) it.

八、改病句:

(   )1. The rain is  heavily , isn' t  it ? _______

         A         B     C  D

(   )2. How delicious sandwiches we  had this morning ! _______

        A              B         C      D

(   )3. When does the  game start yesterday afternoon? _______

        A    B            C         D

(   )4. I don' t like winter because it' s too much cold. _______

           A             B    C     D

(   )5. Look , the candles in the  cake are very beautiful. _______

                A     B          C   D

(   )6. Thanks you  for telling me  the good news. _______

         A        B   C        D

(   )7. The all  food was on  the table. The  sandwiches were on  the 

           A       B                            C

       plates , and the candles were on  the cake. _______

                           D

(   )8. What beautiful present! I  can wear it  in my new  hat. _______

        A             B           C     D

(   )9. The party starts at four , isn' t it? _______

       A         B  C       D

(   )10. Ann ran to the  door , and find Li  Lei outside. _______

            A      B           C            D

九、从 B 栏中选出 A 栏的答句, 填入括号内:

              A                       

(   )1. Shall we  go for a  walk?  

(   )2. When shall we  go this afternoon?

(   )3. You want to  go swimming , don' t you ?

(   )4. Shall we  leave at half past seven?

(   )5. Where shall we  go the day  after tomorrow?

(   )6. May I  speak to Ann , please?

(   )7. Would you  like to come to  my birthday party?

(   )8. Are you  free this evening?

            B

A. No , I don' t.

B. Let' s go  to the park.

C. Thank you. I  would love to  come.

D. No. Let' s leave at  eight o' clock.

E. Certainly.

F. Good idea!

G. Yes , I think so.

H. What about eight o' clock?  

初二英语第十九单元练习

一、找出与所给单词划线部分发音相同的一个单词:

(   )1. east        A. ready    B. piece     C. report    D. head

(   )2. temperature A. call      B. message   C. date     D. hand

(   )3. report      A. bought   B. October   C. porridge  D. popular

(   )4. wait        A. inside    B. lift       C. again    D. build

(   )5. stop        A. north     B. draw      C. your    D. office

(   )6. finished     A. called    B. laughed    C. waited   D. answered

(   )7. above      A. radio      B. long      C. strong   D. enough

(   )8. below       A. present    B. December C. second  D. telephone

(   )9. most       A. almost     B. October   C. move   D. soccer

(   )10. south      A. below      B. enough    C. town    D. north 

二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

 1. radio (复数)__________        2. break (过去式)_________

 3. above (反义词)_________       4. turn on (反义词组)___________

 5. fall (过去式)__________        6. stop (过去式)__________

 7. nine (序数词)_________        8. careful (名词)__________

 9. wait (现在分词)__________     10. long (反义词)_________

三、将下列汉语译成英语:

 1. 打开收音机__________________   2. 有空____________________

 3. 去散步___________________      4. 等公共汽车______________

 5. 华南_________________          6. 后天______________

 7. 零度以上_________________       8. 好得多_______________

 9. 取回某物_________________       10. 天气预报______________

四、选择填空:

(   )1. Be quick. They _____ us outside the  office.

      A. are waiting for        B. are waiting

      C. waited for           D. will wait

(   )2. Mr John came  here _____.

      A. got it back          B. got back it

      C. to get it  back        D. to get back it

(   )3. It' s very good radio _____.

       A. Turn on           B. Turn it on

      C. Turn on it          D. Turning it on

(   )4. There' s a  lot of wind today. _____ weather it  is!

       A. What bad            B. What a bad  

       C. How bad            D. How bad  a

(   )5. The colour TV  looks _____ now.

       A. much good   B. much well   C. much better   D. very well

(   )6. —How long _____ the rain _____ last night?

      —Is lasted two  hours.

      A. was , lasted   B. did , last    C. will , last   D. does , last

(   )7. —I' m sorry. I  broke your pen.  —_____. Don' t worry.

       A. That' s all right          B. All right

       C. That' s right             D. You' re welcome

(   )8. She wants to  get the book back , _____ she?

       A. isn' t     B. don' t      C. doesn' t      D. won' t

(   )9. The radio says Beijing will be _____.

       A. sun     B. rain     C. wind     D. cloudy

(   )10. I' m going to  have a birthday party. ____ you like to  come?

       A. Could        B. May       C. Would        D. Can

(   )11. I think the  sun will _____ later.

       A. come down    B. come in    C. come out    D. come up

(   )12. Don' t worry. They _____ everything ready soon.

        A. got       B. get      C. are getting       D. will get

(   )13. Shall we  have _____ work to do  tomorrow?

        A. much     B. a lot    C. many      D. a few

(   )14. The radio says there will be  rain _____.

       A. at the night           B. in the night

       C. on the night           D. in night

(   )15. The cloud will _____ quite quickly.

       A. lift     B. stop     C. turn     D. get

(   )16. Please help _____ lift the  heavy box.

        A. I       B. me      C. we      D. mine

(   )17. _____ do you  like better , tea or  coffee?

       A. When      B. How      C. What      D. Which

(   )18. I listen to  the weather report _____ the radio every day.

       A. at       B. in      C. on      D. by

(   )19. Fuzhou is _____ the southeast of  China.

       A. to       B. on      C. in      D. at

(   )20. _____ the flowers are  beautiful.

       A. The  most of    B. Most of   C. Most a    D. Of most

五、介词填空:

 1. We won' t go  to school ______ seven thirty.

 2. ______ night the  temperature will fall ______ zero again.

 3. Would you  please mend the  bike ______ me?

 4. Mike goes swimming in  the river ______ times.

 5. Why don' t you  have dinner ______ us this evening?

 6. I can  not sleep ______ the day-time.

 7. Would you  like to go ______ a walk ______ me now?

 8. There will be  a strong wind _____ the north of  the Huai River.

六、将下列句子改为否定句、疑问句, 并作肯定、否定回答:

 1. They will leave the  office at eleven.

    ____________________________________________________

    ____________________________________________________

    ____________________________________________________

 2. We shall go  to see our  English teacher tomorrow.

    ____________________________________________________

    ____________________________________________________

    ____________________________________________________

 3. It' ll be  windy this evening.

    ____________________________________________________

    ____________________________________________________

    ____________________________________________________

 4. There will be  a class meeting this afternoon.

    ____________________________________________________

    ____________________________________________________

    ____________________________________________________

 5. He will wait for  us at the  bus stop.

    ____________________________________________________

    ____________________________________________________

    ____________________________________________________

七、用所给动词的正确形式填空:

 1. I' m afraid the  rain _________ (stop) later  in the day.

 2. Thanks a  lot for your supper. I _________ (enjoy) it very much.

 3. They _________ (make) some kites next Sunday.

 4. I ________ (hope) you could come to  my party but  you didn' t.

 5. We often help the  old woman _________ (carry) water.

 6. Can your father _________ (write) in English?

 7. I _________ (not have) supper with my  mother last night.

 8. It' s eight o' clock now. Mum _____________ (write) a letter to  my     brother and I __________ (draw) a picture.

 9. Wei Hua's bike __________ (break) yesterdeay. He asked me ______    (mend) it this afternoon.

 10. Chen Hui _________ (have) his birthday the  day after tomorrow.

八、改病句:

(   )1. There is going to  have an English party this evening. _______

            A          B   C              D

(   )2. It' s raining heavily. Bringing me  a raincoat please. _______

       A          B      C        D

(   )3. People often listens to the  weather report every day. _______

              A     B   C             D

(   )4. I think the  weather will be very better soon. _______

         A                B    C         D

(   )5. Look! There are a lot  of apples in the  tree. _______

                 A     B     C    D

(   )6. What a fine day today! Let' s go  for walk outside. _______

         A        B         C          D

(   )7. Thank you  for come and  for the beautiful present. _______

        A        B   C           D

(   )8. There is nothing in the  room , isn' t there? _______

            A    B   C             D

(   )9. Shall you  come to our  house for supper? _______

        A            B       C   D

(   )10. I usually read a book for some time after I  go to bed. _____

                     A    B            C        D

九、阅读理解:

     Kate and Peter like sports. In  summer they swim and  in winter they skate. They are  planning a skate trip for  this weekend , but they don' t know about the  weather. It' s 7:30 now , and they are  listening to the  weather report on  the radio. The  weather-man is giving the  weather for the  weekend.

    “Friday is  going to be  cold and cloudy , but it' s not  going to rain. The  temperature is going to  be belwo zero. It' s going to  snow on Friday evening. Saturday and  Sunday are going to  be  cold and sunny.”

     Now Kate and  Peter are happy. The  weather is going to  be very nice for  a skate trip. They are  going to have a  good time on  the hills.

(   )1. Kate and  Peter like _____.

       A. listening to the  radio            B. watching TV

       C. sports                        D. music

(   )2. They are  planning _____ for this weekend.

       A. a class meeting              B. a party

       C. a game                    D. a skate trip

(   )3. They want to  know about _____.

       A. the rain    B. the food   C. the weather   D. the radio

(   )4. It _____ on Saturday and  Sunday.

      A. will rain             B. will be windy

      C. will be cloudy        D. will be cold and  sunny

(   )5. Kate and  Peter are happy because _____.

       A. the weather is  going to be  nice for a  skate trip

       B. they are going to  visit the friends

       C. They are going to  see their parents

       D. They are going to  have a good meal

初二英语第二十单元练习

一、找出与所给单词划线部分发音相同的一个单词:

(   )1. chips    A. school    B. sandwich  C. lunch    D. machine

(   )2. real     A. ready     B. east      C. season   D. hear

(   )3. cabbage A. vegetable  B. leg       C. dialogue  D. dog

(   )4. sugar    A. sell       B. sure      C. salt      D. set

(   )5. potato   A. carrot    B. candle    C. answer   D. radio

(   )6. tomato   A. from      B. photo    C. tonight   D. move

(   )7. fry      A. ready     B. fly       C. happy   D. usually

(   )8. pork    A. short      B. doctor    C. porridge  D. total

(   )9. salt      A. half       B. walk      C. fall      D. also

(   )10. sugar   A. similar    B. party      C. park    D. car 

二、按要求写出下列单词的相应形式:

 1. potato (复数)__________        2. popular (比较级)___________

 3. three (序数词)_________        4. sunny (比较级)__________

 5. free (反义词)__________        6. outside (反义词)_________

 7. fish (复数)_________           8. fry (形容词)_________

 9. careful (最高级)___________     10. five (序数词)__________

三、汉译英:

 1. 把…带回家__________________   2. 把…递给某人_____________

 3. 给…打电话__________________   4. 在露天_______________

 5. 这么多的书___________________ 6. 家里煮的_______________

 7. 外卖食品__________________    8. 在西北________________ 

 9. 最受欢迎的食物______________________  10. 炸鸡____________

四、选择填空:

(   )1. Mr Bruce will give us _____ to eat.

       A. everything different      B. something different

       C. different something      D. anything different

(   )2. Which is _____ popular , pork , beef , or chicken?

       A. more    B. the more    C. most    D. the most

(   )3. It is  raining _____ than  yesterday.

      A. more hard            B. much harder

      C. more harder          D. much more hard

(   )4. —Where is  Ann?      —She _____ in the library.

      A. must be    B. can be    C. will be    D. would be

(   )5. Mr Bruce is  not in. What _____ now?

       A. do we do            B. we will do

       C. shall we do           D. are we going do

(   )6. I like apples _____ of all.

      A. well      B. best      C. better      D. good

(   )7. —People eat  a lot of  beef in England.  —_____.

      A. So do we            B. So we do

      C. We so do            D. We do so

(   )8. I want to  cook something _____ English.

      A. really      B. real      C. an      D. to

(   )9. The cloud will lift quite _____.

       A. quick    B. well     C. quickly     D. fastly

(   )10. —Would you  like to come for  supper this evening? —____.

       A. Yes , please         B. Thank you , I' d love  to

       C. Yes , I want to      D. Don' t be so  nice

(   )11. —Would you  like a cup  of tea?  —_____.

       A. Yes , please    B. Excuse me    C. Well     D. Good

(   )12. Which is _____, this photo or  that one?

        A. much beautiful           B. the more beautiful

        C. more beautiful           D. most beautiful

(   )13. Would you  like to have ____ eggs for  your breakfast ?

        A. frying      B. fried      C. to fry      D. fries

(   )14. They often go  for a walk _____ the open air.

        A. in      B. at      C. on      D. to

(   )15. Please _____ me a ring when you  get there.

         A. do      B. make      C. give      D. take

(   )16. We have _____ books in  this library.

        A. so many     B. so much    C. too much    D. much too

(   )17. Chen Hui  will go to  a fish and  chip shop , _____.

        A. so Ann will            B. so does Ann

        C. so will Ann            D. so Ann does

(   )18. Robert likes tea  with _____ it.

        A. milks in            B. milk in

        C. milk on            D. the milk in

(   )19. I' ll help him _____ the box  upstairs.

        A. carrying    B. carry     C. carries    D. carried

(   )20. This meeting is _____ of all.

        A. the more important        B. most important

        C. the most important        D. more important

五、介词:

 1. I hope you  can come ______ my house ______ my birthday next Sunday.

 2. I like Chinese tea ______ nothing ______ it , please.

 3. Please listen ______ the weather report ______ the next twenty-four     hours.

 4. The snow will last a  week ______ the north ______ China.

 5. What food will they cook ______ the dinner?

 6. Please take the  radio home ______ your father.

 7. I think it' s much nicer ______ a paper bag.

 8. Thank you ______ coming and _____ the beautiful present.

六、用所给形容词、副词的适当形式填空:

 1. This TV  set is _________ (small) than that one  and it is ________     (cheap).

 2. I' m very ________ (hungry). But  Wang Hong is ________ (hungry)    it is.

 3. Are the  flowers on the  right __________ (beautiful) than  the ones      on the left?

 4. This orange is  very _________ (big). I  think it is ________(big) one    in the  basket.

 5. Does your father get  up _________ (early) in  your family?

 6. Which do  you like __________ (well) , apples or pears?

 7. The second truck is  carrying _________ (few) than  the first one.       The third one  is carrying _________ (few) of all.

 8. Her mother says tha t it must be  much __________ (delicious).

 9. Li Ping is _________ (tall) in his  class.

七、句型变换:

 1. We shall cook some chicken for  supper. (划线提问)

 2. We' ll wait for  you outside the  school gate. (同上)

 3. It' ll be  sunny tomorrow. (同上)

 4. In England , the most popular food is  fish and chips. (同上)

 5. The Kings are  going to have real Chinese food tomorrow evening.

 (同上)

 

6. You can  be here at  seven o' clock. (改为反意问句)

 7. He went to  the zoo with his  friend. (同上)

 8. There was  a call for  him. (同上)

 9. My brother doesn' t like beef. (同上)

 10. Fish and  chips are dilicious. (改为感叹句)

八、用所给动词的正确形式填空:

 1. Li Lei ____________ (not do) his homework yesterday evening. He     ___________ (write) a  latter to his  father.

 2. It _________ (rain)  heavily now. But  the radio says it _______ (be)    sunny tomorrow.

 3. Listen! A  lot of sutdents _________ (sing) in the  next classroom.

 4. Everything __________ (begin) to grow when spring comes.

 5. His home __________ (not be) far from here. It' ll take only ten       minutes ________ (walk) there.

 6. Sorry , I can' t _________ (go) with you  this afternoon. I  have a lot    of work _________ (do).

 7. I usually _________ (go) to school by  bus. But she  usually ______    (go) to school on  foot.

 8. Thanks a  lot for _________ (ask) me to your English party.

 9. He _________ (study) in the  south ten years ago.

 10. The radio _________ (say) the wind _________ (stop) later on.

九、选择正确译文:

(   )1. 只要花十分钟就能走到警察局。

    A. It takes only ten  minutes to walk to  the police station.

    B. It only takes ten  minutes walking to  the police station.

    C. Ten minutes will be  enough walking to  the police station.

(   )2. 我想明天天气不会好转。

    A. I think it  won' t be better tomorrow.

    B. I think it  will be better tomorrow.

    C. I don' t think it  will be better tomorrow.

(   )3. 他最喜欢西红柿。

    A. He likes tomatoes better.

    B. He likes tomatoes best of  all.

    C. He is like tomatoes best of  all.

(   )4. 请到我家吃晚饭吧!

    A. Please you come to  my house to  have supper.

    B. Come to my  house have supper , please.

    C. Please come  to  my house for  supper.

(   )5. 今晚我校将放映一部英语影片。

    A. There will be  a English film in  our school this evening.

    B. There is going to  be an English film in  our school tonight.

    C. There is going to  have an English film this evening.

(   )6. 老师要我们去打扫教室。  

    A. The teacher asked us  to clean the  classroom.

    B. The teacher asked we  to cleaned the  classroom.

    C. The teacher asked us  cleaned the classroom. 

初二英语单元测试(Unit 15—Unit 17)

 

听力部分(20分)

1. 听句子, 选择你所听到的单词: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. thick        B. sits      C. its         D. six

(   )2. A. street       B. free      C. tree       D. three

(   )3. A. monkeys   B. Monday  C. month    D. mouth

(   )4. A. way        B. why      C. write      D. right

(   )5. A. sing        B. think     C. thing      D. ring

2. 听对话, 选择正确的答案回答问题: (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. A. It' s Monday.                 B. It' s Sunday.

       C. It' s February.                D. It' s six fifteen

(   )2. A. I went to  have breakfast.      B. I went to  school.

       C. I went to  the park.            D. I went boating.

(   )3. A. Lily feels full.                B. Lily feels hungry.

       C. Lily feels fine.                D. Lily feels well.

(   )4. A.They are talking about the  time.

       B. They are talking about their classroom.

       C. They are talking about the  weather.

       D. They are talking about their shoes.

(   )5. A. He is picking apples.      B. He is playing a  game.

       C. He is holding a  ladder.  

       D. He is looking for  his friend.

 3. 听录音, 选择下原句意思相似的句子: (每小题念两遍)

(   )1. A. They bought many books yesterday.

      B. They bought a  lot of oranges yesterday.

      C. Jim bought many apples yesterday.

      D. Jim' s sister bought a  lot of oranges yesterday.

(   )2. A.We helped the  farmers to pick oranges last Sunday.

       B. We helped the  farmers pick apples last Sunday.

        C. They helped the  farmers to pick oranges last Tuesday.

       D. They helped the  farmers pick apples last Tuesday.

(   )3. A. Li Ping likes spring.      B. Li Ping likes autumn.

       C. Lucy likes spring.        D. Lucy likes autumn.

(   )4. A. It' s so warm in  the room.

         Why don' t you  take off your coat?

       B. It' s so warm in  the room.

         Why don' t you  take off your sweater?

       C. It' s so old  in the room.

          Why n ot put  on your coat?

        D. It' s so cold in  the room.

          Why not put  on your sweater?

(   )5. A. Bruce is at  home.       B. Bruce is away.

       C. Bruce is at  the shop.   D. Bruce is  at the cinema

四. 听录音, 选出你所听到的电话号码: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. 322148    B. 311482     C. 311248    D. 311284

(   )2. A. 996656    B. 669965     C. 696965    D. 969656

(   )3. A. 886152    B. 886652     C. 881652    D. 888152

 五. 听录音, 选出该词的反义词: (每小题念一遍)

(   )1. A. heavy    B. early     C. day    D. full

(   )2. A. small     B. open    C. long    D. outside

(   )3. A. young    B. night     C. down    D. closed

      六. 听对话, 填表格: (对话念两遍)

笔试部分(80分)

一、找出下列各组中单词划线部分发音不同的单词:8%

(   )1. A. message      B. paper      C. village      D. passage

(   )2. A. warm        B. party       C. harvest    D. park

(   )3. A. season       B. speak      C. read        D. weather

(   )4. A. snow        B. down       C. grow       D. window

(   )5. A. weather      B. birthday    C. fourth      D. throw

(   )6. A. enjoyed      B. laughed     C. cleaned    D. carried

(   )7. A. wet          B. vegetable   C. December  D. men

(   )8. A. country       B. blouse      C. flower      D. trousers        二、A、根据句意,填入适当的词:6%

 1. Which colour do  you like ________, red , yellow or blue?

 2. ________ the weather like today? It' s hot.

  3. I' m sorry I  was out when you _______. My mother answered the  telephone.

 4. Friday comes ________ Thursday.

 5. ________ beautiful pictures they are!

 6. Lucy is  different ________ her  father.

    B、汉译英:10%

 1. They' re ________ the ________. (在看电影)

  2. I' m afraid they are  not _______ _______ to  pick the apples. (足够多的人)

  3. The farmers _______ _______ with the  apple harvest. (在…方面需要帮助)

 4. We have _______ _______ every day. (明媚的阳光)

 5. Spring in  England can last from _______ _______. (三月下旬)

三、选择题:16%

(   )1. Could I ____ Jim , please ?

       A. say     B. speak      C. speak to     D. tell

(   )2. There was  a telephone call ____ you.

       A. on    B. in    C. for    D. of

(   )3. I ____ on a  piece of paper.

       A. write down it         B. writed down it

       C. wrote it down        D. wrote down it

(   )5. I must get  ready ____ the meeting now.

       A. for      B. of     C. at    D. in

(   )6. The Greens ____ a good time in  the park last Sunday.

       A. have     B. had     C. has     D. were

(   )7. Green is  a policeman , ____?

       A. is he    B. isn' t he    C. isn' t Green    D. is not he

(   )8. There are  not ____ English books in  our library (图书馆).

        A. a lot of      B. lots of     C. much     D. many

(   )9. —____ part of England does your teacher come from? 

       —London.

        A. What      B. Where     C. That     D. Which

(   )10. —Who called me  this morning?

        —____ was your mother.

        A. That     B. This     C. She     D. It

(   )11. They ____ in the  river in summer.

        A. enjoy to swim           B. enjoy swimming

        C. enjoyed to swim         D. enjoyed swimming

(   )12. —Who is ____?   —This is  Mary speaking.

        A. this      B. you     C. that      D. he

(   )13. In our  village it is ____ hot in  July.

         A. very much    B. much too   C. too much   D. many too

(   )14. Sorry , I ____ you about it.

        A. forget to tell          B. forget telling

        C. forgot to tell          D. forgot telling

(   )15. The best time __ to come to  China is in  spring or in  autumn.

        A. come       B. came      C. coming      D. to come

(   )16. She rings up  his father ____ the telephone.

      A. in     B. at     C. on    D. to

四、句型转换:8%

 1. She did  the work yesterday afternoon. (改为一般疑问句)

   _______ she _______ the work yesterday afternoon ?

 2. Jim and  his friends went to  help the furmers. (划线提问)

   _______ _______ Jim and his  friend _______ to help ?

 3. Jim is  from England. (同上)  _______ is Jim from?

 4. He was  ill yesterday so  he didn' t go  to school. (同上)

   _______ _______ he go to  school ?

 5. There' s a  lot of snow today. (同义句替代)

    It' s _______ _______.

 6. The rain was  very heavy last night. (同上)

   It _______ _______ last night.

 7. What a  delicious cake ! (同上)    _______ _______ the  cake is !

 8. Summer lasts three months in  the USA. (同2)

    _______ _______ does summer last in  the USA.

五、介词填空:12%

 1. It' s not  very good ______ the moment.

 2. Jim , you must look ______ your brother. He' s young.

 3. —Thank you ______ telling me  the news.  —Not ______ all.

 4. The weather is  very cold ______ winter.

 5. It' s very cold ______ this time ______ year ______ America.

 6. Autumn last ______ August ______ October in  China.

 7. She was  born ______ Marth 4th , 1987.

 8. In much ______ Chian , spring is  very short.

六、改错:5%

(   )1. He never works in a  hospital , doesn' t he ?

            A     B   C               D

(   )2. It' s cold. You' d better putting on  the coat.

            A       B         C           D

(   )3. The sun shines bright.

       A    B    C     D

(   )4. Would you  like come to  my supper.

         A         B   C            D

(   )5. In autumn the  leaves (叶子) turn to  brown.

       A    B           C               D

 七、根据所提供的情景, 选择所给的句子完成下列对话.每句用一次.10%

 a. It' s a  pleasure.       b. Thank you        c. The same to  you.

 d. It doesn' t matter.    e. No , thank you.    f. Yes , that' s right.

 g. What about you?     h. Here you are.     i. Yes , please.

 j. Thank you  all the same.

 1. —I' m going to  Ann' s party. ____?

   —I' m afraid. I  can' t because I  have a lot  of work to  do.

 2. —Happy birthday !     —____.

 3. —Happy New  Year.    —____.

 4. —Sorry , I don' t know that. You' d better ask  our teacher. —___.

 5. —Thanks a  lot for giving Lucy the  message for me  —____.

 6. —Would you  like some more food?  —____. I' m full.

 7. —I' m afraid I  can' t go to  the cinema with you.  —____.

 8. —Would you  like another piece of  meat?

   —____. Thank you  very much.

 9. —May I  have some fish , please?   —Sure! ____.

 10. —Our class starts  at  half past seven , doesn' t it ?  —____.

八、阅读理解:5%

Boys or  Girls

     A lot of  boys and girls in  western (西方的) countries are  wearing the same kinds of  clothes , and many of  them have long hair , so it' s aften difficult (困难的) to tell wether (是否) they are boys or  girls.

     One day an  old man went for  a walk in  the park in  Washington (华盛顿) , and when he  was tired (疲劳), he sat down on  a chair by  a lake. A  young person (人) was standing on  the other side of  the lake.

    “Oh,”the  old man said to  the  person sitting next to  him on the  chair.“Do  you see that person with the  pants (宽裤) and long hair ? Is  it a boy  or a girl ?”

    “A girl ,”said his  neighbour.“She' s my  daughter.”

    “Oh ,”the old  man said quickly.“Please forgive me.  I didn' t know that you  were her mother.”“I' m not ”said the  other person.“I' m her father.”

(   )1. What did  the man see  on the other side of  the lake?

       A. A girl    B. A boy     C. A young person    D. A man

(   )2. Is it  a boy or  a girl ?“it”in this sentence means ____.

       A. he      B. she      C. that person     D. the lake

(   )3. The meaning of“forgive”is ____.

       A. 忘记      B. 责备    C. 放弃    D. 原谅

(   )4. The old  man thought his  neighbour (邻居) was ____.

       A. a woman      B. a man     C. a girl     D. a boy

(   )5. The old  man took his  neighbour for the  girl' s mother because        his neighbour ____.

       A. wore a skirt          B. had a beautiful face

       C. had long hair         D. was shy

 初二英语抽考试卷

 一、找出划线部分读音不同的单词:10%

 (   )1. A. w or k      B. w or se      C. doct or     D. w or ld

 (   )2. A. pre s ent    B.  s trong    C. i s         D. the s e

 (   )3. A. t al k       B. t a ll        C.  al ways    D. c a ll

 (   )4. A. nor th      B. sou th      C. bir th day   D. wea th er

 (   )5. A. help ed     B. answer ed   C. listen ed    D. stay ed 

 二、词汇:10%

     (一)根据句子意思,用适当的词填空:5%

  1. Please call me  tomorrow. My _________ number is .

  2. Last week my  father bought a  new watch as  my birthday ________.

  3. It is  very hot in  summer. It' s ________ to wear cool clothes.

  4. The temperature will ________ above zero in  the day-time.

  5. In autumn the  days  get shorter and  the nights get ________.

     (二)根据括号内汉语意思,完成下列句子:5%

  1. Will you _______ _______ (等候) me at the  bus stop?

  2. Spring in  England can last from _______ _______(三月底) to May.

  3. It is  cold today , but it  is going to  be warmer _______ _______(过后).

  4. _______ _______(天气预报) for the next twenty-four hours.

  5. The flowers start to _______ _______ (开花) in spring.

 三、选择题:30%

 (   )1. What would you  like _____ now?

       A. play      B. playing     C. to play    D. for playing

 (   )2. There ____ an English party this Saturday.

       A. is going to  have         B. is going to  be

       C. are going to  have        D. are going to  be

 (   )3. Picking apples is _____ hard work.

       A. a      B. an     C. one      D. /

 (   )4. Your sister went to  the park last week , _____?

       A. wasn' t she         B. did she    

       C. didn' t she          D. does she

 (   )5. They visited our  school and we  visited _____.

        A. them      B. they      C. their      D. theirs

 (   )6. Who called me  this morning?   _____ was your mother.

       A. That      B. This      C. She       D. It

 (   )7.“She isn' t a  student , is she?” “_____. She  is a teacher.”

        A. Yes , she isn' t.          B. No , she is.

        C. Yes , she is.             D. No , she isn' t.

 (   )8. What a _____ wind! It' s blowing _____.

        A. strong , strongly             B. strong , strong

        C. strongly , strong              D. strongly , strongly

 (   )9. Usually in  winter there' s _____ ice in the  north.

        A. little      B. many      C. too much      D. much too

 (   )10. In _____ of China , spring is  usually very short.

         A. much       B. many     C. few      D. little

 (   )11. Can you  see _____ moon in _____ day time?

        A. the , the    B. the , a     C. a , the      D. a , /

 (   )12. Who has _____ dumplings , Li Lei  or Zhao Hua?

         A. the fewest     B. fewer     C. less      D. many

 (   )13. —Why did  you come here so  late?

        —Sorry. I _____ the bus.

        A. missed      B. caught      C. took      D. got on

 (   )14. Tai Wan  is _____ the east of  China.

         A. at         B. in        C. on       D. to

 (   )15. Father and  I often get  up at six. So _____ my motheer.

        A. is      B. gets     C. does      D. did

 (   )16. Will you  make me a  plane ? _____.

         A. I' m glad                    B. I' ll be glad

         C. I' m going to  be glad         D. I' ll  be glad to

 (   )17. Excuse me , may I  ask you a  question?  Yes. _____.

        A. You ask                  B. Anything else

        C. What is wrong            D. What is it

 (   )18. May I  borrow your ruler? _____.

        A. Never mind        B. Yes , here it to  you

        C. Yes , it is here      D. Yes , here you are

 (   )19. I think you  are a good student . _____

        A. No , I' m not.           B. It' s very kind of  you to say  so

        C. No , I don' t think so    D. That' s all right

 (   )20. How did  you go to  the zoo? _____

      A. I liked it            B. I had  a present

      C. By bike             D. Many people were there

 四、按括号内的要求改写句子,每格一个单词:10%

  1. There was  a lot of  sunshine yesterday. (同义转换)

     It was _______ _______ yesterday.

  2. There is  a book  on  the desk. (改为复数)

    There are  a _______ _______ on the desk.

  3. Kate read the  book. (变反意疑问句)

    Kate read the  book , ________ _______?

  4. The dumplings are  delicious. (改为感叹句)

    _______ _______ the dumplings are.

  5. The students worked  very  hard  on the  farm. (划线提问)

     _______ ______ the  students work on  the farm?

 五、口语运用:10%

 (   )1. ①And what' s the  date today?

       ②Excuse me.  What day is  it today?

       ③It' s June 1st.        ④It' s  Saturday.

       ⑤Oh , it' s Children' s Day. I' ll take my  son to the  park.

        A. ②③①④⑤   B. ①③②④⑤  C. ①③⑤②④   D. ②④①③⑤

 (   )2. ①How do you  know?      ②Yes , it' s bad  now.

        ③No , it won' t. I  think it' ll get  better soon.

       ④Will it  last long?    ⑤What bad weather! I  don' t like the  rain.

        A. ④③⑤②①   B. ⑤②④③①   C. ⑤④②③①    D. ①②④③⑤

 (   )3. ①Could you see  any good apples on  the tree?

       ②Yes. Don' t worry.     

       ③Yes. Behind you! Can  you reach them?

       ④Are  you holding the  ladder , Bill?

       ⑤Oh , I can  see them. But  I can' t reach them.

       A. ④⑤②①③   B. ①②③④⑤   C. ①③⑤②④    D. ④②①③⑤

 (   )4. ①Hello! This is Tom  speaking. Can I  speak to Bill?

       ②Well. Could you  ask him to  call me back?

       ③Sure.   ④See you later.    ⑤I' m afraid he' s out.

        A. ①②③④⑤   B. ①②⑤④③   C. ④②⑤①③   D. ①⑤②③④

 (   )5. ①Can I take a  bus?

       ②Go  down this street , and take the  second turning on  the left.

       ③Excuse me , which is  the way to  Putian Hospital?

       ④Of  course. You can  take the No. 2 bus.

       ⑤Thanks a  lot.

       A. ④⑤③②①   B. ③②①④⑤   C. ①③②④⑤    D. ③②④①⑤

 六、从下列七个单词中选择5个,并用适当的形式填空:10%

 clean , fall , do , close , say , be , have

     Good morning , boys and  girls. I have something to  tell you. This morning we ________ four classes. This afternoon , we are  going to do  some ________ after  school. The radio ________ it will be  windy at  night , so don' t forget ________ the doors and  windows. The temperature _______ below zero tomorrow morning. Please remember to  put on more warm clothes.

 七、根据图画内容,在下列短文的空格内填入适当的单词,使短文完整、正确、通顺(每个空格限填一个单词)。10%

     It is _______ the  first today. 

 Li  Ming  doesn' t go  to school. 

 His _______ don' t need to go to 

 work , either. What are  they doing 

 now ? Look! Li  Ming' s father is

 _______ a _______.  His mother 

 is _______ some _______, and Li 

 Ming  himself is ________ to the ________. He  wants to know the  weather in the  afternoon. He' s going to  play _______ if it is _______.

 八、完形填空:10%

     Some people have very good memories (记忆力) and can easily learn quite long poems (诗歌) by heart. Other people have 1___ memories and  can only 2___ things when they have said them 3___ and over again.

     A good 4___ is a  great help in  5___ a language (语言). Everybody learns 6___ own language 7___ remembering what he  hears 8___ he is  a small child. Some children , like those who  live abroad (国外) with their parents , seem to  learn two languages as  9___ as they do  one. In school it  is not so  easy for pupils to  learn a second language because they have very 10___ time for  it.

     Memory is like a  diary that we  keep every day.

 (   )1. A. ill    B. poor     C. badly    D. rich

 (   )2. A. remember   B. find      C. forget      D. know

 (   )3. A. for         B. twice     C. over      D. once

 (   )4. A. student      B. child      C. teacher    D. memory

 (   )5. A. learning      B. knowing  C. doing     D. having

 (   )6. A. their         B. his        C. my       D. your

 (   )7. A. from         B. about     C. of        D. by

 (   )8. A. since         B. if         C. when    D. before

 (   )9. A. carefully      B. easily      C. early     D. slowly

 (   )10. A. little         B. a little     C. few      D. a few

 九、阅读理解: 20%

 A

 In  England , people often talk about the  weather because they can  experience (经历) four seasons  in  one day. In  the morning the  weather is warm just like in  spring. An hour later black clouds come and  then it rains hard. The  weather gets a  little cold. In  the late afternoon the  sky will be  sunny , the sun will begin to  shine , and it will be  summer at this time of  a day.

 In  England , people can also have summer in  winter , or have winter in  summer. So in  winter they can  swim sometimes , and in  summer sometimes they should take warm clothes.

 When  you go to  England , you will see  that some English people usually take an  umbrella (伞) or a  raincoat with them in  the sunny morning , but you  should not laugh at  them.

 If  you don' t take an  umbrella or a  raincoat , you will regret (后悔) later in the  day.

 (   )1. Why do  people in England often talk about the  weather?

     A. Because they may  have four seasons in  one day.

     B. Because they often have very good weather.

     C. Because the weather is  warm just like in  spring.

     D. Because the sky  is sunny all  day.

 (   )2. From the  story we know that _____ come and  then there is  a              heavy rain.

      A. sunshine and snow         B. black clouds

      C. summer and winter         D. spring and autumn

 (  )3.“Peple can  also have summer in winter.”means “I is                      sometimes too _____ in winnter.”

      A. warm       B. cool      C. cold      D. rainy

 (   )4. In the  sunny morning some English people usually take a                  raincoat or an  umbrella with them because _____.

      A. their friends ask  them to do  so

      B. it often rains in  England

      C. they are going to  sell them

       D. they are their favourite things

 (   )5. The best title (标题) for this passae is _____.

     A. Bad seasons                   B. Summer or Winter

     C. The Weather in  England        D. Strange English People

 B

 What  a fine day! The  sun is shining and  everything looks bright. Can  you feel the  heat (热) when you  stand in the  sun? The sun  gives the heat from very far  away. It is  hard to believe that the  sun is about one  hundred and fifty million kilometres away. The  sun looks small because it  is so far  from us , but its  really very huge.

 The  earth moves round the  sun. It takes one  year for the  earth to go  around the sun. And  at the same time the  earth itself is  spinning (自转) around once evern twenty-four hours.

 The  sun gives us  light. It keeps us  warm. It makes things grow. Plants , animals and  people need the  sun. We can  not live without it.

 (   )1. The sun  looks small because its _____.

     A. about one hundred and  fifty million metres away from us

     B. very far away from the  earth

     C. not very huge              D. next to us

 (   )2. The earth goes round the  sun _____.

     A. twice a year            B. twlve times a  yeaar

     C. once a year             D. four times a  year

 (   )3. It takes the  earth _____ hours to spin around twice.

     A. twice      B. twenty0-four    C. thirty-six    D. forty-eight

 (   )4. The sun  gives us _____.

     A. heat and light          B. light   

     C. heat                   D. bright twelve hours

 (   )5. The sun  makes _____ grow.

     A. plants                B. animals

     C. people                D. plants , animals and people

 初二英语练习卷

 一、找出划线部分读音不同于其它三个的词:5%

 (   )1. A. photo s       B. bag s       C. make s      D. ha s

 (   )2. A. need ed       B. play ed     C. turn ed     D. carri ed

 (   )3. A. san d wich    B.  d esk       C.  d ry        D. stu d ent

 (   )4. A.  al ways       B.  al so       C. s al t        D. b al l

 (   )5. A. ph o to        B. t o night    C. t o mato    D. p o tato 

 二、根据句意填入适当的词:10%

  1. Could ylu ________ the telephone.

  2. But there were not ________ people to  pick them.

  3. Evering begins to ________ in spring.

  4. It' s very ________ from Australia at  this time of  year.

  5. Summer ________ ________ spring.

  6. It' s going to  be warmer ________ on.

  7. We have ________ sunshine every day!

  8. I can  wear it ________ my new  hat.

  9. ________ of North and  South China will have a  cold wet day.

 三、选择填空:15%

 (   )1. Your sister went to  the park last week , _____?

     A. wasn' t she     B. did she     C. didn' t she     D. does she

 (   )2. —What are  you doing?

       —I' m _____ the child , He should be  back for lunch now.

     A. looking                 B. looking up    

     C. looking for              D. looking after

 (   )3. There' s _____ ice in the  north.

     A. few      B. many     C. too much     D. much too

 (   )4. It' s raining very __ now. Would you  like to close the  window?

      A. heavy       B. heavier       C. heaviest      D. heavily

 (   )5. _____ nice weather it  is!

     A. what a       B. How a       C. What      D. How

 (   )6. Don' t forget _____ tell him.

     A. on      B. at      C. for     D. to

 (   )7. She is  in Class One. So _____.

     A. am I      B. I am     C. is she      D. is it

 (   )8. There isn' t _____ milk in  the bottle.

     A. some      B. any     C. no    D. little

 (   )9. I' m glad to  meet you here. _____.

     A. It' s you    B. The same to  you      C. Me too    D. All same

 (   )10. It' ll _____ 10 minutes to  do the work.

      A. spend      B. takes      C. take      D. cost

 (   )11. The cloud is _____. The  sun is coming out.

      A. falling      B. lifting      C. lefting      D. backing

 (   )12. Weather report _____ the next twenty-four hours.

     A. for       B. in       C. of       D. about

 (   )13. Please _____ the TV.

      A. turn on      B. drne     C. open     D. turns on

 (   )14. The radio _____ the snow will stop later.

      A. says      B. tells     C. speaks      D. say

 (   )15. I was  born _____ July 1st , 1975.

     A. in      B. on     C. at      D. by

 四、句型转换:16%

  1. These apples are  red. (改为反意问句)

     These apples are  red , __________?

  2. I got  up at six  this morning. He got  up at six , too. (同义转换)

    So _______ _______.

  3. His bike is  nice. (改为感叹句)

    _______ _______ the watch is!

    _______ _______ _______ watch  it is!

  4. Shall we  go out for  a walk?

    _______ _______ going out for  a walk?

  5. I have much work to  do.

    I have _______ _______ _______ work to  do.

  6. It' s  February 28th  today. (划线提问)

     _______ _______ _______ today?

 五、看图填空:10%

  1. A: What' s the _______ _______?

    B: It' s _______.

  2. A: Which _______ do you  like best.

     _______, _______, _______, or _______?

   B: I think I  like _______ best.

   A: Why?

   B: Well , I like _______ in the  river.

 六、用所给动词的适当形式填空:14%

  1. I like _______ (read) books. Now  I would like _______ (speak) to            my friend.

  2. There _______ (be) some birds in  the tree. When we  looked up.

  3. The ice  is so thin. You' d better ____________ (not play) on it.

  4. Can pick __________ (speak) a little chinese now ?

  5. Look , the wind __________ (blow) strongly.

  6. Two hnours ago. Bruce _______ (come) here. _______ (ask) you to          his party. He ________ (want) you _______ (ring) him.

  7. The rain _______ (be) very heavy lart night.

  8. Let him _______ (go) to see  the film with us.

  9. He _______ (spend) much of  his time on  English.

  10. It' s winter now. It' s _______ (get) colder and  colder.

 七、完型填空:12%

 Mr  Jones and Mr  Brown worked in  the same 1___. One  day Mr Jones 2___ to Mr  Brown ,“We are  going to 3___ a small party at  our house 4___ Wednesday evening. Will you  and your wife come?”

 Mr  Brwon said ,“Thank you very much. That is  very kind of  you. We are  5___ that evening. I  think , but I will telephone my  wife and ask  her. Perhaps she  wants to go  some-where that 6___.”So Mr  Brown went to  7___ room and telephone. When he  came back. he  looked very surprised (惊讶).“What' s the matter?”said Mr  Jones,“Did you  8___ to your wife?”

 “No,”answered Mr  Brown,“she wasn' t there. my  son answered the  9___. I said to  him , ‘Is your mother there David?’and he  answered,‘No , she is  not in the  house.’10___ is she  then?‘she is  some where outside’11___ is she doing?‘she 12___me!’”

 (   )1. A. room     B. office      C. desh      D. bus

 (   )2. A. said       B. told       C. spoke    D. talked

 (   )3. A. get        B. take       C. make    D. have

 (   )4. A. next       B. last        C. in       D. at

 (   )5. A. busy       B. clever      C. free      D. happy

 (   )6. A. morning   B. ofternoon   C. evening  D. season

 (   )7. A. other       B. the other   C. my      D. their

 (   )8. A. say        B. tell         C. talk      D. speak

 (   )9. A. phone      B. question    C. letter     D. words

 (   )10. A. When     B. Why       C. Where    D. What

 (   )11. A. When      B. What       C. Where    D. Why

 (   )12. A. looked for               C. looks for

        C. is going to  look for       D. is looking for  

 八、根据短文,填入所缺单词:10%

 Tomorrow North China will be _______. But  the cloud will lift tomorrow evening. There will be  a north ________. The ________ will be  4 to 15℃ In  Xingjiang there will be  a strong wind. There will be  a heavy _______ tomorrow night.  The  temperture will _______ below zero. But  the snow will not  last long.

 To  the south of  the Yellow Kiver _______ will be  a north west wrnd. It  will be cloudy , too.

 South china will be _______ , but the  rain will _______ later on.  The sun will _______ our. The  temperature will be _______ 25℃.

 九、阅读理解:

 The  Importance (重要性) of the  sun

 What  a fine day! The  sun is shining and  everything looks bright. Can  you feel the  heat when you  stand in the  sun? The sun  gives the heat from very far  away. It' s hard to  beliele. that the  sun is about one  hundred and fifty million kilometres away. The  sun looks small because it  is so far  from us. but  it' s really very huge.

 The  earth wicles the  sun. It takes one  year for the  earth to go  wround the sun. And  at the same time the  earth itself is  spinning (转) around once every twenty-four hours.

 The  sun gives us  light. It keeps us  warm. It makes things grow. Plants animals and  people need the  sun. We can' t live without the  sun.

 判断正误,正确用“T”,错误用“F”:

 (   )1. On a  fine day everything is  bright because the  sun is shining.

 (   )2. The sun  gives us heat  and  light.

 (   )3. It' s about 150 , 000 , 000 kilometres from the  earth to the  sun.

 (   )4. In fact the  sun isn' t very big  because it' s too  far away from us.

 (   )5. It takes the  earth 24 hours to  go around the  sun.

 (   )6. We can' t live without the  sun because all  the living things on             the earth depend on  the sun.

 初二英语期中考练习卷

 一. 在下列各组单词中选出一个划线部分读音与所给单词的划线部分读音一样的单词.

 (   ) 1. worri ed    A.clean ed    B.wait ed      C.pass ed   D.stopp ed 

 (   ) 2. tom a to    A.c a rrot    B.h a ppily      C.pot a to   D.p art y

 (   ) 3. ea s ily     A. s top      B. s andwich    C.we s t     D.pre s ent

 (   ) 4. fea th er    A.wea th er   B. nor th east    C. th in     D.sou th 

 (   ) 5.  wh ose    A .wh ole     B. wh en       C. wh ile    D. wh ich 

 (   ) 6. veget a ble  A.sk a te     B.t a ble        C.anim a l    D.p a per

 (   ) 7. sug ar      A.h ar d      B.poul ar      C.p ar k      D.st ar t

 (   ) 8. sea s o ns   A.wink o w s   B. map s      C.ticket s     D.duck s 

 (   ) 9. bri gh t     A.enou gh    B. thele ph one  C. ph oto  D.ei gh t

 (   ) 10. dr y       A.read y       B.quickl y     C.empt y   D.Jul y 

 二. 找出适当的字母或字母组合, 使单词完整. 正确

 (   )1. t__l_ph__ne   A. a…i…o   B. e…e…o  C.e…e…oa Da…e…o

 (   )2. happ__   A. yly    B. ily    C. ly        D. ely

 (   )3. ____cken   A. shi    B. the    C. chi     D. che

 (   )4. v ___g__t__ble  A. a…i…a   B. e…i…e C. a…e…i  D.e e…a

 (   )5. c__f__lly  A. air …i  B. ere…u  C. are…u  D. ear…i

 (   )6. usu___   A. ally     B. aly     C. elly     D. ely

 (   )7. b__t__ful__  A.eau…e    B.eau…i    C. ea…i    D. ea…e

 (  )8. Aug____    A. ust     B. ist      C. est      D. ast

 (  )9. aut__m __   A. u…e   B.u…n    C. e…n    D. i…m

 (  )10. plea ____  A. ture     B. sion    C. tion     D. sure

 三. 用所给词的正确形式填空:

   1. My coat is  too _____. My brother's coat is _____ than mine. (big)

   2. There are  many ____ in the sky  today.  It's _____. (coud)

   3. This boy  is very _____. He can  do the work _____. (care)

   4. The ________on the  desk are theirs . (radio)

   5. The snow was  very _______last night.  It  snowed ________last           night. (hesvy)

   6. He is  a _______student.   He studies very ______.(good)

   7. Please pout these  _________ on  the plate. (sandwich)

   8. My sister is  a _____. She ________in a  factory. (work)

 四. 选择填空;

 (   )1. His mother is  ill . He feels _____.

      A.worry     B.worrying    C.worried     D.to worry

 (   )2.The policeman helped me _____the car.

     A.stops    B. stopped     C. stopping     D.stop

 (   )3.A. B.C.D.

 初二英语期中考练习卷

 一. 在下列各组单词中选出一个划线部分读音与所给单词的划线部分读音一样的单词.

 (   ) 1. worri ed    A.clean ed    B.wait ed      C.pass ed   D.stopp ed 

 (   ) 2. tom a to    A.c a rrot    B.h a ppily      C.pot a to   D.p art y

 (   ) 3. ea s ily     A. s top      B. s andwich    C.we s t     D.pre s ent

 (   ) 4. fea th er    A.wea th er   B. nor th east    C. th in     D.sou th 

 (   ) 5.  wh ose    A .wh ole     B. wh en       C. wh ile    D. wh ich 

 (   ) 6. veget a ble  A.sk a te     B.t a ble        C.anim a l    D.p a per

 (   ) 7. sug ar      A.h ar d      B.poul ar      C.p ar k      D.st ar t

 (   ) 8. sea s o ns   A.wink o w s   B. map s      C.ticket s     D.duck s 

 (   ) 9. bri gh t     A.enou gh    B. thele ph one  C. ph oto  D.ei gh t

 (   ) 10. dr y       A.read y       B.quickl y     C.empt y   D.Jul y 

 二. 找出适当的字母或字母组合, 使单词完整. 正确

 (   )1. t__l_ph__ne   A. a…i…o   B. e…e…o  C.e…e…oa Da…e…o

 (   )2. happ__   A. yly    B. ily    C. ly        D. ely

 (   )3. ____cken   A. shi    B. the    C. chi     D. che

 (   )4. v ___g__t__ble  A. a…i…a   B. e…i…e C. a…e…i  D.e e…a

 (   )5. c__f__lly  A. air …i  B. ere…u  C. are…u  D. ear…i

 (   )6. usu___   A. ally     B. aly     C. elly     D. ely

 (   )7. b__t__ful__  A.eau…e    B.eau…i    C. ea…i    D. ea…e

 (  )8. Aug____    A. ust     B. ist      C. est      D. ast

 (  )9. aut__m __   A. u…e   B.u…n    C. e…n    D. i…m

 (  )10. plea ____  A. ture     B. sion    C. tion     D. sure

 三. 用所给词的正确形式填空:

   1. My coat is  too _____. My brother's coat is _____ than mine. (big)

   2. There are  many ____ in the sky  today.  It's _____. (coud)

   3. This boy  is very _____. He can  do the work _____. (care)

   4. The ________on the  desk are theirs . (radio)

   5. The snow was  very _______last night.  It  snowed ________last           night. (hesvy)

   6. He is  a _______student.   He studies very ______.(good)

   7. Please pout these  _________  on  the plate. (sandwich)

   8. My sister is  a _____. She ________in a  factory. (work)

 四. 选择填空;

 (   )1. His mother is  ill . He feels _____.

      A.worry     B.worrying    C.worried     D.to worry

 (   )2.The policeman  helped me _____the car.

     A.stops    B. stopped     C. stopping     D.stop

 (   )3. ____likes to  go swimming in  the river.

     A.No everyone  B. Not everyone  C.Not all  of us D. No all  of us

 (   )4. English  is ___than Chinese.

      A.much more popular      B. much poular

     C. very popular            D. the most popular

 (   )5. He ____ the  radio and sat  down to listen to  the radio.

     A. open      B. turned off    C. turned    D.turned on

 (   )6. ——Would you  like _____ cup  of tea?.

    ——No , thanks.

   A. other     B.the other    C.another     D.more

 (   )7. When I  went into his  room, he was  still ______.

      A. in bed    B.on bed    C.another     D.more

 (   )8. He runs ______than I.

     A.slowly     B.more slowly     C.slowlier     D.slower

 (   )9. ____have  a  cup of  tea ?

    A. Will I      B.more  slowly   C.May I   D.slower

 (   )10. _____hard--working the boy  is!

     A.What      B.What  a       C.How     D.How  a

 (   )11.Jim can  cook some Chinese  food, _____?

     A. can  he    B. can't Jin    C. can Jim      D.can't he

 (   )12.The child can  read the letter ______.

     A.easy     B.easily     C.puick    D.happily

 (   )13. He is  getting better. Don't _____ him.

    A.worry about           B. worried   about

    C. be worried           D. worry

 (   )14. May I ______a message for  John?

    A.carry      B.take      C.brought     D.took

 (   )15.I'm sorry _____ that your mother is  ill.

    A. hear     B.to hear     C.hearing     D.in hearing

 (   )16. ____ part of  America does Lucy come from?

    A. How     B.Which    C.where     D.what

 (   )17. Why not  ____ out for  a walk?

    A. went    B.going      C. to  go    D. go

 (   )18._____beautiful clothes!

     A.What    B. What a    C.How    D. How a

 (   )19.______to work at  the factory with us  next week?

     A.Did you go   B. Do you  go  C. Will you  go    D.Shall you go

 (   )20. This book is  buite different  ________ that one.

    A. with    B.from    C.about    D.of

 (   )21. Robert often eats chicken at  the shop, ____.

    A. so I do     B.so does I   C. so am  I     D. so do  I

 (   )22. Our teacher will teach us  _____ tomorrow.

    A. new something    B. new everything

    C. something now    D. everything  new

 (   )23. Mr Green does the  cooking _____in the  room.

   A. at times   B. at the  moment    C. later on   D. the next day

 (  )24. I'm busy today. I  need _____ some shopping.

   A. to do    B. doing     C. will  do    D. did

 (   )25. ——Hello! May  I speak to  Bruce      ——________.

    A. This is Bruce here    B. I'm Bruce

    C. Bruce is I             D. It's Bruce here

 (   )26. ——I'm sorry for  breaking your blass

        —— _____. Glass breaks easily.

    A. Don't worry      B. You are welcome

    C. That's all right     D. Don't be afraid

 (  )27.——Would you  like to come to  my birthday party?

      ——________

    A. I want to  very much     B. You are welcome

    C. That's all right           D. Don't be afraid

 (   )28. ——Can you  play pingpong with me  now?

        ——_____. I must finish my  homework first.

    A. Certainly   B. Yes , I can   C . I'm not  afraid    D. I'm afraid not

 (  )29. ——Will it  be fine tomorrow?

        ——I hope ____. we are  going to have a  football game.

      A. so    B. not    C.  will     D. fine

 (   )30. ——Thank you  for your help .  ——________.

      A. Thanks a lot    B. It's a pleasure   C. All right   D. That's right

 五. 连词成句:

 1. cold , is, how, today, it!

 2. the, will, start, when, party?

 3. before, we, not, ten, leave, will.

 4. cake, put, ann. tye, on, candles, her

 5. the, season, year, best, spring, of, is, the.

 6. he, I, is, am, moment, afraid, at, out, the.

 7. farmers, went, Sunday, to, we, last, help, the.

 8. China, come, which, do, of, you , part, from?

 

 六. 根据要求改写句子:

 1.There is   a littele  tea in  the  cup. (划线提问)

 2.The girl  in  a red  hat is  my sister. (同上)

 3.We  are going to  help the farmers pick apples  this autumn  (同上)

 4.My  uncle telephones us   once a  week. (同上)

 5.The weather here is   quite different from that in  the south of  China .                                                             (同上)

 6.  It is a  very beautiful.(改为反意问句)

 7.The present is  very beautiful. (同上)

 8.Ann likes to  eat English food. (同上)

 9.Chen Hua  can't spoeak English (同上)

 10.It's very cold today. (同上)

 七. 用所给动词, 词组的正确形式填空.

 live, turn green, wait for, fall, ring up, thank, sit down, enjoy, break, last,       want, call, take, have

 1. Please _______me _______ when you  get to  Shanghai.

 2. Tom ________Mary _______ him when he  came back.

 3. _______you for  your birthday present .  Did you ______the party?

 4. When spring comes , the tree______.

 5. Please _____me at  the gate of  the cinema tomorrow.

 6. It _____me about two  hours  to do  the work.

 7. When I _____I found the  chair was ______.

 8. The hot  weather _______two  weeks. Brt the  temperature ______           next week.

 9. We _____ a  good time in  the park last Saturday afternoon.

 10. Lucy enjoys _____ in  China very much.

 八. 在必要的地方, 填上适当的冠词:

 1. My father enjoys _______ English food very much.

 2. ______radio says there will be  snow in ____night.

 3. Jim lives in _____small village near _____London.

 4. Robert gave me ____ photo. ______photo is  very beautiful.

 5. John is  at _____cinema at ______moment.

 6. _____coldest season of  _____year is ______winter.

 7. What ______ fine day! Let's go  out for ______ walk.

 8. Don't read ____ books in _____bed.

 9. There is  ______ orange on ___________table.

 10. I think _____ snow will stop later in  ______day.

 九. 改病句:

 (   )1. __________ The children   are  playing   happy   in  the park.

                   A         B         C    D

 (   )2. ________ Ann  felt   worry   because  her mother was  ill .

                      A    B      C                   D

 (  )3. _______They can't   leave   the  office   before  eleven,  do  they?

                          A       B        C          D

 (  )4. ______ Jim often  eats   chickens   at  home   on  Sumdays.

                        A      B       C     D

 (  )5._________ It  is   more   colder  today   than  yesterday.

                 A       B     C          D

 (  )6. _________ I   need   to  go  to the  street  to  do  some   shoping .

                     A     B                 C            D

 (   )7. ______ They  helped    the  farmers   in  the harvest  last month .

                      A         B       C                D

 (  )8. _______  Japan  is  in   the  east of   China .

                 A      B   C           D

 (  )9. ________  It's   Lucy's  telephone  number.  Write   down  it  please.

                 A     B                       C      D

 (  )10. ______ In  the northwest , there  will  be   rainy   in  the night.

               A                       B     C   D

 十根据所提供的情景, 选择所给的句子完成下列对话(每句只能使用一次)

 1. It's a  pleasure    2. Thank you      3. The same to  you  4. It doesn't matter    5. No, thank you   6. Yes , that's right   7. What about you 

 8. Here you  are   9. Yes , please   10. Thank you  all the same.

   1. ——I'm going to  Ann's party. ______?

      ——I'm afraid. I  can't bcacuse I  have a lot  of work to  do.

    2. ——Happy birthday!   —— ________________.

    3. ——Happy New  Year! ——_________________.

    4. ——Sorry, I don't know how  to say it  in English .

           You'd better ask  our teacher.

       ——_____________________.

    5. —— Thanks a lot  for giving Lucy the  message for me.

      —— ____________________.

    6. ——I'm afraid I  can't go to  the cinema with you.

       —— ____________________.

    7. ——Would you  like some more food?

      —— ____________________. I'm full.

   8. ——Would you  like some more food?

      ——________________. Thank you  very much .

   9. ——May I  have some fish , please?

      ——Sure! __________________.

    10. —— Our class starts at  half past seven , doesn't it?

        ——__________________.

  十一. 完型填空.

     A train stopped at  a small station . A  man on the  train looked   1  the  window and  saw a woman. The  woman was selling cakes, and  people from  2   train were buying them . The  man  3   to  buy a cake , but  the woman was   4    far from him  . It was  raining and he  didn't want to  go out  5  the rain.

 Sudenly he  saw a  boy. The  boy was  walking on  the platform(站台)   6   from  him . "Come here boy!"the man  said. "Do you know   7   each of  the cakes is?  " "Five cents(美分) , "the boy    8   The man  gave the boy  ten cents and  asked him   9  t wo cakes. "One  is  for me, and   10  for you, " he  told  the boy.

 Some  minutes later, the boy  came back.

 He  was eating a  cake. He    11    the man  five cents and  said, "There was only   12    ."

 (   )1. A. at     B. for     C. up    D. out  of

 (   )2. A. a       B. an     C. the    D./

 (   )3. A. wanted   B. asked   C. thought     D. like

 (   )4. A. stand   B. standing    C. stay      D. stood

 (   )5. A. to      B. on        C. with      D. in

 (   )6. A. not near    B. not far   C. far     D. near

 (   )7. A. how much  B. what is    C. how many  D. how

 (   )8. A. answers    B. answered    C. is answering   D. will  answer

 (   )9. A. bought      B. to  buy     C. buying     D. buy

 (    )10. A. other      B. another      C. the  other      D. others

 (   )11. A. said  to      B. took      C. gave       D. told

 (   )12. A. one cake   B. two cakes  C. some cakes  D. a  lot of  cakes

 十二. 阅读理解

 One  morning, John went to  the market (市场集市)  with six  donkeys(驴).  After walking for  a while he  got very tired. He got  on one of  them. Then he  counted the donkeys, and there were only five. So he  got off the  donkey and went to  look ror the  sixth. He looked and looked but didn't find it. He went back to  the dondeys and  counted them again, This time there were six, so he  got on one  of them again, and  they all started.

 After a few minutes, he counted the  donkeys again, and again there were only five ! When he  was counting again, his friend Bill passed. And John said to  him, " I left my  house with six  donkeys; then I had  five; then I  had six again; and  now I have only five! Look! One, two, three, four, five."

 "But John, "said Bill, "you are  sitting on a  donkey, too! That's the sixth.And yor  are the seven!"t

      (   )1.John went to the market with six____.

    A. monkeys  B.chickens  C.donkeys  D.horses

 (   )2.He wanted to  sell his donkeys in  the ____.

   A.shop       B.cinema    C.market   D. fields

 (   )3.When he  was____he sat on one of  his donkeys.

   A.angry      B.hungry   C.happy   D.tired

 (   )4.There were five donkeys when John counted dthem, because____.

   A.he was  on one of  them     B.one ran away

   C.he couldn't count            D.he sold one 

 (   )5.Did he  look for the  sixth donkeys?____.

   A.Yes, he does       B.No, he doesn't

   C.Yes, he did        D.NO, he didn't

 (   )6.At last he  found it, didn't he? ____.

    A.Yes, he did        B.No, he didn't

    C.Yes, he didn't      D.No he did

 (   )7.After____,John counted the  donkeys again.

    A. two seconds   B. a few  ninutes    C. an hour   D. three days.

 (   )8. When he  was counting,____came.

   A.one of  his friends   B.his son

   C.the sixth dondey     D.his wife

 (   )9.Bill said,"Yor are_____a donkey. That's the  sixth."

   A.in front      B.sitting on     C.standing by   D.behind

 Unit  17 ~ Unit 23  综合训练

 Class __________ NO.________ Name_________

 Ⅰ.Listen to the tape and  choose the right word or  phrase you hear.(听录音选择你所听到的单词或词组,每小题念一遍。)(5分)

   (   ) 1. A. sock    B. box     C. son    D. so 

   (   ) 2. A. mend    B. men    C. name   D.them

   (   ) 3. A. wrong    B. long    C. home   D. rorm

   (   ) 4. A. bottle    B.broken   C. boat    D. brown

   (   ) 5. A.could    B. good     C. book    D. put

   (   ) 6. A. black    B. brend    C. back     D.bed 

   (   ) 7. A. boat      B. bird     C. bottle    D. ball

   (   ) 8. A. on the  desk         B. in the desk

        C. under the desk      D. behind the desk

   (   ) 9. A. look at             B. look after

        C. look like           D. look the same 

   (   ) 10. A.something to do      B. something to eat

         C. something to mend   D. something to drink

 Ⅱ. Listen to the  tape and choose the  right sentence you  hear . (听录音选择你所听到的句子,每小题念二遍。)(5分)

 (   ) 1. A. The old  man is 55  years old .

        B. The old man  is 65 years  old .

        C. The old man  is 75 yesrs old .

        D. The old man  is 45 yesrs old .  

 (   )2 . A. How much is  eight and eighteen?

        B. How much is  eighty and eighteen?

        C. How much is  eight and eigty?

        D. How much is  eight and eight?

 (   ) 3. A. What's the time ?  It's 8:15.

        B. What's the time ?  It's 8 :50.

        C. What's the time ?  It's 8:55.

        D. What's the time ?  It's 8:35.

 (   )4. A. Our  room number is  1117.

        B. Our room number is  1170.

        C. Our room number is  2117.

        D. Our room number is  2170.

 (   ) 5. A. Let's put  these books in  the box.

        B. Don't put these books in  the box.

        C. I want to  put these books in  the box.

        D. I can't put  these books in  the box.

 Ⅲ . Listhen to the  dialogue and  fill  in the blanks. (听录音后补对话,对话念二遍。)(5分)

 A:  Look 1 _____________________the picture. Where is  the pencil - box? Is  it 2._______________________the desk ?

 B: Yes, it  is .

 A: What's that 3_________________the pencil - box?

 B:  It's a  pen .

 A:  Is the light 4________________________the pencil - box?

 B:  Yes , it is .

 A:  Where's the football ?

 B: 5______________the desk.

 A: Look , What 6_________________is it  ? Is it  yellow ?

 B:  No, it's blacd 7____________white.

 A:  Can you find the  bag ?

 B:  Oh,  look , it's 8______________the desk.  Is it  9____________ ?

 A:  No , it  10_________________mine . It's  Li  Lei's.

 Ⅳ . Listen to the  passage and judge the  following sentence .(听短文后判断所给句子的正误,正确的用T,错误的用F,短文念三遍。)(5分)

 (   ) 1. Mrs Black looks very old .

 (   ) 2.She doesn't go  to the school every day.

 (   ) 3. She can't speak Chinese .

 (   ) 4. Mrs Black likes eating Chinese food.

 (   ) 5. Mrs Bland nas  two sons.

 Unit  17~ Unit 23  期中考试卷

 Class ________ No. ________Name__________

 Ⅰ. Listen to the  tape and choose the  right word or  phrase you hear.(听录音选择你所听到的单词或词组,第小题念一遍。)(5分)

 (    ) 1. A. think        B. thing       C. thank         D.drink

 (    ) 2. A. watch       B. catch       C. carry         D. worry

 (    ) 3. A. right        B.eight        C.light          D. rice

 (    ) 4. A. pear        B. dear        C. their         D. near

 (    ) 5. A. bread       B.blacd        C.bag          D. bed

 (    ) 6. A. row        B. boat        C.throw        D. know

 (    ) 7. A. would      B. full          C. good        D. food

 (    ) 8. A. make a kite         B. make a cake

         C. make a plane       D. make a chair

 (    ) 9. A. a yellow blorse      B.a yellow shirt 

         C. a yellow  sock      D. a yellow skirt

 (    ) 10.A. prt on             B. listen  to

         C. get down           D. put …away

 Ⅱ.Listen to  the tape and  choose the right sentence you  hear.(听录音选择你所听到的句子,每小是念二遍。)(5分)

 (    ) 1. A. Can you sing it , Tom ?     B. Can you say  this , Tom ?

        C. Can yor put  it on ?         D. Can yor get  it down ?

 (   ) 2. A.Don't run with the  cat .       B. Don't run with it .

       C. Don't throw it  like that .       D. Don't do it  like that .

 (    ) 3. A. Bill isn't cleaning the  blackboard.

         B. Bill isn't cleaning the  window .

        C. Bill isn't cleaning the  wall .

        D. Bill isn't cleaning the  desk.

 (    ) 4. A. How many boats are  there in the  river ?

         B. How many birds are  there in the tree ?

         C. How  many girls are  there in the  school?

         D. How many chairs are  chsirs are there in  the classroom?

 (    ) 5. A. I want to  get some books .

         B. I want to  have some food .

         C. I want to  have some bottle of  milk .

         D. I want to  have something to  eat.

 Ⅲ. Listen to  the dialogue and  choose the right answer to  each question.(听对话后选择正确的答案,对话念二遍。)(5分)

 (    ) 1. A. She can't make a  cake.        B. She can't fly  a kite .

    C. She can't ride a  bike .             D. She can't mend a  bike.

 (   ) 2. A. A river and  some boats .       B. A hill and  some birds .

       C. A river and  some hills .         D. A hill and  some rivers .

        (   ) 3. A. They're behind the  door .   

        B. They're under the  bed.

        C. They're in the  bag .

        D. They're on the  floor .

 (   ) 4. A. A bottle of  orange .      B. A cup of  tea .

        C. A glass of  milk .        D. A glass of  water .

 (    ) 5. A. They are talking about a  plane .

         B. They are talking about the  coat .

        C. They are talking about the  colour.

        D. They are talking about the  dress .

 Ⅳ. Listen to the  passage and fill in  the missing words .(听短文后填入短文中所缺的单词,短文念三遍。)(5分)

 Kate's family are  sll at home . 1____________father, Mr Green is  2__________on a chair near the  window and 3____________a book . Kate is  4_____________her room . She is  listening 5_______________the radio . Bill and  Tom , Kate's brothers , are not playing . They 6________________cleaning 7_______________new bikes. 8_______________is Mrs  Green ? She is in  the garden . She 9_____________________watering  the flowers . Kate's sister  is 10_________________her mother.

 Unit  17—Unit 18

 Ⅰ. Losten and choose

    听句子,选择你所听到的单词:(每小题念一遍)

 (    ) 1. A. sunny    B.sun    C. song        D. Sunday

 (    ) 2. A. laugh    B. love    C. life(生活)   D. like

 (    ) 3. A. snow     B.grow    C. show       D. blow

 (    ) 4. A. hold     B. told    C. hope       D. cold

 (    ) 5. A. feel      B. ill       C. till         D. meal

 Ⅱ. Listen and choose

 听 问句,选择最恰当的答案:(每小题念两遍)

 (    ) 1.A. Winter is the  warmest season in  China.

         B. Summer is the  warmest season in  China .

         C. Spring is the  best season in  China.

         D. Autumn is the  best season in  China.

 (    ) 2. A. It's winter .       B. It's summer . 

         C. It's spring .       D. It's autumn .

 (    ) 3. A. Shopping .        B. Swimming .

         C. Fishing .          D. Skating .

 (    ) 4. A. The same to  you .    B. It doesn't matter.

         C. I am happy .         D. Thanks a lot .

 (    ) 5. A. It's cool .         B. It's Sunday .

         C. It's October lst .   D. It's my  birthday .

 Ⅲ. Losten and choose

 听录音,选择与原句意思相似的句子:(每小题念两遍)

 (    ) 1. A. What about the  picture ?

         B. What aice picture it  is !

         C. The picture is  very beautiful .

         D. What does the  picture look loke?

 (    ) 2. A. The rain was  very heavy last might .

         B. It rained heavily last week .

         C. It rained all  night .

         D. The rain wasn't neavy last night.

 (    ) 3. A. His birthday party is  going to start at  5:30 .

         B. His birthday party is  going to start at  6:30 .

         C. His bithday party is  going to start at  5:45 .

         D. His bithday party is  going to start at  6:15 .

 (    ) 4. A. Give Lily the  message .    B.Give ready for  Lucy .

         C. Ring up Lucy .           D. Remember to tell Lucy .

 (    ) 5. A. The days get  shorter snd shouter .

          B. In winter , the days are  shorter than the  nights .

         C. Winter is from December to  February .

         D. The weather gets warmer and  warmer .

 Ⅳ. Look, Listen and choose

 看图,听录音,选择正确答案:(每小题 念两遍)

 (    ) 1.A. It's my birthday .      B.It's Jack's birthday.

        C. It's John's birthday .    D. It's Jim's birthday .

 (    ) 2. A. There is a  moomcake on the  table .

         B.There is a  chicken on the  plate .

         C. There is some fish and  meat on the  plate .

         D. There is a  big birthday cake on  the table .

 (    ) 3. A. They are going to  have a class meeting .

         B. They are going to  have a rest .

         C. They are going to  have a birthday party.

         D. They are going to  have a talk about the  class .

 (    ) 4. A. John is eleven years old .      B. Jack is seven years old .

         C. John is thirteen years old.     D.Jim is six  years old .

 (    ) 5. A. I think he  is very happy today.

          B. He isn't happy today, I think .

         C. He is busy today , I think.      D. He is strong today .

 Ⅴ. Listen and choose

 听短文,选择正确的答案:(短文念两遍)

 (    ) 1.A. Sam's friend .           B. Bill .

        C. Sam's father.            D.Sam's mother .

 (    ) 2. A. In the office .          B. In the classroom .

         C.At home .               D.He was out .

 (    ) 3.A. Sam's teacher .          B. Bill.

        C.Sam's father.            D. Sam's friends .

 (    ) 4.A. His telephone number was  451382 .

         B. His telephone number was  541328 .

         C. His telephone number was  453218 .

         D. His telephone number was  543128 .

 (    ) 5. A. Because Sam's mother was  at the cinema .

         B. Because Sam's mother was  busy at home .

         C. Because Sam's mother was  ill athome .

         D. Because Sam's mother wanted to  tell him something                      interesting.

 Ⅰ. A rhyme to  learn

         Rain

 The  rain is raining all  round .

 It  falls on field and  tree .

 It  rains on umbrelles here ,

 And  on the ships at  sea .

 Ⅱ. A joke

 A: Who can  spell the word "banana" ?

 B:I  can

 C:  Me, too . But  I don't know when to  stop .Banananananana……

 Ⅲ .A story

 Mrs  Brown's old grandfather went out  for a walk ih  the park euery morning and  came back home at  hlaf past twelve for  his lunch .

 But  on morning a  police car stopped outside Mrs  Brown's house and  two policemen helpec the  old man to  get out of  the car . One or  them said to  Mrs Brown , "The old  man lost his  way in the  park and phoned us  ror help , so we bring him  home. " Mrs Brown thanked the  policemen and they left.

 "But , Grandfather ." she said , "you go  to that park mearly every day. How did  you lose your way  there ? "

 The  old man smiled ,closed one  eye and said, "I just got  tired and I  didn't want to  walk home !"

 Question: did theold man  really lose his  way?

 Unit  19- Unit 20

 Ⅰ.Listen and  choose 

 听句子, 选择你所听到的单词:(每小题念一遍)

 (    ) 1. A. below      B. before     C. because    D.brown

 (    ) 2. Afall         B. feel       C. felt        D. fell

 (    ) 3. A. about      B. above     C. along      D.again

 (    ) 4.A. whole      B. hold      C. ago        D. cold

 (    ) 5. A.boy       B. easy       C. enjoy        D. story

 Ⅱ. Listen and judge

 听录音,判断该 单词与你所听到的单词的元音音素是否相同,相同的写"S",不同的写"D":(每小题 念 一遍)

 (    ) 1.friend    (     ) 2. south     (    ) 3. pork     (   ) 4. beef

 Ⅲ.Listen and  write

 听句子,把所缺的部分 补充完整:(每小题念两遍)

 (    ) 1. The radio ______________it will be  ___________tomorrow.

 (   ) 2.The temperature will_____________ __________zero at  night.

 (   ) 3.There will be  a ____________  _____________the day  after tomorrow.

 (   ) 4. I shall ________________  ________________yor outside the  school gate.

 (   ) 5. It is _____________ _______________food.

 Ⅳ. Listen and choose

 听录音, 选择与原句意思相似的句子:(每小题念两遍)

 (   ) 1. A. Lucy likes eating fried eggs better than fried beef

       B. Lucy likes eating apples better than oranges.

       C. Lucy doesn't like fried eggs.

       D. Lucy doesn't like fried chicken.

 (   ) 2.A.Who is  back this evening ?

        B. Who is ill  this evening ?

       C. Who will come this evening ?

       D. Who will stay at  home this evening?

 (   ) 3. A. What do you  think of the  potatoes ?

        B. How are the  delicious potatoes ?

        C. How delicious  the potatoes are  !

        D. What about the  potatoes ?

 (   ) 4.A. It's cloudy today.      B. It's rainy today.

        C. It's sunny today.       D.It's windy today.

 (   ) 5.A.Bruce often comes at  noon.

        B. Bruce often comes at  night.

        C. Bruce ofteh comes in  the day-time.

        D. Bruce often comes at  that time.

 Ⅴ. Listen and choose

 听短文,选择正确答案:(短文念两遍)

 (   ) 1. A. Fish and chips .

         B.Chinese take-away food.

        C. Oranges and apples.

        D. Both A and  B.

 (   ) 2. A. England .     

        B. The U. S. A..

        C. Australia.      

        D. Japan.

 (   ) 3.A. Pork and  beef.        

        B. Fried chicken.

        C. Fish and chips          

        D. Meat and fish .

 (   ) 4.A. Fried chicken.     

       B. Fish and chips .

       C. Hamburgers(汉堡包).  

       D. Fied beef.

 (   ) 5. A.The USA , England and  China.

        B. Ehgland, China and Australia.

        C.Australia , England  and the USA .

        D. England , Australia  and France .

 

 Ⅰ. A rhyme to  learn 

      Who has seen the  wind ?

      Neither I nor  you .

     But when the  leaves (树叶)  hang trembling (颤动),

     The wind is  passing through.

     Who has seen the  wind ?

     Neither you nor  I.

     But when the  trees bow down their heads ,

     The wind is  passing by.

 Ⅱ. Puzzles

     It teakes off  a piece of  its clothing each day. At the  end of the  year it has  nothing left to  wear. What's it?

 (calendar)

   Two brothers look into the  water but can't meet each other.

    What's it ?                                (The banks of  a river)

 Ⅲ. A story

    A lady went into a shop and  bought some rings . She paid (付) a lot of  money for them . When she  went to bed  that night , she put  them on a  table near the  window. Then she  went to sleep. When she  woke up in  the next morning, there were no  rings on the  table . She picked up  the telephone and  called the police station . " A thief (贼)has taken my  rings ,"she said. "please come quickly." Soon some policemen came. They looked everywhere but  they could not  see the thief or  the rings . Then one  of them saw  some blacd feathers on  the table. Then he  saw some more near a  tree . He looked up  and saw a  bird's nest (窝) .He climbed up the tree and  a big black crow (乌鸦) flew out  of the nest . The policeman put  his hand inside the  nest , and pulled out  all the rings.

 Question: Who has  taken away the  lady's rings?

 The  answer: The crow 

 Unit  15 -Unit 21

 Ⅰ.Listen and  choose

  听句子,选择你所听到的单词:(每小题念一遍)

 (   )1. A. pleasure    B. present     C. parents    D. parent

 (   ) 2. A. late        B. letter       C. later      D. matter

 (   ) 3. A. their       B. where      C. wear      D. pear

 (   ) 4. A. would     B. could       C. cool       D. food

 (   ) 5. A. warm     B. form       C. phone     D. born

 Ⅱ. Listen and choose

 听录音,选择与原句意思相似的句子:(每小题念两遍)

 (   ) 1. A. Could you ask  him to call her  name, please?

        B. Could you please answer the  phone ?

        C. Could you make her  a telephone clall, please?

        D. Could you ask  him to ring me , please?

 (   ) 2. A. I'm sorry I  forget to say  "Good-bye".

        B. I'm sorry I  forget the room number.

        C. I'm sorry I  must go now.

        D. I'm sorry I  can't remember the  phone number.

 (   ) 3. A. How hot  it is today!

        B. How cold is  it today?

        C. What a cold day!

        D. What a hot  day!

 (   ) 4. A. THe weather in  the same country is  not the  same.

        B. The weather in  different countries are  not the same.

        C. Different countries don't have different weather.

        D. The weather in  different countries are  hte same .

 (   ) 5. A. Englishmen like the  most popular food in Australia.

        B. Englishmen like eating fish and  chips very much.

        C. Fis and chips are  the most popular food in  the USA

        D. The most popular food in  England is Chinese tade-away food.

 Ⅲ. Listen and choose

 听对话,选择正确答案:(对话念两遍)

 (   ) 1. A. Yes. Mary will see  her grandma.

        B. No, Mary won't see  her grandma.

        C. Yes, Mary will see  her grandpa.

        D. NO.Mary won't see  her grandpa.

 (   ) 2. A. Tom gets up  at 7:00 and  leaves home at  8:00.

        B. Tom gets up  at 7:30 and  leaves home at  8:30.

        C. Tom gets up  at 7:00 and  leaves home at  7:30.

        D. Tom gets up  at 7:50 and  leaves home at  8:15.

 (   ) 3. A. The book and  the pen are  in the black bag.

        B. The book isn't in  the red bag.

        C. The pen and  the book are  in  the red  bag.

        D.The pen and  the book are  in the blue bag.

 (   ) 4. A. In 1989.  B. In 1992.   C. In  1990.  D. In 1987.

 (   ) 5. A. They are talking about sports.

        B. They are talking about shopping.

        C. They are talking about the  seasons.

         D. They are talking about the  weather.

 Ⅳ. Listen and choose

 看图,听录音,选择正确答案:(每小题念一遍)

 (   ) 1. A.It's sunny.       B.It's cloudy.

        B. It's windy.      D. It's rainy.

 (   ) 2. A. He is  Bruce.    B. He is  Mike.

        C. He is Jim.      D. He is Bob.

 (   ) 3. A. They are talking    B. They are making a  telephone call.

        C. They are  speaking English. 

        D. They are counting the  number.

 (   ) 4. A. He is  saying , "How old are  you ?".

        B. He is saking, "What's your house's number?"

        C. He is saking , "What's you  telephone number?"

        D. He is saking , "What's the  car number?".

 (   ) 5. A. It's  .       B. It's .

        C. It's .       D. It's .

 Ⅴ. Listen and choose

 听短文,选择正确答案:(短文念两遍)

 (   ) 1. A. The People's Park.      B. Beijing Zoo.

        C. The Great Wall.         D. The hospital.

 (   ) 2. A. His aunt.            B.His friend.

        C. His teacher.           D. His motrher.

 (   ) 3. A. They played games.   B. They took some photos.

        C. They drew pictures.    D. They had  lunch.

 (   ) 4. A. They had noodles.     B. They had Beijing duck.

        C. They had potatoes.    D. They had chicken.

 (   ) 5. A. Yes, they did.         B. No, they didn't.

        C. Yes, they are .          D. No, they aren't.

         

 Ⅰ. A. rhyme to learn

             Good night,

             Sleep tight.

             Wake up bright,

             In the morning light.

             To do what's right,

             With all your might.

 Ⅱ. A.funy story

 Madam Lay  went shopping with her  with sons. She  bought the same coats for  them. They put them on  at once. Madam Lay  asked the shop assistant, "Is there any  mirror (镜子)?"

 "Why mirror ? They only have  to  look at each other. "

 大班计算活动计划

    班级:大(4)班     执 教 者:陈 永爱    

    日期:2001.4.11     指导老师:林丽峰、王凤琴

 活动目的:

 1. 使幼儿能正确说出正方体和长方体的主要特征,并比较其异同

 2. 让幼儿感知形和体的不同,发展空间知觉。

 活动准备:

 1. 正方体和长方体娃娃头饰各1 个,各种形体的积木。线若干条,魔术箱、录音机、磁带。

 2. 场地布置:形体乐园。

 3. 事先排好情境表演。

 活动过程:

 一、以谈话的形式引入,引出正方体娃娃和长方体娃娃,激发幼儿的兴趣

 师: 小朋友,今天我们班来了两位客人,你们看看是谁?(幼儿看情境表演)

 二、带幼儿到形体乐园玩。

 1. 认识正方体、长方体。

 ① 认识正方体。

 a. 请幼儿先找出正方体。

 b. 幼儿边玩边操作:找到了正方体,数一数有几个面,并用铅笔标上序号,用自然测量法测量每个面的每条边,发现了什么?

 c. 请幼儿讲述自己的操作情况

 d. 引导幼儿感知形和体的不同。

 e.师小结正方形的特征:方积木有六个一样大小的而,每个而都是正方形,像这样的物体叫下方体。(幼儿学讲:正方体)

 ②认识长方体

 a. 每个幼儿找1. 长方体积木,数一数有几个而,并用目测的方测看看每个而是什么形状的?它们一样吗?

 b. 幼儿表达自己的发现.

 c. 启发幼儿找一找长方体扔六个面中,它的对面在哪里,并进行比较,对面的开头怎样?大小一样吗?

 d. 师小结:长方体也有六个面,有的六个面是长方形;有的四个面是长 方形、两个面是正方形。

 ③比较正方体和长方体的异同点。

 三、游戏“击鼓摸箱子”

 玩法:1. 请幼儿在听信号后,到魔术箱摸出一个形体,并说出自己摸的是什么形体,有什么特征。

 2. 根据教师讲述的形体特征,让幼儿摸出相应的物体,

 四、巩固练习,让幼儿根据形体标志进行归类。

 五、引导幼儿说说日常生活中,哪些物体是正方体,哪些物体是长方体。

 六、以谈话法结束活动。幼儿开小汽车回家出活动室。

 大班计算活动说课

 ————认识正方体,长方体

 一、说教材

 《认识正方体长方体》是大班下学期中的计算教学内容。大班的幼儿对几何平面图形有了正确的认识,他们已经认识了正方形和长方形等并能作出准确的判断,但对物体的体这个概念却不知道为此,我在幼儿掌握平面图形的基础上开设活动,符合幼儿的年龄特点。不但可以发展幼儿的空间知觉能力,也等以后的知识打下基础。

 本活支以“游戏法”贯穿态个活动,准备足够的教玩具,让幼儿动手操作,启发引导幼儿运用观察、比较发现等多种方法进行教学,这样安排不但可以激发幼儿学习的积极主动性,以可以让幼儿运用多种感害直接去感知正方体、长方体的特征。幼儿在操作中逐步理解,符合循序渐进的认知规律。

 根据本班幼儿的实际水平和教材内容、特点,制定了以下

 活动目标:

 1. 使幼儿能正确说出正方体和长方体的主要特征,并比较其异同。

 2. 让幼儿感知形和体的不同,发展空间知觉。

 3. 培养幼儿分析、比较能力和认真细致观察的习惯。

 通过活动引导幼儿能说出正方体和长方体的主要特征是三活动的重点。进而感知正方体、长方体六个面中,对面一样大是本活动的难点。

 教具准备

 1. 正方体和长方体娃娃的头饰各1 个,各种形体的积木。线若干条,魔术箱一个、录音机、磁带.

 2. 场地布置:形体乐园.

 3. 事先排好情境表演.

 二、 说活动方法:

 大班的幼儿年龄小,感性知识少相象概括能力弱,思维的特点是以具体形象思维为主要形式。空间方位知觉正在发展阶段,他们的学习完全依靠赖于对被认识对象感兴趣的程度,根据这些特点组织活动时我采用了以下几种教学法:

 1. 以游戏法贯穿整个活动

 游戏是幼儿最喜欢的活动。在计算教学中运用游戏法不但符合幼儿活泼好动及思维具体形象的特点。而且能激发幼儿的学习兴趣和积极性集中幼儿的注意力;使幼儿轻松愉快地学习。本活动以“支形体乐园玩”贯穿整个活动,幼儿不但在玩中找到乐趣,而且也在玩中学习、掌握了正方体、长方体的特征。

 2. 运用操作法,让幼儿主动学习.

 幼儿是学习活动的主体,为了突出幼儿的主体的位,发挥幼儿的主体作用,我准备了足够的教玩具,提供幼儿动手、动口、动脑的机会,让幼儿在操作中获取对正方体的认识,帮助幼儿理解事物的规律,突破了教学重点。

 3. 灵活采用直观教学法,观察法和比较法

 幼儿的思维是具体形象的,活动开始以“直观形象 的正方体长方体娃娃”引入,一下子引起幼儿的话意;接着“形体乐园”里的玩具,再次调动幼儿的积极主动性。通过操作和游戏,引导幼儿结合应用观察法,比较法,来发现问题得出结论,使活动达到高潮。

 三、说活动程序.

 根据幼儿年龄小、活泼、好动的性格特点,简明的导语和生动的引入,能引起幼儿的注意调动幼儿的学习积极性

 1. 开始部分:

 师以“我们班来了两个小客人”引入,引出正方体和长方体娃娃。正方体娃娃和长方体娃娃分别自我介绍,并提出愿意带小朋友一起去形体乐园玩(幼儿开小汽车去形体乐园)

 2. 基本部分

 ① 认识正方体和长方体

 教师带幼儿到形体乐园玩,让幼儿分别和正方体、长方体交朋友并用操作法发现它们各自的特征.

 ② 教师引导幼儿比较正方体和长方体的异同点.

 ③ 玩游“击鼓摸箱子”

 a. 请幼儿在听信号后到箱子里摸出一个形体,并说出自己摸的是什么形体,有什么特征。

 b. 根据教师讲述的形体特征。让幼儿摸出相应的物体。

 ④ 巩固练习,让幼儿根据形体标志进行分类

 ⑤ 引导幼儿说说日常生活中哪些物体是正方体,哪些物体是长方体?

 3.结束部分

 以“今天我们在形体乐园玩了一天,也玩累了,让我们开着小汽车回家”(幼儿听音乐做开汽车的动作出活动室)

 初三英语阅读    (1) A  Box Full of  Christmas Cards

 It  was two weeks before Christmas (圣诞节), and Mrs  Smith was  very busy . She  bought a lot  of Christmas cards(卡片)to  send to  her friends and  to her husband's friends, and put  them on the  table in the  living-room(起居室). Then, when  her husband came home from work, she  said to him, "Here are  the Christmas cards for  our friends, and  here  are the  stamps(邮票),the pen  and the address(地址)book. Will you  please write the  cards while I  am cooking the  dinner(正餐)?"

 Mr  Smith did not  say anything, but  walked out of  the living-room and  went to his  study(书房). Mrs Smith was  very angry with him , but  did not  say anyting ,  either.

 Then  2 minutes later he  came back with a  box of Chrismas cards with stamps on  and all had  been addressed(写上姓名地址).

 "These  are from last year,"he said. "I forgot to  post them."

 (   ) 1. What did  Mrs Smith do  before  Christmas?____

   A. She bought a  lot of Christmas cards.  B. She did  some cooking.

      C. She bought a  lot of presents  for their friends.

      D. She bought a  box full of  Christmsa cards.

 (   )2. Mrs  Smith wanted her  husband __ when he  came home from work.               A. to do some cooking

      B. to put the  stamps on and  write the addresses on  the cards.

     C. to get the  box from the  next room

     D. to send the  Christmas cards  to their friends

 (   )3. What did  Mr·Smith do  then? ______.

     A. He wrote the  addresses  on the  cards

     B. He  helped Mrs·Smith  to cook the  dinner

   C. He suddenly(突然)thought of  something and went to  get a box

    D. He said nothing and  did nothing

 (   )4. In the  second paragraph, the  word "angry"  means "______"

     A. 失望      B. 满意       C. 惊讶       D. 生气

 (   )5. From the  story we can  see Mr Smith was  a ____man.

     A. careless(粗心)   B. clever    C. good    D. bad

 (2)  Why Are You  Shouting

 Mike  liked chocolates (巧克力) very much, but his  mother never gave him  any, because they were bad  for his teeth, she thought. But Mike had  a nice grandfather. The old  man loved (孙子) very much, and sometimes he  brought Mike chocolates when he  came to visit him. Then his  mother let him  eat them, because she  wanted to make the  old man happy.

 One  evening, a few days before Mike's seventh birthday, he was  saying his prayers (祈祷词) in his bedroom before he  went to bed.  “Please, God (上帝), ”he shouted,  “make them give me  a big box  of chocolates for  my birthday on  Saturday.”

 His  mother was in  the kitchen (厨房) , but she heard the  small boy shouthing and  went into his  bedroom quickly.

  “Why are  you shouting, Mike? ”she asked her  son.  “God can hear you  however gently (无论多轻) you speak. ”“I know,” answered the clever bay  with a smile,  “but Grandfather's in  the next room, and he  can't.”

 (   ) 1. Mike's mother never gave Mike chocolates because ______.

        A. she wanted the  grandfather to give him  instead

        B. She thought they were bad  for his teeth

        C. it was not  easy to buy  them    D. they were not  cheap 

 (   ) 2. MIke was ____ years old.

        A. eleven        B. seven       C. seventeen    D. six

 (   ) 3. From the  story we can  see Mike's mother was ___ her father.

        A. angry with    B. kind to     C. pleased with  D. happy about

 (   ) 4. After saying his  prayers, Mike ____.

        A. went to see  his grandfather    B. went to bed

        C. went to eat  chocolates         D. went to the  kitchen

 (   ) 5. Mike shouted his  prayers because hewas afraid ___ could not 

        hear him.

        A. somebody                    B. God

        C. his mother                    D. his grandfather

 (3)  We Enjoy Ourselves Without Friends

 Most  things cannot be  enjoyed (不能被欣赏) without friends, but reading can. When we  sit alone in  our house, we can  travel (旅行) around the  world, and we  can understand the  reason (道理) for thousands of  things. We live today, but we  can talk with the  people  of thousands of  years ago. We can  become the  friends of clever men. Only books give us  this happiness (快乐). If people cannot enjoy reading, they are  poor men; If people enjoy reading most, they can  get the most happiness from books.

 (   ) 1. One can  ____ if he has  no friends with him.

        A. sit alone                    B. do some reading 

        C. have a talk                 D. have a sleep

 (   ) 2. From books we  can ____.

        A. get much money            B. get many friends

        C. know a lot  of things in  the world

        D. know some people in  our country

 (   ) 3. ____ can make us  know a lot  of things in  the world.

        A. Thinking       B. Writing     C. Reading    D. Working

 (   ) 4. If we  read more books, we will ____.

        A. be cleverer                 B. get richer

        C. look stronger               D. have more friends

 (   ) 5. which of  the following is  true?

        A. If one reads a  lot, he will have many friends.

        B. When one reads a  lot of books, he is  a poor man.

        C. One can enjoy everything without friends.

        D. Reading is a  great happiness.

 (4)  Tell Me  in Such a  Way

 One  day, an old lady wanted to  go to London to  see her son. She  got up early and  readched the small station at  nine o'clock in  the morning. Becarse this was  her first trip (旅行) to London, she didn't know the  train time. She was  very worried. Just at  that moment, she saw  a little boy  running towards her. She stopped him  and asked him  what time the  train woukd arrive and  when the train woukd leave for  London. the boy looked at  the woman and  said, “tu: tu: tu: tu: tu:” just like firing a  gun (象开枪似的). Then he  ran away. The old  lady was very much surprised and  got angry. She didn't know why  the boy had  made fun of (开玩笑) her. She sat in  a chair and  thought and thought. At last she  began to smile. She could not  help (不禁) crying out, “What a  clever boy! He told me  the train time in  such a way!”

 (   ) 1. When the  lady got to  the small station, _____.

        A. she saw no  one there       B. the train had  arrived

        C. she asked a  boy the train time

        D. a boy came up  to meet her

 (   ) 2. The little boy  ran away because _____.

        A. the lady laughed at  him     B. the lady was  angry with him

        C. he had told the  lady the train time

        D. he didn't want to  tell the lady the  train time

 (   ) 3. That day  the lady stayed at  the small staion for  about_____.

        A. one hour   B. two minutes    C. five hours   D. half a  night

 (   ) 4. At last the  old lady understood the  train would  arrive at ___ .

        and leave at _____.

        A. 10: 10… 2:12  B. 2: 00 … 12  C. 2:02 … 2:04 D. 1:58 … 2:02

 (   ) 5. Which of  the following is  true?

        A. The old lady didn't get  up early enough to  catch the train.

        B. The old lady never went to  London before.

        C. The boy got  angry with the  lady and made fun  of her.

        D. The  boy told the  lady the train time in  a clever way.

 (5) Have a  Joke (玩笑)

 Once  Effendi had a  joke with the  prime Minister (首相). He said the  Minister would due  the next day. The next day, the Minister really fell from the  horse and died. When the  king heard this, he got  angry and sent (派遣) his men  to catch Effendi at  once.

 When  Effendi came, the king shouted angrily, “Effendi, you knew when my  Minister would die, you must also know the  date of your own  death (死). Say it out, or you;ll die  today.”

 Effendi looked at  the king and  answered, “But how  can I know? I'll die  two days earlier than your.”

 the  king was afraid that he  would die if  he killed Effendi. He thought he  must keep  Effendi alive (活着的) as long as  he could. So he  let him go.

 (   ) 1. This story tells us_____.

        A. when the king would die       B. why the Prime Minister died

        C. how Effendi fooled (愚弄) the king

        D. that Effendi died two  days earlier than the  king

 (   ) 2. The Prime Minister died because ______.

        A. Effendi talked about his  death the day  before

        B. he fell to  the ground from a  horse

        C. he was ill                D. Effendi hated him

 (   ) 3. The king asked Effendi to  tell the date of  his death because the  king ____.

        A. wanted to know the  time of his  own death

        B. wanted to find an  excuse (借口) to kill him 

        C. was afraid that he  would die       D. wanted to learn form Effendi

 (   ) 4. Effendi said that he  would die two  days earlier than the  king because he 

       wanted ____.

        A. to let the  king know the  time of his  death

        B. to tell the  time of the  king's own death

        C. to let the  king kill him       D. to let the  king keep him  alive

 (   ) 5. The king let  Effendi go because ____.

        A. he didn't know what to  do       B. he wanted to  live a long life

        C. he knew  the date of  Effendi's death

        D. he wanted Effendi to  live a happy life

 (6)  Something About Coffee and  Tea

 Two  hundred years ago  people in Europe (欧洲) didn't know coffee (咖啡) and tea. They were afraid to  drink them because they thought coffee or  tea could kill a  person. Once the king of  Sweden (瑞典) decided (决定) to find out  whether (是否) it was  true or not.

 At  that time there were two  twin (双胞胎) brothers in prison (监狱). They would die  in a few  days because they did  wrong. The king said, “I shall let  them live but  they must drink coffee or  tea to the  end of their lives. One brother must drink coffee and  the other must drink tea  every day.”

 They  both lived many years. At last, one of  the brothers died when he  was eighty-three years old. The other died a  few years later. After that, people knew both coffee and  tea were useful (有益的) to man.

 (   ) 1. People were afraid to  drink coffee and  tea because ____.

        A. people didn't like them       B. they smelt bad

        C. they have no  money to buy  them      

        D. people knew little about them

 (   ) 2. The king of  Sweden ____ that coffee and  tea were useful at  last. 

        A. found out                  B. didn't believe

        C. didn't think                 D. thought

 (   ) 3. What saved the  two brothers' lives? ____.

        A. found out                  B. didn't believe     

        C. did't think                  D. thought

 (   ) 4. Today people ____ drink not  only coffee but  also tea.

        A. in Sweden                 B. in Europe

        C. in China                   D. all over the  world

 (   ) 5. The two  brothers lived to ____ years old.

        A. more than 82     B. less than 82       C. 83       D86

 (7)  Will's Bike

 Will  has a bike, but there's a  hole (洞) in its inner tube (内胎). He cannot ride it  now. He has to  repair the hole. He needn't want the  man in the  bike shop to  repair it. He can  repair  it himself. It's easy for  him. First, he takes out  the inner tube. Then he  tests (检查). it and  finds the hole. The test is  easy. You get some water, blow up (吹胀) the inner tube, and put  the tube into the  water. Yor move the  tube round and  will see air  coming up through the  water. You mark (作记号) the place ( The air  is coming out  of the place ) With a  kind of pencil. Will has  one of these pencils. His father has  given him a  repair box. The pencil is  in the box. He has  found the hole now. When the  inner tube is  not wet any  more, he is going to  put a rubber (橡皮) patch (补块) on  the hole. There are  some patches and  something else (其他的) in the repair box. When will repairs his  bike, he is going to  ride it again.

 (   ) 1. There's _____ Will's bike.

        A. something wrong with       B. anything wrong in

       C. nothing wrong with          D. something wrong in

 (   ) 2. Will repairs his  bike himself because _____.

        A. he hasn't got  any money

        B. it takes a  lot of money for  a bike shop to  repair it

        C. it is easy for  him to repair it  himself

        D. there is no  bike shops near his  home

 (   ) 3. Will's father has  given him ____.

        A. a pencil- box               B. a school- bag

        C. a repair basket             D. a repair box

 (   ) 4. He doesn't put  a rubber patch on  the hole when the  inner tube is ____.

        A. still wet                   B. not wet any  more

        C. no longer wet             D. not wet enough

 (   ) 5. Can Will repair his  bike himself at  last?

        A. Yes, he can.               B. Hard to  say.

        C. No, he can't.              D. Of course not.

 (8)  Mr. Guo's Story

 My  grandfather was a  fine man. I loved him  very much. But one  day I told him  a lie (诺言). I can not  tell you now  what the lie  was. I was only seven years old  then.

 Grandfather was  not angry with me. “Ask Wang to  bring a long ladder (梯子), ” he said. Wang took care of  our garden.

 Wang  brought the big  ladder. Then  Grandfather told him, “put the  ladder in front of  the house, up to  the top (顶部).”

 Wang  put the ladder there. Then Grandfather said, “My  boy, now jump from the  top of the  house. The ladder  is  for you.”

 I  knew at once what he  was telling me. I often heard the  old saying (俗语) “A lie is  a jump from the  top of a  jump frim the  top of a  hoouse”

 I  said nothing. But I  felt like crying.

 The  minutes went by. What would people think about the  ladder? It stood by  the front door. I was  afraid it might be  there a long time. I had  to do something!

 At  last I went to  Grandfather. He was reading a  book. I went up  to him and  put my face on  his arm.

 “Grandfather,” I said. “I  will not tell a  lie again. We don't need the  ladder now.”

 Grandfather seemed (好像) very happy. He called Wang. “Take the  ladder away,” he said. “My boy does not  jump from the  top the house.”

 His  words made me  happy once again.

 (   ) 1. There were ____ persons in  the story.

        A. tow        B. three        C. four        D. five

 (   ) 2. “I  felt like crying ”means “_____”.

       A. 我正在哭        B. 我喜欢哭       C. 我很想哭        D . 我感到象哭

 (   ) 3.  The story shows that Grandfather was ____ the boy.

        A.  clever and  kind  to           B. foolish and unkind to

        C. clever but not  kind to       D. foolish but kind to

 (   ) 4.  The old saying tells people ____.

        A. to jump from the  top of a  house        B. to jump to  the top of  a house

        C. not to  tell lies        D. a story of  jumping from the  top of a  house

 (   ) 5.   “My boy does not  jump from the  top of the  house ” means“____”.

        A. My boy doesn't like the  ladder

        B. My boy isn't brave (勇敢) enough to  jump from the  top

        C. My boy doesn't tell lies again

        D. It's not necessary (需要) for my boy  to use the  ladder

 (9) The Year

 A  year is a  long time, as long as  it takes the  earth to go  around the sun, as long as  from one birthday to  another. There are lots of  things in a  year-one New Year, one Christmas, one spring, one summer, one autumn, and one  winter.

 Spring is  the morning of  the year. Everything wakes up  in spring,. Leaves come out  of the trees, flowers and  plants (植物) come out of  the ground, and animals, after they have slept all  winter, run out of  their holes. Spring is  the time for  planting (种植). Then the  ground is soft (松软) and warm from the  rain and the  sun.

 Summer is  the daytime of  the year. It is  the time for  growing. The sunshine is  hot and bright and  all the growing things stretch (伸展) up to  meet it. Plants can  not be strong and  grow well without the  sun. Flowers get bringt and  fruits (果实) get ripe (成熟). Birds sing, and all  kinds of things grow and  stretch.

 Autumn is  the evening of  the year, the harvest time. The last fruits get  ripe and people pick them up. Some animals grow thicker (更厚的) coats, and they will be  warm when winter comes. Some animals keep food. They will not  be hungry when there is  no food to  find in weinter. Leaves fall to  the ground. After a  while they break into small pieces and  become part of  the earth.

 Winter is  the night time of  the year, the time for  resting. In cold places, gardens and  fields rest, waiting for  the warm spring. Many animals rest in  their holes and  do almost nothing but  draw (吸) their breath. In winter the  days are short and  the nights are  very long.

 (   ) 1. A year is  as long as ____.       A. one spring          B. one Christmas

        C. one birthday to  one New Year    D. it takes the  earth to go  around the sun

 (   ) 2. In spring, _____.

        A. plants and animals wake up        B. plants wake up  but animals don't 

        C. we have Christmas               D. it is always very cold

 (   ) 3. In the  daytime of the  year, ____.

        A. plants can be  strong and grow well without the  sun

        B. plants are growing fast and  people often go  swimming in rivers

        C. animals wake up  frowm their long winter sleep       D. flowers get ripe

 (   ) 4. In autumn ____.

       A. animals are hungry and  they keep food  B. plants grow stronger and  stronger

       C. most of the  leaves fall to  the ground from the  trees

        D. the leaves come out  of the trees

 (   ) 5. In the  last season, ____.

        A. everything stops moving             B. the weather is  like the warm spring

        C. days are shorther than in  summer    D. days are  long, and nights are  short

 (10) Coral lslands (珊瑚岛)

 In  the sea there are  many islands. In its  warm waters there are  some little ones. We call them“Coral Islands”.

 A  coral island is  very nice to  look at. It looks like a  ring of land (一圈陆地) with trees, grass, and flowers on  it. One part of  the ring is  open to the  water. There is a  little round lake inside the  island.

 If  you look into this lake, you will see  beautiful coral. You may  think they are  flowers.

 If  you look at  a piece of  coral, you will see  many little holes in  it. In each of  these holes a  very small sea  animal has lived. These sea  animals make the  coral.

 They  began to build (营造) under the water. Year after year, the coral grew higher and  higher. At last it  grew out of  the water.

 Then  the sea brought to  it small trees and  something else. After some years, these things changed into earth. Sometimes the  wind brought seeds to  this earth. Sometimes birds flew over it  and brought seeds to  the island.

 The  little seeds grew. In a  few years there were plants all  over the island. In a  few more years there were trees growing there.

 So  you see, these islands were built little by  little (一点点形成的). The workers were very small. Do  they not  teach us a  lesson? Can you think what the  lesson is?

 (   ) 1. In the  sea ____.

        A. there are coral islands in  all places       B. there are some coral islands

        C. the water is  always warm               D. we can see  many flowers

 (   ) 2. A  coral island looks like ____.

        A. a round cake                B. trees, grass and flowers

        C. a ring of  land               D. a round lake

 (   ) 3. There are ____ in the  holes in corals.

        A. flowers        B. little corals        C. grass        D. sea animals

 (   ) 4. How did  seeds of trees, grass and  flowers come to  the coral islands? ___.

        A. The wind and  birds brought them to  the coral islands 

        B. Only the wind brought them there

        C. People brought them there        D. Fishes brought them there

 (   ) 5. From the  story we learn that ____.

        A. small workers can't do  big things   B. only big  workers can to  big things

        C. small workers can  do dig thbings if  they work hard and  work a long time

        D. all small things can  do dig things

 (11)  “How Old  Was the Tree?”

 A  very rich man  bought a big  farm. He paid a  lot of money for  it because there was  a great tree on  the farm. People said that the  tree was a  bout 3 hundred years old, and it  was famous (著名). But many of  his men did  not believe that the  tree was so  old. The new owner (主人) of the farm heard that Zeke, one of  his men, was very wise. He called him  to try to  make sure (弄清楚) how old the  tree really was.

 Four  days later Zeke came to  the new owner and  told him that the  tree was even older than they thought. It was  332 years old!

 “Great! Good news! How  wise you are!”said the  owner. “But I  want to know how  you could tell that tree was  so old.”

 “Very easy! I  cut (砍) down the  tree and  counted (数) the rings (圈),”answered Zeke.

 (   ) 1. The rich man  bought the farm because ____.

        A. he was interested in  the big trees on  the farm

        B. he was going to  plant trees on  the farm

        C. it was a  famous farm            D. it was a  big one

 (   ) 2. The word “men” in the first paragraph means“____”.

        A. 男人        B. 人        C. 雇工        D. 士兵

 (   ) 3. The new  owner was ____ when he  knew Zeke cut  down the tree.

        A. glad        B. sad and angry        C. worried        D. happy

 (   ) 4. To the  new owner, Zeke's words were ____.

        A. good news      B. bad news      C. not true      D. a lie (诺言)

 (   ) 5. The story shows Zeke was ____.

        A. a man not  really very clever          B. a bad man

        C. really very clever                    D. very strong

 (12)  One Way  Street

 One  day a Frenchman (法国人) went to New  York (纽约) on business (出差). He didn't know a  word of English. When he  arrived in  New  York, he took a  bus to a  hotel (旅馆).

 It  was Sunday, and the  Frenchman decided (决定) to go out  for a walk. He left the  hotel and went out  into the street.

 As  he walked along the  street, he suddenly (突然) remembered that he  didn't know the  name of the  street. So he decided to  write it down. He looked at  the wall  near the  corner of the  street. There he saw  some English words and  copied (抄) them down in  his notebook (笔记本).  “Now I  know  the name of  this street,”he said to  himself. “It will be  easy for me  to get back to  the hotel.”

 He  walked for a  long time in  the city. Then he  felt tired and  wanted to go  back to his  hotel. He took the  notebook out of  his pocket and  showed the name of  the street to  a young woman.

 Then  he decided to  ask someone else (别的). He stopped an  old man and  showed it to  him. The old man  didn't know what he  wanted, either.

 The  Frenchman was very much worried. Then he  went to a  young policeman nearby. The youun man  knew a little French. When the  Frenchman showed him  the words in  the notebook and  asded him where the  street was, the young man  laughed and laughed, for these were the  words in the  Frenchman's notebook: One Way Street (单行道).

 When  the policeman knew what had  happened, he helped the  Frenchman to find the  hotel. When the Frenchman got  to the hotel, he was  so tired that he  couldn't say a  word.

 (   ) 1. The Frenchman ___ .

        A. knew English well                  B. didn't knwo Englis at  all

        C. knew a lot  of English words        D. knew only a  little English

 (   ) 2. On Sunday the  Frenchman decided ____.

        A. to go to  a hotel                    B. to go to  New York

        C. to go out  for a walk                D. to do some shopping

 (   ) 3. He wrote down the  name of the  street in his  notebook because ____.

        A. he forgot the  name of the  street     B. he didn't want to  lose his way(迷路)

        C. he remembered the  name of the  street     D. he wanted to  go for a  walk

 (   ) 4. The other people didn't know what the  Frenchman wanted because ____.

        A. they didn't know the  words  “One way  street”

        B. they didn't want to  help him        C. they didn't know a  word of English

        D. the words  “One Way  Street” were not  a name of  a street

 (   ) 5. At last ____ helped him  to find the  way to  the hotel.

        A. a young policeman   B. an old  man   C. a young woman    D. a friend

 (13)  Best Present

 David came from a  poor family. When he  graduated (毕业) from high school, his father gave him  an unforgetable (难忘的) present. Some of his  friends got new  clothes and a  few rich children even got  new cars. His father took a  nickel (5分镍币) out of  his pocket and  said to him, “Buy a  piece of newspaper with that. Read every word of  it. Then turn to  the classified section (分类广告栏) and get  yourself a job (工作). Get into the  world. It's all yours now.”

 David always thought that was  a great joke (玩笑) until a few  years later when he  army (军队), sitting in  a foxhole (散兵坑), and thinking about his  fsmily and his  life. It was then that he  understood his friends had  got only new  cars, or only clothes. His father had  given him the  whole world. What a  greater present!

 (   ) 1. when David graduated from high school, his father gave him ___.

        A. a new car               B. some new clothes

        C. a nickel                 D. a piece of  newspaper

 (   ) 2. When David ___, his  father gave him  a present.

        A. finished middle school              B. left a university (大学)

        C. worked as a  teacher of English      D. became a soldier

 (   ) 3. In “It's all  yours now”, “it”refers to (指) “____”.

        A. the world       B. the nickle        C. a job        D. a newspaper

 (   ) 4. David's father ____.

        A. wasn't good to  David               B. played a joke on  David

        C. was clever and  very strict (严格) with David  D. was poor and  foolish

 (   ) 5. A few  years later David ____.

        A. understood that his  father had given him  a very great present

        B. thought his father had  played a joke on  him

        C. didn't find a  job        D. found a very good job

 (14)  A Bundle Of  Sticks

 Once  an old farmer had  sevral sons, and  his  sons often quarrelled (吵架) with one another. The farmer told them not  to quarrel, but they would not  listen to him. He was  very unhappy. He wanted to teach them a  lesson. He thought hard. At last he  had an idea.

 One  day he called his  sons together and  showed them some sticks (柴枝). He tied (绑扎) the sticks into a  bundle (一捆) and told his  sons to break it. They all  tried, but none (一个人也没有) of them could do  so. Then the farmer untied (解开) the bundle and  told his sons to  break (折断) the sticks one  by one. This time all  of them did  easily. The old man  said, “You  see, my sons, when you  are united (联合, 团结), you are strong. If you  are not, your enemy (敌人) will beat (打败) you one by  one.”.

 After that the  sons never quarrelled again.

 (   ) 1. The exact (确切) meaning of the  word “lesson” here may  be “__”.

        A. 功课        B. 课程       C. 一节课        D. 教训

 (   ) 2. The old  farmer's sons could not  break the bundle of  sticks because ____.

        A. it was too  heavy        B. it was very strong

        C. they didn't want to  break it      D. they were too  tired to bread it

 (   ) 3. All of  them broke the  sticks one by  one ____.

        A. easily        B. happily       C. slowly        D. quickly

 (   ) 4. The story shows that the  old farmer was ____.

        A. clever and liked his  sons          B. foolish and liked his  sons

        C. clever but didn't like his  sons      D. foolish and didn't like his  sons

 (   ) 5. The story tell us  that ____

        A. we must break a  bundle of  sticks together.

        B. we must break sticks one  by one.

        C. we must listen to  old farmers.    D. unity (团结) is strength (力量).

 (15)  Laura's Story

 My  father died when I  was born. Life was not easy in  Spain (西班牙) in those years. My mother decided to  move to Mexico (墨西哥) because people said things were easier there. And there was  no reason (理由) to stay in  Barcelona. It broke my  mother's heart to  leave, but  it also broke her  heart to stay. She sold (卖) her diamond ring (钻石戒指). It was her  only thing. Then she  bought two tickets to  Mexico.

 There, in Mexico, I forgot the  past. After all (毕竟) I was only a  child. But our new  life was not  like my mother's golden dreams (金色的梦). I grew up  and had to  to to work. I was  not happy. We were poor and  alone in the  world.

 At  eighteen I married (结婚) an older man. He had  a little money, and I  lived a happy life with him  for a few  years. I got new  clothes and lived in  a fine house. But I  didn't love him, and I  thought he knew it, too. He wasn't a  bad husband. He wanted a  quiet (安静的) life and  a big family, but I  didn't. We fought (吵架) about it and  made each other unhappy (不高兴). Finally we left each other. After that I  came to New  York.

 (   ) 1. They moved to  Mexico because ____.

        A. life  was hard in  Barcelona        B. life was easy in  Spain

        C. Laura's mother was  ill  D. they had  enough money to  buy two tickets

 (   ) 2. In Mexice, their life was ____.

        A. better than before            B. like the mother's  golden dreams

        C. happier                     D. as poor as  before

 (   ) 3. After Laura got  married, she lived a  happy  life for  a few years,  

        because ____.

        A. she loved  her husband husband     B. she had a  big family

        C. she was richer than before         D. her husbad was  older than she

 (   ) 4. In the  sentence “I  thought he knew it”,“it”refers to (指) “__”.

        A. I din't love him                       B. I got new  clothes

        C. a little money                         D. a fine house

 (   ) 5. At last she  left her husband and  went  to ____.

        A. America        B. England        C. Australia        D. Japan

 (16)  The Statue (雕像) of General (将军) Pershing

 General Pershing was  a great American officer. He was  in the American army and  fought (打仗) in Europe (欧洲) in the First World War (第一次世界大战).

 After he  died, some people in  his home town wanted to  remember him , so they put  up a big  statue of him  on a horse.

 There was  a school near the  statue and some of  the boys went there every day  on their way  to school and  again on their way  home. After a few  months, some of them began to  say, “Good morning, Pershing” Whenever (不论何时 ) they reached the  statue, and soon all  the boys at  the school were doing this.

 One  Saturday, one of the  youngest of these boys was  going to do  shopping with his  parents. When he went past the  statue, he said “Good morning, Pershing”to it. But then he  stopped and said to  his parents, “I like Pershing very much, Mum and  Dad, but who's that strange man  on his back?”

 (   ) 1. General Pershing was  from ____.

        A. Europe        B. England        C. America        D. Japan

 (   ) 2. In the  second paragraph “put up” means “_____”.

        A. 竖起        B. 制造        C. 挂起        D. 雕塑

 (   ) 3. The statue was ____ the school.

        A. not far from        B. behind       C. in        D. very far from

 (   ) 4. The boys went there every day _____.

        A. on their way  to school        B. on their way  home

        C. both A and  B               D. after class

 (   ) 5. One of  the youngest boy  thought that _____ was Pershing.

        A. the shop        B. the stone        C. the horse        D. the house

 (17)  Play Music for  Patients (病人)

 Eddie liked music very much when he  was at school, but when he  went to university (大学), he decided (决定) to study nedicine (医学) instead of music. When he  finished his study and  lbecame a doctor, he decided to  work in a  hospital for some time. There he  found that a  lot of the  patients were happier and  caused (引起) less trouble if  nice music was  played to them. When Eddie got  an office and  began to work for  himself, he decided to  keep his patients happy by  having a recorder (录音机) with beautiful music  in his  waiting- room.

 But  one morning, soon after Eddie had  put the recorder, a woman in  the crowded waiting-room said angrily,  “Here we're all  waiting to see  the doctor, and he's just playing the  violin  (小提琴) in his  office instead of  doing his work! ”

 (   ) 1. Why did  Eddie study medicine instead of  music? ____.

        A. Because he found medicine more interesting

        B. Because he didn't like music any  more when he  grew up

        C. Because  he wasn't interested in  music

        D. The story didn't tell us  why

 (   ) 2. ____, Eddie found that music was  helpful (有帮助的) to patients.

        A. When he worked in  a hospital     B. When he studied in  the university

        C. When he was  at school           D. After he bought a  recorder

 (   ) 3. “Eddie  got an office and  began to work for  himself” means “____”.

        A. he worked in  the office of  the hospital

        B. he himself worked in  the office

        C. he set up (建立) his own  clinic (诊所)

        D. he worked only for  himself, not for his  friends

 (   ) 4. “The  crowded waiting-room”means “_____”.

        A. there were many people in  the room  B. there were few  people in the  room

        C. the room was  bright                 D. the room was  small

 (   ) 5. Eddie ____ in his  office when the  woman said angrily.

        A. was playing the  violin               B. was working

        C. was doing nothing                   D. enjoying music

 ( 18)  I Like Bikes

 Two  years ago my  husband bought me  a bike. If you  live in a  town, it is often faster than a  car and you  don't have to  worry about parking (停车). You can  leave it anywhere (任何地方). As it has  a seat at  the back and  a basket at  the front, I can  take my small daughter to  school, to the library (图书馆) , shopping, anywhere in fact (事实上).

 I  use it mostly in  summer when the  weather is warm and  dry. It can not  be pleasant (舒适的) in winter when it  is cold and  it is raining hard. It can  also be very dangerous (危险的). You must, of course, be careful on  a bike. Accidents (事故) are not  the only problem. One day  I went shopping and  when I came back, I couldn't find my  front wheel (轮子). It was a  long walk to  the bike shop! Now I  have three strong locks (锁).

 My  husband  uses my  bike sometimes for  short trips (旅行). He is not  good at using bikes, but he  says it is  better than waiting for  a bus. He still likes his  car for longer trips, but I  think that all  this sitting down is  making him fat. On my  bike I get  a lot of  exercise and fresh air, and it  makes me feel a  lot younger.

 (   ) 1. I have had  a bike for ____.

        A. twenty months    B. one year       C. two weeks       D. two  years

 (   ) 2. A bike is  often____ if you live in  a town.

        A. slower than a  car               B. faster than a  car

        C. as fast as  a car                 D. not so fast as  a car

 (   ) 3. It can  be pleasant ____.

        A. when it is  cold                 B. when it rains hard

        C. when the weather is  warm and dry        D. when the weather is  wet

 (   ) 4. When my  husband wants to  go a long way, he likes to ____.

        A. drive a car   B. take a  train  C. use my  bike  D. walk without his  car

 (   ) 5. Which of  the following is  not true?

        A. People can get  mush exercise by  using a bike.

        B. People can get  fat by using a  bike. 

        C. People can get  fresh (新鲜的) air by using a  bike.

        D. People can feel younger by  using a bike.

 (19)  Life Without TV

 When  friends come to  visit us in  the evening, they often tell us  that they are  in a hurry and  look at their watches. It isn't that our  friends are all  very busy, it is  just that we  haven't got a  TV set. People think that we  are very strange. “But what do  you do in  the evening?”they are always asking. It's easy to  answer. Both my wife and  I have hobbies (爱好). We certainly don't only look at  the walls. My wife enjoys cooking and  drawing and often goes to  evening classes in  foreign languages (外语). This is very useful (有用的) as we always go  abroad (出国) for our  holidays. I collect stamps (集邮) and I am  always busy with my  collection. Both of us  enjoy listening to  music and playing chess (下棋) together.

 Sometimes there is  no electricity (电) in the house. This does not  worry us as  we just use  candles (腊烛) and go  on with what we  were doing before. Our friends don't know what to  do. They only watch TV. On such evenings there are  a lot of  people in our  house. They all come to  us. They all have a  good time. Instead of  sitting quietly (静静地) in front of  the TV set, everybody talks and  plays games. Is life really impossible (不可能) without TV?

 (   ) 1. Our friends don't stay in  our house long because ____.

        A. they are busy        B. we have no  TV set

        C. they  don't like us  very much        D. we are busy all  the time

 (   ) 2. Our friends think we  are strange because ____.

        A. we have no  time to watch TV

        B. we haven't got  a TV set  and often go  to bed early

        C. we don't like them to  come to our  home

        D. they don't understand life without TV

 (   ) 3. In the  wvening we _____.

        A. like to look at  the walls        B. often go to  the cinema

        C. enjoy drawing and  collecting stamps

        D. often go to  listen to music in  our friends' homes

 (   ) 4. If there is  no electricity in  the house, ____.

        A. we go out  to play chess        B. we are very worried

        C. our friends come to  our house and  stay longer

        D. we go out  to visit our  friends

 (   ) 5. Life without TV  is _____ for us.

        A. impossible                  B. not impossible

        C. hard                        D. not interesting

 (20)  A Day  to See the  Circus (马戏)

 Last  Saturday the circus was  in town, and my  neighbor invited me  to go with him  and three of  his children to  see it. One of  the first things we  saw at the  circus was a  man. He was selling popcorn (爆玉米). You know what popcorn is, din't you? It's a  kind of  corn (玉米) that pops (爆开) when it gets hot. The pieces of  corn break open (裂开) and grow quickly into little white balls about the  size (大小) of the  end of your finger (手指). They are good to  eat. Everybody buys popcorn at  the circus. The children love it, and I  love it, too. After we  bought the popcorn, we went on  to look at  some of the  animals. We stopped  at a  cage (笼子). There were some monkeys in  it. They were so  small that we  thought they  must  be babies, but a  guard (守卫) explained (解释), “They  have grown up.” They did  a lot of  funny (有趣的) things and  made the children lauth and  cry. One of the  monkeys turned his  head to one  side and closed one  eye. It looked  as  though (似乎) he was  making faces at  me. I din't know if  I looked as  funny to him  as he did  me.

 (   ) 1. My neighbour invited me  to go with him  and his ___ehildren to  see the

        circus.

        A. two        B. five        C. three        D. four

 (   ) 2. At the  circus there was  a man _____.

        A. seling popcorn           B. eating popcorn

        C. buying popcorn          D. making cakes

 (   ) 3. We noticed (注意) that _____ were in a  cage.

        A. some birds              B. many birds

        C. a few monkeys          D. a lot of  monkeys

 (   ) 4. We  thought the monkeys must be  babies because they were so _____.

        A. small       B. funy        C. thin         D. clever

 (   ) 5. Maybe I  looked _____ to the monkeys.

        A. happy         B. fine        C. worried        D. very funny

 (21)  Why Is  He So Secretive (神秘)

 Mrs smith is  the owner (主人) of a house. She keeps one  room for herself and  lets out the  other rooms. Since the  house is near a  college (大学), there are a  lot of young people.

 Mrs Smith keeps a  strict (严格的) eye on  the use of  the phone, electricity (电), and everything else, because she  doesn't want to  keep the bill high. Last month's phone bill was  very high. She wanted to  know if someone in  the house made long distance calls (长途电话) and didn't tell her. So she  decided (决定) to find out  who it was.

 She has  waited behind the  door for several nights. Just now  she was glad to  hear someone coming near the  telephone desk. She couldn't hear what the  person was saying, but she  was sure it  was a  man's voice. “He must be trying to  hide (藏) something..”She decided to  go in quickly so  that she could catch the  man right then.

 But when she  suddenly (突然地) opened the  door, she saw only the  back of a  man with his  hand on the  telephone desk. He was  saying something in  a low (低) voice to a  girl beside him. So Mrs  Smith still doesn't know who  the culprit (罪犯) is.

 (   ) 1. In the  second sentence, “let out”means “____”.

        A. 居住        B. 装修        C. 出租        D. 搬出

 (   ) 2. Most of  the people in  Mrs Smith's other rooms are ____.

        A. policemen             B. middle school students

        C. college students             D. factory workers

 (   ) 3. “Jeeo tge bill high ” means “____”.

        A. 放帐单于高处             B. 使开支大

        C. 保持帐单于高处          D. 把账单提高

 (   ) 4. She was  glad to hear someone coming near because___.

        A. she thought she  then could  know  who made long                 distance calls without telling her

        B . she thought she  could hear what he  was saying

        C. she at last caught the  man

        D. she waited behind the  door for some nights

 (   ) 5. “to be seeretive” mcans “____”.

        A. not to keep quiet      B. to tell anybody everything

        C. not to make noise     D. to hide (隐藏) something

 (   )1.A. B.C.D.

 (   )1.A. B.C.D.

 (   )1.A. B.C.D.

 (   )1.A. B.C.D.

 (   )1.A. B.C.D.

 (   )1.A. B.C.D.

 (   )1.A. B.C.D.

 (   )1.A. B.C.D.

 (   )1.A. B.C.D.

 (   )1.A. B.C.D.

 五. 连词成句:

 六. 根据要求改写句子:

 1. (划线提问)

 2. (同上)

 3.  (同上)

 4. (同上)

 5. (同上)

 6.  (同上)

 7. (同上)

 8. (同上)

 9. (同上)

 10.  (同上)

 七. 用所给动词, 词组的正确形式填空.

 八. 在必要的地方, 填上适当的冠词:

 九. 改病句:

 十根据所提供的情景, 选择所给的句子完成下列对话(每句只能使用一次)

 十一. 完型填空.

 (站台)(美分)

 十二. 阅读理解

 (市场集市)(驴)

 初二英语期中考练习卷

 一. 在下列各组单词中选出一个划线部分读音与所给单词的划线部分读音一样的单词.

 (   ) 1. A.B. C. D.

 二. 找出适当的字母或字母组合, 使单词完整. 正确

 三. 用所给词的正确形式填空:

 四. 选择填空;

 五. 连词成句:

 六. 根据要求改写句子:

 1. (划线提问)

 2. (同上)

 3.  (同上)

 4. (同上)

 5. (同上)

 6.  (同上)

 7. (同上)

 8. (同上)

 9. (同上)

 10. (同上)

 七. 用所给动词, 词组的正确形式填空.

 八. 在必要的地方, 填上适当的冠词:

 九. 改病句:

 十根据所提供的情景, 选择所给的句子完成下列对话(每句只能使用一次)

 十一. 完型填空.

 (站台)(美分)

 十二. 阅读理解

 (市场集市)(驴)

 

  

     

  

   

   

   

   

   

TELEPHONE  MESSAGE

From : _____________   To : _____________

Time : _________________________________

Message : __________________________________        __________________________________

        __________________________________

Timetable

STOP

BUS 1

BUS 2

BUS 3

BUS 4

Ferry

Old Street

Park

New Street

Hotel

Playground

Hospital

Market

 6.00

6.10

6.25

6.30

6.35

6.40

7.00

7.10

 6.30

6.40

6.55

7.00

7.05

7.10

7.30

 7.00

7.10

7.25

7.30

7.35

7.40

8.00

8.10

 7.30

7.40

7.55

8.00

8.05

8.25

8.35